Z8F3221VN020AC [IXYS]
暂无描述;High Performance 8-Bit Microcontrollers
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
PS019921-0308
Copyright ©2008 by Zilog®, Inc. All rights reserved.
www.zilog.com
DO NOT USE IN LIFE SUPPORT
Warning:
LIFE SUPPORT POLICY
ZILOG'S PRODUCTS ARE NOT AUTHORIZED FOR USE AS CRITICAL COMPONENTS IN LIFE
SUPPORT DEVICES OR SYSTEMS WITHOUT THE EXPRESS PRIOR WRITTEN APPROVAL OF
THE PRESIDENT AND GENERAL COUNSEL OF ZILOG CORPORATION.
As used herein
Life support devices or systems are devices which (a) are intended for surgical implant into the body, or (b)
support or sustain life and whose failure to perform when properly used in accordance with instructions for
use provided in the labeling can be reasonably expected to result in a significant injury to the user. A
critical component is any component in a life support device or system whose failure to perform can be
reasonably expected to cause the failure of the life support device or system or to affect its safety or
effectiveness.
Document Disclaimer
©2008 by Zilog, Inc. All rights reserved. Information in this publication concerning the devices,
applications, or technology described is intended to suggest possible uses and may be superseded. ZILOG,
INC. DOES NOT ASSUME LIABILITY FOR OR PROVIDE A REPRESENTATION OF ACCURACY
OF THE INFORMATION, DEVICES, OR TECHNOLOGY DESCRIBED IN THIS DOCUMENT.
ZILOG ALSO DOES NOT ASSUME LIABILITY FOR INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY
INFRINGEMENT RELATED IN ANY MANNER TO USE OF INFORMATION, DEVICES, OR
TECHNOLOGY DESCRIBED HEREIN OR OTHERWISE. The information contained within this
document has been verified according to the general principles of electrical and mechanical engineering.
Z8, Z8 Encore!, Z8 Encore! XP, Z8 Encore! MC, Crimzon, eZ80, and ZNEO are trademarks or registered
trademarks of Zilog, Inc. All other product or service names are the property of their respective owners.
PS019921-0308
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
iii
Revision History
Each instance in the Revision History table reflects a change to this document from its pre-
vious revision. For more details, refer to the corresponding pages or appropriate links
given in the table below.
Revision
Level
Page
Date
Description
Number
March
21
Changed title to Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series.
All
2008
February 20
2008
Changed Z8 Encore! XP 64K Series Flash
Microcontrollers to Z8 Encore! XP F64xx Series Flash
Microcontrollers. Deleted three sentences that
mentioned Z8R642. Removed the 40 PDIP package.
Added ZENETSC0100ZACG to the end of the
Ordering Information table. Changed the flag status to
unaffected for BIT, BSET, and BCLR in Table 133 on
page 246.
Various
December 19
2007
Updated Zilog logo, Disclaimer section, and
implemented style guide. Updated Table 112.
Changed Z8 Encore! 64K Series to Z8 Encore! XP
64K Series Flash Microcontrollers throughout the
document.
All
December 18
2006
November 17
2006
Updated Table 110 and Ordering Information.
224, 265
270
Updated Part Number Suffix Designations.
PS019921-0308
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
iv
Table of Contents
Manual Objectives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xii
About This Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .xii
Intended Audience . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .xii
Manual Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .xii
Safeguards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xiv
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Part Selection Guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
CPU and Peripheral Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
eZ8™ CPU Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
General-Purpose Input/Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Flash Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
10-Bit Analog-to-Digital Converter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
UARTs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
I2C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
Serial Peripheral Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
Timers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
Interrupt Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
Reset Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
On-Chip Debugger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
DMA Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
Signal and Pin Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
Available Packages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
Pin Configurations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
Signal Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
Pin Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
Address Space . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Register File . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Program Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Data Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
Information Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
Register File Address Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
PS019921-0308
Table of Contents
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
v
Control Register Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
Reset and Stop Mode Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Reset Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Reset Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Power-On Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Voltage Brownout Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Watchdog Timer Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
External Pin Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
On-Chip Debugger Initiated Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Stop Mode Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Stop Mode Recovery Using Watchdog Timer Time-Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
Stop Mode Recovery Using a GPIO Port Pin Transition HALT . . . . . . . . . . 50
Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
STOP Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
HALT Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
General-Purpose I/O . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
GPIO Port Availability By Device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Architecture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
GPIO Alternate Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
GPIO Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
GPIO Control Register Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Port A–H Address Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
Port A–H Control Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
Port A–H Input Data Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Port A–H Output Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Interrupt Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Interrupt Vector Listing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Architecture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Master Interrupt Enable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Interrupt Vectors and Priority . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Interrupt Assertion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Software Interrupt Assertion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Interrupt Control Register Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Interrupt Request 0 Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Interrupt Request 1 Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
PS019921-0308
Table of Contents
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
vi
Interrupt Request 2 Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
IRQ0 Enable High and Low Bit Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
IRQ1 Enable High and Low Bit Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
IRQ2 Enable High and Low Bit Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Interrupt Edge Select Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Interrupt Port Select Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Interrupt Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Timers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Architecture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Timer Operating Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Reading the Timer Count Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Timer Output Signal Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Timer Control Register Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Timer 0-3 High and Low Byte Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Timer Reload High and Low Byte Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Timer 0-3 PWM High and Low Byte Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Timer 0-3 Control 0 Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Timer 0-3 Control 1 Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
Watchdog Timer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
Watchdog Timer Refresh . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Watchdog Timer Time-Out Response . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Watchdog Timer Reload Unlock Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Watchdog Timer Control Register Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Watchdog Timer Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Watchdog Timer Reload Upper, High and Low Byte Registers . . . . . . . . . . 97
UART . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Architecture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Data Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Transmitting Data using the Polled Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
Transmitting Data using the Interrupt-Driven Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Receiving Data using the Polled Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
Receiving Data using the Interrupt-Driven Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Clear To Send (CTS) Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
PS019921-0308
Table of Contents
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
vii
MULTIPROCESSOR (9-bit) Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
External Driver Enable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
UART Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
UART Baud Rate Generator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
UART Control Register Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
UART Transmit Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
UART Receive Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
UART Status 0 Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
UART Status 1 Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
UART Control 0 and Control 1 Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
UART Address Compare Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
UART Baud Rate High and Low Byte Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
Infrared Encoder/Decoder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Architecture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Transmitting IrDA Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Receiving IrDA Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Infrared Encoder/Decoder Control Register Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Serial Peripheral Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Architecture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
SPI Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
SPI Clock Phase and Polarity Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
Multi-Master Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
Slave Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
Error Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
SPI Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
SPI Baud Rate Generator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
SPI Control Register Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
SPI Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
SPI Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
SPI Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
SPI Mode Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
SPI Diagnostic State Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
SPI Baud Rate High and Low Byte Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
I2C Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
PS019921-0308
Table of Contents
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
viii
Architecture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
SDA and SCL Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
I2C Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
Software Control of I2C Transactions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
Start and Stop Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
Master Write and Read Transactions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
Address Only Transaction with a 7-bit Address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
Write Transaction with a 7-Bit Address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
Address Only Transaction with a 10-bit Address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
Write Transaction with a 10-Bit Address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
Read Transaction with a 7-Bit Address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
Read Transaction with a 10-Bit Address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
I2C Control Register Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
I2C Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
I2C Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
I2C Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154
I2C Baud Rate High and Low Byte Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
I2C Diagnostic State Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
I2C Diagnostic Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
Direct Memory Access Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
DMA0 and DMA1 Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
Configuring DMA0 and DMA1 for Data Transfer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
DMA_ADC Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
Configuring DMA_ADC for Data Transfer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
DMA Control Register Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
DMAx Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
DMAx I/O Address Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
DMAx Address High Nibble Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
DMAx Start/Current Address Low Byte Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
DMAx End Address Low Byte Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
DMA_ADC Address Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
DMA_ADC Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
DMA Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
Analog-to-Digital Converter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
Architecture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
PS019921-0308
Table of Contents
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
ix
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172
Automatic Power-Down . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172
Single-Shot Conversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
Continuous Conversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
DMA Control of the ADC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174
ADC Control Register Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
ADC Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
ADC Data High Byte Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
ADC Data Low Bits Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
Flash Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
Information Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
Timing Using the Flash Frequency Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
Flash Read Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
Flash Write/Erase Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
Byte Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
Page Erase . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
Mass Erase . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
Flash Controller Bypass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
Flash Controller Behavior in Debug Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
Flash Control Register Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186
Flash Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186
Flash Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186
Page Select Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187
Flash Sector Protect Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188
Flash Frequency High and Low Byte Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188
Option Bits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
Option Bit Configuration By Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
Option Bit Address Space . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
Flash Memory Address 0000H . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192
Flash Memory Address 0001H . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
On-Chip Debugger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
Architecture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
OCD Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
PS019921-0308
Table of Contents
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
x
DEBUG Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197
OCD Data Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197
OCD Auto-Baud Detector/Generator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198
OCD Serial Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198
Breakpoints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
On-Chip Debugger Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
On-Chip Debugger Control Register Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205
OCD Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205
OCD Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
On-Chip Oscillator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207
Operating Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207
Crystal Oscillator Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207
Oscillator Operation with an External RC Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211
Absolute Maximum Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211
DC Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
On-Chip Peripheral AC and DC Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
AC Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
General-Purpose I/O Port Input Data Sample Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228
General-Purpose I/O Port Output Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
On-Chip Debugger Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
SPI Master Mode Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
SPI Slave Mode Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232
I2C Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233
UART Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
eZ8™ CPU Instruction Set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
Assembly Language Programming Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
Assembly Language Syntax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
eZ8 CPU Instruction Notation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
Condition Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
eZ8 CPU Instruction Classes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241
eZ8 CPU Instruction Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Flags Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255
Opcode Maps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
Packaging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
PS019921-0308
Table of Contents
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
xi
Ordering Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265
Part Number Suffix Designations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273
Customer Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
PS019921-0308
Table of Contents
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
xii
Manual Objectives
This product specification provides detailed operating information for the Flash devices
within Zilog’s Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series microcontroller (MCU) products. Within
this document, the Z8F642x, Z8F482x, Z8F322x, Z8F242x, and Z8F162x devices are
referred to collectively as the Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series unless specifically stated
otherwise.
About This Manual
Zilog® recommends that you read and understand everything in this manual before setting
up and using the product. However, we recognize that there are different styles of learning.
Therefore, we have designed this product specification to be used either as a how to
procedural manual or a reference guide to important data.
Intended Audience
This document is written for Zilog customers who are experienced at working with micro-
controllers, integrated circuits, or printed circuit assemblies.
Manual Conventions
The following assumptions and conventions are adopted to provide clarity and ease of use:
Courier Typeface
Commands, code lines and fragments, bits, equations, hexadecimal addresses, and various
executable items are distinguished from general text by the use of the Couriertypeface.
Where the use of the font is not indicated, as in the Index, the name of the entity is
presented in upper case.
•
Example: FLAGS[1] is smrf.
Hexadecimal Values
Hexadecimal values are designated by uppercase H suffix and appear in the Courier
typeface.
•
Example: R1 is set to F8H.
Brackets
The square brackets, [ ], indicate a register or bus.
•
Example: For the register R1[7:0], R1 is an 8-bit register, R1[7] is the most significant
bit, and R1[0] is the least significant bit.
PS019921-0308
Manual Objectives
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
xiii
Braces
The curly braces, { }, indicate a single register or bus created by concatenating some
combination of smaller registers, buses, or individual bits.
•
Example: The 12-bit register address {0H, RP[7:4], R1[3:0]} is composed of a 4-bit
hexadecimal value (0H) and two 4-bit register values taken from the Register Pointer
(RP) and Working Register R1. 0His the most-significant nibble (4-bit value) of the
12-bit register, and R1[3:0] is the least significant nibble of the 12-bit register.
Parentheses
The parentheses, ( ), indicate an indirect register address lookup.
•
Example: (R1) is the memory location referenced by the address contained in the
Working Register R1.
Parentheses/Bracket Combinations
The parentheses, ( ), indicate an indirect register address lookup and the square brackets,
[ ], indicate a register or bus.
•
Example: Assume PC[15:0] contains the value 1234h. (PC[15:0]) then refers to the
contents of the memory location at address 1234h.
Use of the Words Set, Reset and Clear
The word set implies that a register bit or a condition contains a logical 1. The words reset
or clear imply that a register bit or a condition contains a logical 0. When either of these
terms is followed by a number, the word logical may not be included; however, it is
implied.
Notation for Bits and Similar Registers
A field of bits within a register is designated as: Register[n:n].
•
Example: ADDR[15:0] refers to bits 15 through bit 0 of the Address.
Use of the Terms LSB, MSB, lsb, and msb
In this document, the terms LSB and MSB, when appearing in upper case, mean least
significant byte and most significant byte, respectively. The lowercase forms, lsb and msb,
mean least significant bit and most significant bit, respectively.
Use of Initial Uppercase Letters
Initial uppercase letters designate settings and conditions in general text.
•
•
Example 1: The receiver forces the SCL line to Low.
Example 2: The Master can generate a Stop condition to abort the transfer.
PS019921-0308
Manual Objectives
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
xiv
Use of All Uppercase Letters
The use of all uppercase letters designates the names of states, modes, and commands.
•
•
•
Example 1: The bus is considered BUSY after the Start condition.
Example 2: A START command triggers the processing of the initialization sequence.
Example 3: STOP mode.
Bit Numbering
Bits are numbered from 0 to n–1 where n indicates the total number of bits. For example,
the 8 bits of a register are numbered from 0 to 7.
Safeguards
It is important that you understand the following safety terms, which are defined here.
Caution:
Indicates a procedure or file may become corrupted if you do not follow
directions.
PS019921-0308
Manual Objectives
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
1
Introduction
Zilog’s Z8 Encore! XP MCU family of products are a line of Zilog® microcontroller
products based upon the 8-bit eZ8 CPU. The Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series, hereafter
referred to collectively as the Z8 Encore! XP or the F64XX Series adds Flash memory to
Zilog’s extensive line of 8-bit microcontrollers. The Flash in-circuit programming
capability allows for faster development time and program changes in the field. The new
eZ8™ CPU is upward compatible with existing Z8® instructions. The rich-peripheral set
of the Z8 Encore! XP makes it suitable for a variety of applications including motor
control, security systems, home appliances, personal electronic devices, and sensors.
Features
The features of Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series include:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
20 MHz eZ8 CPU
Up to 64 KB Flash with in-circuit programming capability
Up to 4 KB register RAM
12-channel, 10-bit Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Two full-duplex 9-bit UARTs with bus transceiver Driver Enable control
Inter-integrated circuit (I2C)
Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI)
Two Infrared Data Association (IrDA)-compliant infrared encoder/decoders
Up to four 16-bit timers with capture, compare, and PWM capability
Watchdog Timer (WDT) with internal RC oscillator
Three-channel DMA
Up to 60 input/output (I/O) pins
24 interrupts with configurable priority
On-Chip Debugger
Voltage Brownout (VBO) Protection
Power-On Reset (POR)
Operating voltage of 3.0 V to 3.6 V with 5 V-tolerant inputs
0 °C to +70 °C, –40 °C to +105 °C, and –40 °C to +125 °C operating temperature
ranges
PS019921-0308
Introduction
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
2
Part Selection Guide
Table 1 identifies the basic features and package styles available for each device within the
Z8 Encore! XP product line.
Table 1. Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series Part Selection Guide
16-bit
Part
Flash RAM
Timers
ADC UARTs
44-pin 64/68-pin 80-pin
2
Number (KB) (KB) I/O with PWM Inputs with IrDA I C SPI packages packages package
Z8F1621
Z8F1622
Z8F2421
Z8F2422
Z8F3221
Z8F3222
Z8F4821
Z8F4822
Z8F4823
Z8F6421
Z8F6422
Z8F6423
16
16
24
24
32
32
48
48
48
64
64
64
2
2
2
2
2
2
4
4
4
4
4
4
31
46
31
46
31
46
31
46
60
31
46
60
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
4
4
3
4
4
8
12
8
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
12
8
12
8
12
12
8
X
X
X
12
12
X
Die Form Contact
®
Sales
Zilog
PS019921-0308
Introduction
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
3
Block Diagram
Figure 1 displays the block diagram of the architecture of the Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX
Series.
XTAL/RC
Oscillator
On-Chip
Debugger
POR/VBO
and Reset
Controller
eZ8TM
CPU
Interrupt
WDT with
Controller
RC Oscillator
System
Clock
Memory Busses
Register Bus
2
Flash
RAM
Timers
UARTs
I C
SPI
ADC
DMA
Controller
Controller
IrDA
Flash
RAM
Memory
GPIO
Figure 1. Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series Block Diagram
CPU and Peripheral Overview
eZ8™ CPU Features
The latest 8-bit eZ8 CPU meets the continuing demand for faster and more code-efficient
microcontrollers. The eZ8 CPU executes a superset of the original Z8® instruction set.
PS019921-0308
Introduction
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
4
The eZ8 CPU features include:
•
Direct register-to-register architecture allows each register to function as an
accumulator, improving execution time and decreasing the required Program Memory
•
Software stack allows much greater depth in subroutine calls and interrupts than
hardware stacks
•
•
•
Compatible with existing Z8 code
Expanded internal Register File allows access of up to 4 KB
New instructions improve execution efficiency for code developed using higher-level
programming languages, including C
•
•
Pipelined instruction fetch and execution
New instructions for improved performance including BIT, BSWAP, BTJ, CPC, LDC,
LDCI, LEA, MULT, and SRL
•
•
•
•
New instructions support 12-bit linear addressing of the Register File
Up to 10 MIPS operation
C-Compiler friendly
2 to 9 clock cycles per instruction
For more information on the eZ8 CPU, refer to eZ8™ CPU Core User Manual (UM0128)
available for download at www.zilog.com.
General-Purpose Input/Output
The Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series feature seven 8-bit ports (Ports A-G) and one 4-bit
port (Port H) for general-purpose input/output (GPIO). Each pin is individually
programmable. All ports (except B and H) support 5 V-tolerant inputs.
Flash Controller
The Flash Controller programs and erases the Flash memory.
10-Bit Analog-to-Digital Converter
The Analog-to-Digital Converter converts an analog input signal to a 10-bit binary
number. The ADC accepts inputs from up to 12 different analog input sources.
UARTs
Each UART is full-duplex and capable of handling asynchronous data transfers. The
UARTs support 8- and 9-bit data modes, selectable parity, and an efficient bus transceiver
Driver Enable signal for controlling a multi-transceiver bus, such as RS-485.
PS019921-0308
Introduction
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
5
I2C
The I2C controller makes the Z8 Encore! XP compatible with the I2C protocol. The I2C
controller consists of two bidirectional bus lines, a serial data (SDA) line and a serial clock
(SCL) line.
Serial Peripheral Interface
The serial peripheral interface allows the Z8 Encore! XP to exchange data between other
peripheral devices such as EEPROMs, A/D converters and ISDN devices. The SPI is a
full-duplex, synchronous, character-oriented channel that supports a four-wire interface.
Timers
Up to four 16-bit reloadable timers can be used for timing/counting events or for motor
control operations. These timers provide a 16-bit programmable reload counter and
operate in ONE-SHOT, CONTINUOUS, GATED, CAPTURE, COMPARE, CAPTURE
AND COMPARE, and PWM modes. Only 3 timers (Timers 0-2) are available in the 44-
pin packages.
Interrupt Controller
The Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series products support up to 24 interrupts. These interrupts
consist of 12 internal and 12 GPIO pins. The interrupts have 3 levels of programmable
interrupt priority.
Reset Controller
The Z8 Encore! XP can be reset using the RESET pin, Power-On Reset, Watchdog Timer,
STOP mode exit, or Voltage Brownout (VBO) warning signal.
On-Chip Debugger
The Z8 Encore! XP features an integrated On-Chip Debugger. The OCD provides a rich
set of debugging capabilities, such as reading and writing registers, programming the
Flash, setting breakpoints and executing code. A single-pin interface provides
communication to the OCD.
DMA Controller
The Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series feature three channels of DMA. Two of the channels
are for register RAM to and from I/O operations. The third channel automatically controls
the transfer of data from the ADC to the memory.
PS019921-0308
Introduction
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
6
PS019921-0308
Introduction
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
7
Signal and Pin Descriptions
The Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series product are available in a variety of packages styles
and pin configurations. This chapter describes the signals and available pin configurations
for each of the package styles. For information on physical package specifications, see
Packaging on page 261.
Available Packages
Table 2 identifies the package styles that are available for each device within the
Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series product line.
Table 2. Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series Package Options
44-pin
LQFP
44-pin
PLCC
64-pin
LQFP
68-pin
PLCC
80-pin
QFP
Part Number
Z8F1621
Z8F1622
Z8F2421
Z8F2422
Z8F3221
Z8F3222
Z8F4821
Z8F4822
Z8F4823
Z8F6421
Z8F6422
Z8F6423
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
PS019921-0308
Signal and Pin Descriptions
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
8
Pin Configurations
Figure 2 through Figure 6 on page 12 display the pin configurations for all of the packages
available in the Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series. For description of the signals, see Table 3
on page 13. Timer 3 is not available in the 44-pin packages.
6
1
40
39
PA7 / SDA
PD6 / CTS1
PC3 / SCK
VSS
PA0 / T0IN
PD2
PC2 / SS
RESET
VDD
7
VDD
34
12
PC7 / T2OUT
PC6 / T2IN
DBG
PC1 / T1OUT
PC0 / T1IN
VSS
VSS
PD1
PD0
XOUT
XIN
29
VDD
17
18
28
23
Figure 2. Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series in 44-Pin Plastic Leaded Chip Carrier (PLCC)
PS019921-0308
Signal and Pin Descriptions
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
9
33
34
23
22
28
PA7 / SDA
PD6 / CTS1
PC3 / SCK
VSS
PA0 / T0IN
PD2
PC2 / SS
RESET
VDD
VDD
39
44
17
PC7 / T2OUT
PC6 / T2IN
DBG
PC1 / T1OUT
PC0 / T1IN
VSS
VSS
PD1
PD0
XOUT
XIN
12
VDD
1
11
6
Figure 3. Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series in 44-Pin Low-Profile Quad Flat Package (LQFP)
PS019921-0308
Signal and Pin Descriptions
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
10
40
48
49
33
32
PA7 / SDA
PD6 / CTS1
PC3 / SCK
PD7 / RCOUT
VSS
PA0 / T0IN
PD2
PC2 / SS
RESET
VDD
PE5
PE6
PE7
VDD
PG3
VDD
PC7 / T2OUT
PC6 / T2IN
DBG
PC1 / T1OUT
PC0 / T1IN
PE4
PE3
VSS
PE2
PE1
PE0
VSS
25
56
64
PD1 / T3OUT
PD0 / T3IN
XOUT
XIN
17
1
16
8
Figure 4. Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series in 64-Pin Low-Profile Quad Flat Package (LQFP)
PS019921-0308
Signal and Pin Descriptions
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
11
9
1
61
60
PA7 / SDA
PD6 / CTS1
PC3 / SCK
PD7 / RCOUT
VSS
PE5
PE6
PE7
VDD
PA0 / T0IN
PD2
PC2 / SS
RESET
VDD
10
18
PE4
PE3
VSS
PE2
52
PE1
PE0
PG3
VDD
PC7 / T2OUT
PC6 / T2IN
DBG
PC1 / T1OUT
PC0 / T1IN
VSS
VSS
VDD
PD1 / T3OUT
PD0 / T3IN
XOUT
XIN
26
44
43
27
35
Figure 5. Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series in 68-Pin Plastic Leaded Chip Carrier (PLCC)
PS019921-0308
Signal and Pin Descriptions
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
12
80
65
75
70
64
PA7 / SDA
PD6 / CTS1
PC3 / SCK
PD7 / RCOUT
PG0
PA0 / T0IN
PD2
PC2 / SS
PF6
1
5
60
RESET
VSS
PG1
VDD
PF5
PG2
PF4
PE5
PF3
10
15
55
50
45
PE4
PE3
VSS
PE2
PE1
PE0
VSS
PF2
PE6
PE7
VDD
PG3
PG4
PG5
PG6
VDD
PG7
PF1
PF0
VDD
PC7 / T2OUT
PC6 / T2IN
DBG
PC1 / T1OUT
PC0 / T1IN
20
24
PD1 / T3OUT
PD0 / T3IN
XOUT
XIN
41 VSS
40
25
30
35
Figure 6. Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series in 80-Pin Quad Flat Package (QFP)
PS019921-0308
Signal and Pin Descriptions
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
13
Signal Descriptions
Table 3 describes the Z8 Encore! XP signals. To determine the signals available for the
specific package styles, see Pin Configurations on page 8.
Table 3. Signal Descriptions
Signal
Mnemonic
I/O
Description
General-Purpose I/O Ports A-H
PA[7:0]
I/O
Port A[7:0]. These pins are used for general-purpose I/O and support
5 V-tolerant inputs.
PB[7:0]
PC[7:0]
I/O
I/O
Port B[7:0]. These pins are used for general-purpose I/O.
Port C[7:0]. These pins are used for general-purpose I/O. These pins are
used for general-purpose I/O and support 5 V-tolerant inputs
PD[7:0]
PE[7:0]
PF[7:0]
PG[7:0]
PH[3:0]
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
Port D[7:0]. These pins are used for general-purpose I/O. These pins are
used for general-purpose I/O and support 5 V-tolerant inputs
Port E[7:0]. These pins are used for general-purpose I/O. These pins are
used for general-purpose I/O and support 5 V-tolerant inputs.
Port F[7:0]. These pins are used for general-purpose I/O. These pins are
used for general-purpose I/O and support 5 V-tolerant inputs.
Port G[7:0]. These pins are used for general-purpose I/O. These pins are
used for general-purpose I/O and support 5 V-tolerant inputs.
Port H[3:0]. These pins are used for general-purpose I/O.
2
I C Controller
2
SCL
O
Serial Clock. This is the output clock for the I C. This pin is multiplexed with a
general-purpose I/O pin. When the general-purpose I/O pin is configured for
alternate function to enable the SCL function, this pin is open-drain.
2
SDA
I/O
Serial Data. This open-drain pin transfers data between the I C and a slave.
This pin is multiplexed with a general-purpose I/O pin. When the
general-purpose I/O pin is configured for alternate function to enable the
SDA function, this pin is open-drain.
SPI Controller
I/O
Slave Select. This signal can be an output or an input. If the Z8 Encore! XP
F64XX Series is the SPI master, this pin may be configured as the Slave
Select output. If the Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series is the SPI slave, this pin is
the input slave select. It is multiplexed with a general-purpose I/O pin.
SS
PS019921-0308
Signal and Pin Descriptions
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
14
Table 3. Signal Descriptions (Continued)
Signal
Mnemonic
I/O
Description
SCK
I/O
SPI Serial Clock. The SPI master supplies this pin. If the Z8 Encore! XP
F64XX Series is the SPI master, this pin is an output. If the Z8 Encore! XP
F64XX Series is the SPI slave, this pin is an input. It is multiplexed with a
general-purpose I/O pin.
MOSI
MISO
I/O
I/O
Master-Out/Slave-In. This signal is the data output from the SPI master
device and the data input to the SPI slave device. It is multiplexed with a
general-purpose I/O pin.
Master-In/Slave-Out. This pin is the data input to the SPI master device and
the data output from the SPI slave device. It is multiplexed with a
general-purpose I/O pin.
UART Controllers
TXD0 / TXD1
RXD0 / RXD1
CTS0 / CTS1
DE0 / DE1
O
Transmit Data. These signals are the transmit outputs from the UARTs. The
TXD signals are multiplexed with general-purpose I/O pins.
I
Receive Data. These signals are the receiver inputs for the UARTs and
IrDAs. The RXD signals are multiplexed with general-purpose I/O pins.
I
Clear To Send. These signals are control inputs for the UARTs. The CTS
signals are multiplexed with general-purpose I/O pins.
O
Driver Enable. This signal allows automatic control of external RS-485
drivers. This signal is approximately the inverse of the Transmit Empty (TXE)
bit in the UART Status 0 register. The DE signal may be used to ensure an
external RS-485 driver is enabled when data is transmitted by the UART.
Timers
T0OUT/T1OUT/ O
T2OUT/T3OUT
Timer Output 0-3. These signals are output pins from the timers. The Timer
Output signals are multiplexed with general-purpose I/O pins. T3OUT is not
available in 44-pin package devices.
T0IN/T1IN/
T2IN/T3IN
I
Timer Input 0-3. These signals are used as the capture, gating and counter
inputs. The Timer Input signals are multiplexed with general-purpose I/O
pins. T3IN is not available in 44-pin package devices.
Analog
ANA[11:0]
I
I
Analog Input. These signals are inputs to the ADC. The ADC analog inputs
are multiplexed with general-purpose I/O pins.
VREF
Analog-to-Digital converter reference voltage input. The VREF pin must be
left unconnected (or capacitively coupled to analog ground) if the internal
voltage reference is selected as the ADC reference voltage.
Oscillators
PS019921-0308
Signal and Pin Descriptions
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
15
Table 3. Signal Descriptions (Continued)
Signal
Mnemonic
I/O
Description
XIN
I
External Crystal Input. This is the input pin to the crystal oscillator. A crystal
can be connected between it and the XOUT pin to form the oscillator. This
signal is usable with external RC networks and an external clock driver.
XOUT
O
O
External Crystal Output. This pin is the output of the crystal oscillator. A
crystal can be connected between it and the XIN pin to form the oscillator.
When the system clock is referred to in this manual, it refers to the frequency
of the signal at this pin. This pin must be left unconnected when not using a
crystal.
RCOUT
RC Oscillator Output. This signal is the output of the RC oscillator. It is
multiplexed with a general-purpose I/O pin. This signal must be left
unconnected when not using a crystal.
On-Chip Debugger
DBG
I/O
Debug. This pin is the control and data input and output to and from the On-
Chip Debugger. This pin is open-drain.
Caution:
For operation of the On-Chip Debugger, all power pins (VDD and
AVDD) must be supplied with power and all ground pins (VSS and
AVSS) must be properly grounded.
The DBG pin is open-drain and must have an external pull-up resistor
to ensure proper operation.
Reset
I
RESET. Generates a Reset when asserted (driven Low).
RESET
Power Supply
VDD
I
I
I
I
Power Supply.
Analog Power Supply.
Ground.
AVDD
VSS
AVSS
Analog Ground.
Pin Characteristics
Table 4 on page 16 provides detailed information on the characteristics for each pin
available on the Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series products and the data is sorted
alphabetically by the pin symbol mnemonic.
PS019921-0308
Signal and Pin Descriptions
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
16
Table 4. Pin Characteristics of the Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series
Active Low
or
Internal Schmitt-
Symbol
Reset
Tri-State Pull-up or Trigger
Open Drain
Output
Mnemonic Direction Direction Active High Output Pull-down
Input
AVSS
AVDD
DBG
N/A
N/A
I/O
N/A
N/A
I
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
Yes
N/A
Yes
No
No
No
No
No
No
N/A
No
N/A
Yes
N/A
Yes
No
VSS
N/A
I/O
N/A
I
PA[7:0]
Yes
Yes,
Programmable
PB[7:0]
PC[7:0]
PD[7:0]
PE7:0]
PF[7:0]
PG[7:0]
PH[3:0]
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes,
Programmable
Yes,
Programmable
Yes,
Programmable
Yes,
Programmable
Yes,
Programmable
Yes,
Programmable
Yes,
Programmable
RESET
VDD
I
I
Low
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
Pull-up
No
Yes
No
No
No
N/A
N/A
N/A
No
N/A
I
N/A
I
XIN
No
XOUT
O
O
Yes, in
STOP
mode
No
Note: x represents integer 0, 1,... to indicate multiple pins with symbol mnemonics that differ only by the integer.
PS019921-0308
Signal and Pin Descriptions
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
17
Address Space
The eZ8™ CPU can access three distinct address spaces:
•
•
•
The Register File contains addresses for the general-purpose registers and the
eZ8 CPU, peripheral, and general-purpose I/O port control registers.
The Program Memory contains addresses for all memory locations having executable
code and/or data.
The Data Memory consists of the addresses for all memory locations that hold only
data.
These three address spaces are covered briefly in the following subsections. For more
information on eZ8 CPU and its address space, refer to eZ8™ CPU Core User Manual
(UM0128) available for download at www.zilog.com.
Register File
The Register File address space in the Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series is 4 KB (4096 bytes).
The Register File is composed of two sections—control registers and general-purpose reg-
isters. When instructions are executed, registers are read from when defined as sources
and written to when defined as destinations. The architecture of the eZ8 CPU allows all
general-purpose registers to function as accumulators, address pointers, index registers,
stack areas, or scratch pad memory.
The upper 256 bytes of the 4 KB Register File address space are reserved for control of the
eZ8 CPU, the on-chip peripherals, and the I/O ports. These registers are located at
addresses from F00Hto FFFH. Some of the addresses within the 256-byte control register
section are reserved (unavailable). Reading from an reserved Register File addresses
returns an undefined value. Writing to reserved Register File addresses is not
recommended and can produce unpredictable results.
The on-chip RAM always begins at address 000H in the Register File address space. The
Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series provide 2 KB to 4 KB of on-chip RAM depending upon the
device. Reading from Register File addresses outside the available RAM addresses (and
not within the control register address space) returns an undefined value. Writing to these
Register File addresses produces no effect. To determine the amount of RAM available for
the specific Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series device, see Part Selection Guide on page 2.
Program Memory
The eZ8™ CPU supports 64 KB of Program Memory address space. The Z8 Encore! XP
F64XX Series contains 16 KB to 64 KB of on-chip Flash in the Program Memory address
space, depending upon the device. Reading from Program Memory addresses outside the
PS019921-0308
Address Space
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
18
available Flash memory addresses returns FFH. Writing to these unimplemented Program
Memory addresses produces no effect. Table 5 describes the Program Memory maps for
the Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series products.
Table 5. Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series Program Memory Maps
Program Memory Address (Hex) Function
Z8F162x Products
0000-0001
Option Bits
0002-0003
Reset Vector
0004-0005
WDT Interrupt Vector
Illegal Instruction Trap
Interrupt Vectors*
Program Memory
0006-0007
0008-0037
0038-3FFF
Z8F242x Products
0000-0001
Option Bits
0002-0003
Reset Vector
0004-0005
WDT Interrupt Vector
Illegal Instruction Trap
Interrupt Vectors*
Program Memory
0006-0007
0008-0037
0038-5FFF
Z8F322x Products
0000-0001
Option Bits
0002-0003
Reset Vector
0004-0005
WDT Interrupt Vector
Illegal Instruction Trap
Interrupt Vectors*
Program Memory
0006-0007
0008-0037
0038-7FFF
Z8F482x Products
0000-0001
Option Bits
0002-0003
Reset Vector
0004-0005
WDT Interrupt Vector
Illegal Instruction Trap
0006-0007
PS019921-0308
Address Space
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
19
Table 5. Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series Program Memory Maps (Continued)
Program Memory Address (Hex) Function
0008-0037
Interrupt Vectors*
Program Memory
0038-BFFF
Z8F642x Products
0000-0001
Option Bits
0002-0003
Reset Vector
0004-0005
WDT Interrupt Vector
Illegal Instruction Trap
Interrupt Vectors*
Program Memory
0006-0007
0008-0037
0038-FFFF
*See Table 23 on page 63 for a list of the interrupt vectors.
Data Memory
The Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series does not use the eZ8 CPU’s 64 KB Data Memory
address space.
Information Area
Table 6 on page 20 describes the Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series Information Area. This
512 byte Information Area is accessed by setting bit 7 of the Page Select Register to 1.
When access is enabled, the Information Area is mapped into the Program Memory and
overlays the 512 bytes at addresses FE00Hto FFFFH. When the Information Area access is
enabled, execution of LDC and LDCI instruction from these Program Memory addresses
return the Information Area data rather than the Program Memory data. Reads of these
addresses through the On-Chip Debugger also returns the Information Area data.
Execution of code from these addresses continues to correctly use the Program Memory.
Access to the Information Area is read-only.
PS019921-0308
Address Space
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
20
Table 6. Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series Information Area Map
Program Memory
Address (Hex)
Function
FE00H-FE3FH
FE40H-FE53H
Reserved
Part Number
20-character ASCII alphanumeric code
Left justified and filled with zeros (ASCII Null character)
FE54H-FFFFH
Reserved
PS019921-0308
Address Space
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
21
Register File Address Map
Table 7 provides the address map for the Register File of the Z8 Encore! XP F64XX
Series products. Not all devices and package styles in the Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series
support Timer 3 and all of the GPIO Ports. Consider registers for unimplemented peripher-
als as Reserved.
Table 7. Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series Register File Address Map
Address (Hex) Register Description
General-Purpose RAM
Mnemonic
Reset (Hex) Page No
000-EFF
General-Purpose Register File RAM
—
XX
Timer 0
F00
Timer 0 High Byte
T0H
00
01
FF
FF
00
00
00
00
86
86
87
87
88
88
89
90
F01
Timer 0 Low Byte
T0L
F02
Timer 0 Reload High Byte
Timer 0 Reload Low Byte
Timer 0 PWM High Byte
Timer 0 PWM Low Byte
Timer 0 Control 0
T0RH
T0RL
T0PWMH
T0PWML
T0CTL0
T0CTL1
F03
F04
F05
F06
F07
Timer 0 Control 1
Timer 1
F08
Timer 1 High Byte
T1H
00
01
FF
FF
00
00
00
00
86
86
87
87
88
88
89
90
F09
Timer 1 Low Byte
T1L
F0A
F0B
F0C
F0D
F0E
F0F
Timer 1 Reload High Byte
Timer 1 Reload Low Byte
Timer 1 PWM High Byte
Timer 1 PWM Low Byte
Timer 1 Control 0
T1RH
T1RL
T1PWMH
T1PWML
T1CTL0
T1CTL1
Timer 1 Control 1
Timer 2
F10
Timer 2 High Byte
T2H
00
01
FF
FF
00
00
00
86
86
87
87
88
88
89
F11
Timer 2 Low Byte
T2L
F12
Timer 2 Reload High Byte
Timer 2 Reload Low Byte
Timer 2 PWM High Byte
Timer 2 PWM Low Byte
Timer 2 Control 0
T2RH
T2RL
T2PWMH
T2PWML
T2CTL0
F13
F14
F15
F16
PS019921-0308
Register File Address Map
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
22
Table 7. Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series Register File Address Map (Continued)
Address (Hex) Register Description
F17 Timer 2 Control 1
Mnemonic
T2CTL1
Reset (Hex) Page No
00
90
Timer 3 (unavailable in the 44-pin packages)
F18
Timer 3 High Byte
T3H
00
01
FF
FF
00
00
00
00
XX
86
86
87
87
88
88
89
90
F19
Timer 3 Low Byte
T3L
F1A
F1B
F1C
F1D
F1E
F1F
20-3F
Timer 3 Reload High Byte
Timer 3 Reload Low Byte
Timer 3 PWM High Byte
Timer 3 PWM Low Byte
Timer 3 Control 0
T3RH
T3RL
T3PWMH
T3PWML
T3CTL0
T3CTL1
—
Timer 3 Control 1
Reserved
UART 0
F40
UART0 Transmit Data
UART0 Receive Data
UART0 Status 0
U0TXD
XX
110
111
111
113
113
111
116
116
116
U0RXD
U0STAT0
U0CTL0
U0CTL1
U0STAT1
U0ADDR
U0BRH
U0BRL
XX
F41
F42
F43
F44
F45
F46
F47
0000011Xb
UART0 Control 0
00
00
00
00
FF
FF
UART0 Control 1
UART0 Status 1
UART0 Address Compare Register
UART0 Baud Rate High Byte
UART0 Baud Rate Low Byte
UART 1
F48
UART1 Transmit Data
UART1 Receive Data
UART1 Status 0
U1TXD
XX
110
111
111
113
113
111
116
116
116
U1RXD
U1STAT0
U1CTL0
U1CTL1
U1STAT1
U1ADDR
U1BRH
U1BRL
XX
F49
F4A
F4B
F4C
F4D
F4E
F4F
0000011Xb
UART1 Control 0
00
00
00
00
FF
FF
UART1 Control 1
UART1 Status 1
UART1 Address Compare Register
UART1 Baud Rate High Byte
UART1 Baud Rate Low Byte
2
I C
2
F50
I C Data
I2CDATA
I2CSTAT
I2CCTL
I2CBRH
I2CBRL
I2CDST
I2CDIAG
—
00
80
00
FF
FF
C0
00
XX
152
153
154
156
156
157
159
2
F51
I C Status
2
F52
I C Control
2
2
2
2
F53
I C Baud Rate High Byte
F54
I C Baud Rate Low Byte
F55
I C Diagnostic State
F56
I C Diagnostic Control
F57-F5F
Reserved
Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI)
PS019921-0308
Register File Address Map
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
23
Table 7. Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series Register File Address Map (Continued)
Address (Hex) Register Description
Mnemonic
SPIDATA
SPICTL
SPISTAT
SPIMODE
SPIDST
—
SPIBRH
SPIBRL
—
Reset (Hex) Page No
F60
SPI Data
XX
00
01
00
00
XX
FF
FF
XX
133
133
135
136
137
F61
SPI Control
F62
SPI Status
F63
SPI Mode
SPI Diagnostic State
Reserved
SPI Baud Rate High Byte
SPI Baud Rate Low Byte
Reserved
F64
F65
F66
138
138
F67
F68-F6F
Analog-to-Digital Converter
F70
ADC Control
ADCCTL
—
ADCD_H
ADCD_L
—
20
175
F71
Reserved
XX
XX
XX
XX
F72
ADC Data High Byte
ADC Data Low Bits
Reserved
176
176
F73
F74-FAF
DMA 0
FB0
DMA0 Control
DMA0CTL
DMA0IO
DMA0H
00
163
165
165
166
166
FB1
DMA0 I/O Address
XX
XX
FB2
DMA0 End/Start Address High Nibble
DMA0 Start Address Low Byte
DMA0 End Address Low Byte
FB3
DMA0START XX
FB4
DMA0END
XX
DMA 1
FB8
DMA1 Control
DMA1CTL
DMA1IO
DMA1H
00
163
165
165
166
166
FB9
DMA1 I/O Address
XX
XX
FBA
FBB
FBC
DMA1 End/Start Address High Nibble
DMA1 Start Address Low Byte
DMA1 End Address Low Byte
DMA1START XX
DMA1END
XX
DMA ADC
FBD
DMA_ADC Address
DMA_ADC Control
DMA_ADC Status
DMAA_ADDR XX
DMAACTL 00
DMAASTAT 00
167
168
169
FBE
FBF
Interrupt Controller
FC0
FC1
FC2
FC3
FC4
FC5
FC6
FC7
FC8
Interrupt Request 0
IRQ0
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
67
70
70
68
71
71
69
72
72
IRQ0 Enable High Bit
IRQ0 Enable Low Bit
Interrupt Request 1
IRQ1 Enable High Bit
IRQ1 Enable Low Bit
Interrupt Request 2
IRQ2 Enable High Bit
IRQ2 Enable Low Bit
IRQ0ENH
IRQ0ENL
IRQ1
IRQ1ENH
IRQ1ENL
IRQ2
IRQ2ENH
IRQ2ENL
PS019921-0308
Register File Address Map
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
24
Table 7. Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series Register File Address Map (Continued)
Address (Hex) Register Description
Mnemonic
—
IRQES
IRQPS
IRQCTL
Reset (Hex) Page No
FC9-FCC
FCD
Reserved
XX
Interrupt Edge Select
Interrupt Port Select
Interrupt Control
00
00
00
74
74
75
FCE
FCF
GPIO Port A
FD0
Port A Address
Port A Control
Port A Input Data
Port A Output Data
PAADDR
PACTL
PAIN
00
00
XX
00
57
58
62
62
FD1
FD2
FD3
PAOUT
GPIO Port B
FD4
Port B Address
Port B Control
Port B Input Data
Port B Output Data
PBADDR
PBCTL
PBIN
00
00
XX
00
57
58
62
62
FD5
FD6
FD7
PBOUT
GPIO Port C
FD8
Port C Address
Port C Control
Port C Input Data
Port C Output Data
PCADDR
PCCTL
PCIN
00
00
XX
00
57
58
62
62
FD9
FDA
FDB
PCOUT
GPIO Port D
FDC
Port D Address
Port D Control
Port D Input Data
Port D Output Data
PDADDR
PDCTL
PDIN
00
00
XX
00
57
58
62
62
FDD
FDE
FDF
PDOUT
GPIO Port E
FE0
Port E Address
Port E Control
Port E Input Data
Port E Output Data
PEADDR
PECTL
PEIN
00
00
XX
00
57
58
62
62
FE1
FE2
FE3
PEOUT
GPIO Port F
FE4
Port F Address
Port F Control
Port F Input Data
Port F Output Data
PFADDR
PFCTL
PFIN
00
00
XX
00
57
58
62
62
FE5
FE6
FE7
PFOUT
GPIO Port G
FE8
Port G Address
Port G Control
Port G Input Data
Port G Output Data
PGADDR
PGCTL
PGIN
00
00
XX
00
57
58
62
62
FE9
FEA
FEB
PGOUT
GPIO Port H
FEC
Port H Address
Port H Control
PHADDR
PHCTL
00
00
57
58
FED
PS019921-0308
Register File Address Map
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
25
Table 7. Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series Register File Address Map (Continued)
Address (Hex) Register Description
Mnemonic
PHIN
PHOUT
Reset (Hex) Page No
FEE
FEF
Port H Input Data
XX
00
62
62
Port H Output Data
Watchdog Timer
FF0
Watchdog Timer Control
WDTCTL
WDTU
WDTH
WDTL
—
XXX00000b 96
FF1
Watchdog Timer Reload Upper Byte
Watchdog Timer Reload High Byte
Watchdog Timer Reload Low Byte
Reserved
FF
FF
FF
XX
97
97
97
FF2
FF3
FF4-FF7
Flash Memory Controller
FF8
FF8
FF9
Flash Control
FCTL
FSTAT
FPS
00
00
00
00
00
00
XX
186
186
187
188
188
188
Flash Status
Page Select
FF9 (if enabled) Flash Sector Protect
FPROT
FFA
Flash Programming Frequency High Byte FFREQH
Flash Programming Frequency Low Byte FFREQL
Reserved
FFB
FF4-FF8
—
Read-Only Memory Controller
FF9
Page Select
Reserved
RPS
—
00
XX
FFA-FFB
eZ8 CPU
™
FFC
Flags
—
XX
XX
XX
XX
Refer to eZ8
FFD
Register Pointer
Stack Pointer High Byte
Stack Pointer Low Byte
RP
CPU Core
User Manual
(UM0128)
FFE
SPH
SPL
FFF
Note: XX=Undefined
PS019921-0308
Register File Address Map
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
26
Control Register
Summary
Timer 0 Control 1
T0CTL1 (F07H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Timer Mode
000 = One-Shot mode
001 = CONTINUOUS mode
010 = COUNTER mode
011 = PWM mode
Timer 0 High Byte
T0H (F00H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
100 = CAPTURE mode
101 = COMPARE mode
110 = GATED mode
Timer 0 current count value [15:8]
111 = Capture/COMPARE mode
Prescale Value
000 = Divide by 1
001 = Divide by 2
010 = Divide by 4
011 = Divide by 8
100 = Divide by 16
101 = Divide by 32
110 = Divide by 64
111 = Divide by 128
Timer 0 Low Byte
T0L (F01H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Timer 0 current count value [7:0]
Timer Input/Output Polarity
Timer 0 Reload High Byte
T0RH (F02H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Operation of this bit is a function of
the current operating mode of the
timer
Timer 0 reload value [15:8]
Timer Enable
0 = Timer is disabled
1 = Timer is enabled
Timer 0 Reload Low Byte
T0RL (HF03 - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Timer 1 High Byte
T1H (F08H - Read/Write)
Timer 0 reload value [7:0]
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Timer 1 current count value [15:8]
Timer 0 PWM High Byte
T0PWMH (F04H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Timer 1 Low Byte
T1L (F09H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Timer 0 PWM value [15:8]
Timer 1 current count value [7:0]
Timer 0 Control 0
T0CTL0 (F06H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Timer 1 Reload High Byte
T1RH (F0AH - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Reserved
Cascade Timer
Timer 1 reload value [15:8]
0 = Timer 0 Input signal is GPIO pin
1 = Timer 0 Input signal is Timer 3
out
Reserved
Timer 1 Reload Low Byte
T1RL (F0BH - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Timer 1 reload value [7:0]
PS019921-0308
Control Register Summary
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
27
Timer 1 PWM High Byte
T1PWMH (F0CH - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Timer 2 High Byte
T2H (F10H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Timer 1 PWM value [15:8]
Timer 2 current count value [15:8]
Timer 1 PWM Low Byte
T1PWML (F0DH - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Timer 2 Low Byte
T2L (F11H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Timer 1 PWM value [7:0]
Timer 2 current count value [7:0]
Timer 1 Control 0
Timer 2 Reload High Byte
T2RH (F12H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
T1CTL0 (F0EH - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Reserved
Timer 2 reload value [15:8]
Cascade Timer
0 = Timer 1 Input signal is GPIO pin
1 = Timer 1 Input signal is Timer 0
Timer 2 Reload Low Byte
T2RL (F13H- Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
out
Reserved
Timer 2 reload value [7:0]
Timer 1 Control 1
T1CTL1 (F0FH - Read/Write)
Timer 2 PWM High Byte
T2PWMH (F14H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Timer Mode
000 = One-Shot mode
001 = CONTINUOUS mode
010 = COUNTER mode
011 = PWM mode
Timer 2 PWM value [15:8]
100 = CAPTURE mode
101 = COMPARE mode
110 = GATED mode
Timer 2 PWM Low Byte
T2PWML (F15H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
111 = Capture/COMPARE mode
Prescale Value
000 = Divide by 1
001 = Divide by 2
010 = Divide by 4
011 = Divide by 8
100 = Divide by 16
101 = Divide by 32
110 = Divide by 64
111 = Divide by 128
Timer 2 PWM value [7:0]
Timer 2 Control 0
T2CTL0 (F16H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Timer Input/Output Polarity
Reserved
Operation of this bit is a function of
Cascade Timer
the current operating mode of the
timer
0 = Timer 2 Input signal is GPIO pin
1 = Timer 2 Input signal is Timer 1
out
Reserved
Timer Enable
0 = Timer is disabled
1 = Timer is enabled
PS019921-0308
Control Register Summary
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
28
Timer 2 Control 1
Timer 3 PWM High Byte
T2CTL1 (F17H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
T3PWMH (F1CH - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Timer Mode
Timer 3 PWM value [15:8]
000 = One-Shot mode
001 = CONTINUOUS mode
010 = COUNTER mode
011 = PWM mode
Timer 3 PWM Low Byte
T3PWML (F1DH - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
100 = CAPTURE mode
101 = COMPARE mode
110 = GATED mode
111 = CAPTURE/COMPARE mode
Timer 3 PWM value [7:0]
Prescale Value
000 = Divide by 1
001 = Divide by 2
010 = Divide by 4
011 = Divide by 8
100 = Divide by 16
101 = Divide by 32
110 = Divide by 64
111 = Divide by 128
Timer 3 Control 0
T3CTL0 (F1EH - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Reserved
Cascade Timer
Timer Input/Output Polarity
0 = Timer 3 Input signal is GPIO pin
Operation of this bit is a function of
1 = Timer 3 Input signal is Timer 2
the current operating mode of the
out
Reserved
timer
Timer Enable
0 = Timer is disabled
1 = Timer is enabled
Timer 3 Control 1
T3CTL1 (F1FH - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Timer 3 High Byte
T3H (F18H - Read/Write)
Timer Mode
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
000 = One-Shot mode
001 = CONTINUOUS mode
010 = COUNTER mode
011 = PWM mode
Timer 3 current count value [15:8]
100 = CAPTURE mode
101 = COMPARE mode
110 = GATED mode
Timer 3 Low Byte
111 = Capture/COMPARE mode
T3L (F19H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Prescale Value
000 = Divide by 1
001 = Divide by 2
010 = Divide by 4
011 = Divide by 8
100 = Divide by 16
101 = Divide by 32
110 = Divide by 64
111 = Divide by 128
Timer 3 current count value [7:0]
Timer 3 Reload High Byte
T3RH (F1AH - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Timer Input/Output Polarity
Timer 3 reload value [15:8]
Operation of this bit is a function of
the current operating mode of the
timer
Timer 3 Reload Low Byte
T3RL (F1BH - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Timer Enable
0 = Timer is disabled
1 = Timer is enabled
Timer 3 reload value [7:0]
PS019921-0308
Control Register Summary
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
29
UART0 Transmit Data
U0TXD (F40H - Write Only)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
UART0 Control 0
U0CTL0 (F42H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
UART0 transmitter data byte [7:0]
Loop Back Enable
0 = Normal operation
1 = Transmit data is looped back to
the receiver
UART0 Receive Data
U0RXD (F40H - Read Only)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Stop Bit Select
0 = Transmitter sends 1 Stop bit
1 = Transmitter sends 2 Stop bits
UART0 receiver data byte [7:0]
Send Break
0 = No break is sent
1 = Output of the transmitter is zero
UART0 Status 0
Parity Select
0 = Even parity
1 = Odd parity
U0STAT0 (F41H - Read Only)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Parity Enable
CTS signal
0 = Parity is disabled
1 = Parity is enabled
Returns the level of the CTS signal
Transmitter Empty
CTS Enable
0 = Data is currently transmitting
1 = Transmission is complete
0 = CTS signal has no effect on the
transmitter
1 = UART recognizes CTS signal as
Transmitter Data Register Empty
0 = Transmit Data Register is full
1 = Transmit Data register is empty
a
transmit enable control signal
Receive Enable
Break Detect
0 = Receiver disabled
1 = Receiver enabled
0 = No break occurred
1 = A break occurred
Transmit Enable
Framing Error
0 = Transmitter disabled
1 = Transmitter enabled
0 = No framing error occurred
1 = A framing occurred
Overrun Error
0 = No overrun error occurred
1 = An overrun error occurred
Parity Error
0 = No parity error occurred
1 = A parity error occurred
Receive Data Available
0 = Receive Data Register is empty
1 = A byte is available in the Receive
Data Register
PS019921-0308
Control Register Summary
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
30
UART0 Address Compare
U0ADDR (F45H - Read/Write)
UART0 Control 1
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
U0CTL1 (F43H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
UART0 Address Compare [7:0]
Infrared Encoder/Decoder Enable
0 = Infrared endec is disabled
1 = Infrared endec is enabled
Received Data Interrupt Enable
0 = Received data and errors
UART0 Baud Rate Generator High Byte
U0BRH (F46H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
generate
interrupt requests
1 = Only errors generate interrupt
requests. Received data does
UART0 Baud Rate divisor [15:8]
not.
Baud Rate Registers Control
UART0 Baud Rate Generator Low Byte
U0BRL (F47H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Refer to UART chapter for operation
Driver Enable Polarity
0 = DE signal is active High
1 = DE signal is active Low
UART0 Baud Rate divisor [7:0]
Multiprocessor Bit Transmit
0 = Send a 0 as the multiprocessor
UART1 Transmit Data
U1TXD (F48H - Write Only)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
bit
1 = Send a 1 as the multiprocessor
bit
Multiprocessor Mode [0]
UART1 transmitter data byte[7:0]
See Multiprocessor Mode [1] below
Multiprocessor (9-bit) Enable
0 = Multiprocessor mode is disabled
1 = Multiprocessor mode is enabled
UART1 Receive Data
U1RXD (F48H - Read Only)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Multiprocessor Mode [1]
with Multiprocess Mode bit 0:
00 = Interrupt on all received bytes
01 = Interrupt only on address bytes
10 = Interrupt on address match and
following data
UART receiver data byte [7:0]
11 = Interrupt on data following an
address match
UART0 Status 1
U0STAT1 (F44H - Read Only)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Mulitprocessor Receive
Returns value of last multiprocessor
bit
New Frame
0 = Current byte is not start of frame
1 = Current byte is start of new
frame
Reserved
PS019921-0308
Control Register Summary
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
31
UART1 Status 0
UART1 Control 0
U1STAT0 (F49H - Read Only)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
U1CTL0 (F4AH - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
CTS signal
Loop Back Enable
Returns the level of the CTS signal
0 = Normal operation
1 = Transmit data is looped back to
the receiver
Transmitter Empty
0 = Data is currently transmitting
1 = Transmission is complete
Stop Bit Select
0 = Transmitter sends 1 Stop bit
1 = Transmitter sends 2 Stop bits
Transmitter Data Register Empty
0 = Transmit Data Register is full
1 = Transmit Data register is empty
Send Break
0 = No break is sent
1 = Output of the transmitter is zero
Break Detect
0 = No break occurred
1 = A break occurred
Parity Select
0 = Even parity
1 = Odd parity
Framing Error
0 = No framing error occurred
1 = A framing occurred
Parity Enable
0 = Parity is disabled
1 = Parity is enabled
Overrun Error
0 = No overrun error occurred
1 = An overrun error occurred
CTS Enable
0 = CTS signal has no effect on the
transmitter
Parity Error
1 = UART recognizes CTS signal as
0 = No parity error occurred
1 = A parity error occurred
a
transmit enable control signal
Receive Data Available
0 = Receive Data Register is empty
1 = A byte is available in the Receive
Data Register
Receive Enable
0 = Receiver disabled
1 = Receiver enabled
Transmit Enable
0 = Transmitter disabled
1 = Transmitter enabled
PS019921-0308
Control Register Summary
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
32
UART1 Address Compare
U0ADDR (F4DH - Read/Write)
UART1 Control 1
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
U0CTL1 (F4BH - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
UART1 Address Compare [7:0]
Infrared Encoder/Decoder Enable
0 = Infrared endec is disabled
1 = Infrared endec is enabled
Received Data Interrupt Enable
0 = Received data and errors
UART1 Baud Rate Generator High Byte
U0BRH (F4EH - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
generate
interrupt requests
1 = Only errors generate interrupt
requests. Received data does
UART1 Baud Rate divisor [15:8]
not.
Baud Rate Registers Control
UART1 Baud Rate Generator Low Byte
U1BRL (F4FH - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Refer to UART chapter for operation
Driver Enable Polarity
0 = DE signal is active High
1 = DE signal is active Low
UART1 Baud Rate divisor [7:0]
Multiprocessor Bit Transmit
0 = Send a 0 as the multiprocessor
2
I C Data
bit
1 = Send a 1 as the multiprocessor
bit
I2CDATA (F50H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Multiprocessor Mode [0]
I2C data [7:0]
See Multiprocessor Mode [1] below
Multiprocessor (9-bit) Enable
0 = Multiprocessor mode is disabled
1 = Multiprocessor mode is enabled
Multiprocessor Mode [1]
with Multiprocess Mode bit 0:
00 = Interrupt on all received bytes
01 = Interrupt only on address bytes
10 = Interrupt on address match and
following data
11 = Interrupt on data following an
address match
UART1 Status 1
U0STAT1 (F4CH - Read Only)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Mulitprocessor Receive
Returns value of last multiprocessor
bit
New Frame
0 = Current byte is not start of frame
1 = Current byte is start of new
frame
Reserved
PS019921-0308
Control Register Summary
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
33
2
I C Status
2
I2CSTAT (F51H - Read Only)
I C Control
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
I2CCTL (F52H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
NACK Interrupt
0 = No action required to service
I2C Signal Filter Enable
NAK
0 = Digital filtering disabled
1 = START/STOP not set after NAK
1 = Low-pass digital filters enabled
on SDA and SCL input signals
Data Shift State
0 = Data is not being transferred
1 = Data is being transferred
Flush Data
0 = No effect
1 = Clears I2C Data register
Transmit Address State
0 = Address is not being transferred
1 = Address is being transferred
Send NAK
0 = Do not send NAK
1 = Send NAK after next byte
Read
received
0 = Write operation
1 = Read operation
from slave
Enable TDRE Interrupts
10-Bit Address
0 = Do not generate an interrupt
0 = 7-bit address being transmitted
1 = 10-bit address being transmitted
when
the I2C Data register is empty
1 = Generate an interrupt when the
Acknowledge
I2C
0 = Acknowledge not
transmitted/received
1 = For last byte, Acknowledge was
transmitted/received
Transmit Data register is empty
Baud Rate Generator Interrupt
0 = Interrupts behave as set by I2C
control
Receive Data Register Full
1 = BRG generates an interrupt
0 = I2C has not received data
when
1 = Data register contains received
it counts down to zero
data
Send Stop Condition
Transmit Data Register Empty
0 = Data register is full
0 = Do not issue Stop condition after
data transmission is complete
1 = Issue Stop condition after data
transmission is complete
1 = Data register is empty
Send Start Condition
0 = Do not send Start Condition
1 = Send Start Condition
I2C Enable
0 = I2C is disabled
1 = I2C is enabled
I2C Baud Rate Generator High Byte
I2CBRH (F53H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
I2C Baud Rate divisor [15:8]
I2C Baud Rate Generator Low Byte
I2CBRL (F54H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
I2C Baud Rate divisor [7:0]
PS019921-0308
Control Register Summary
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
34
SPI Data
SPI Status
SPIDATA (F60H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
SPISTAT (F62H - Read Only)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
SPI Data [7:0]
Slave Select
0 = If Slave, SS pin is asserted
1 = If Slave, SS pin is not asserted
Transmit Status
SPI Control
0 = No data transmission in progress
SPICTL (F61H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
1 = Data transmission now in
progress
Reserved
SPI Enable
0 = SPI disabled
1 = SPI enabled
Slave Mode Transaction Abort
0 = No slave mode transaction abort
detected
Master Mode Enabled
0 = SPI configured in Slave mode
1 = SPI configured in Master mode
1 = Slave mode transaction abort
was
detected
Wire-OR (open-drain) Mode
0 = SPI signals not configured for
open-drain
Collision
0 = No multi-master collision
1 = SPI signals (SCK, SS, MISO,
detected
and
1 = Multi-master collision was
MOSI) configured for open-
detected
drain
Overrun
Clock Polarity
0 = No overrun error detected
1 = Overrun error was detected
0 = SCK idles Low
1 = SPI idles High
Interrupt Request
Phase Select
0 = No SPI interrupt request pending
1 = SPI interrupt request is pending
Sets the phase relationship of the
data
to the clock.
BRG Timer Interrupt Request
0 = BRG timer function is disabled
1 = BRG time-out interrupt is
enabled
SPI Mode
SPIMODE (F63H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Start an SPI Interrupt Request
0 = No effect
Slave Select Value
If Master and SPIMODE[1] = 1:
0 = SS pin driven Low
1 = Generate an SPI interrupt
1 = SS pin driven High
request
Slave Select I/O
Interrupt Request Enable
0 = SS pin configured as an input
1 = SS pin configured as an output
(Master mode only)
0 = SPI interrupt requests are
disabled
1 = SPI interrupt requests are
enabled
Number of Data Bits Per Character
000 = 8 bits
001 = 1 bit
010 = 2 bits
011 = 3 bits
100 = 4 bits
101 = 5 bit
110 = 6 bits
PS019921-0308
Control Register Summary
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
35
SPI Mode
ADC Control
SPIMODE (F63H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
111 = 7 bits
ADCCTL (F70H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Analog Input Select
Diagnostic Mode Control
0000 = ANA0
0010 = ANA2
0100 = ANA4
0110 = ANA6
1000 = ANA8
0001 = ANA1
0011 = ANA3
0101 = ANA5
0111 = ANA7
1001 = ANA9
0 = Reading from SPIBRH, SPIBRL
returns reload values
1 = Reading from SPIBRH, SPIBRL
returns current BRG count value
1010 = ANA10 1011 = ANA11
11xx = Reserved
Reserved
Continuous Mode Select
0 = Single-shot conversion
1 = Continuous conversion
SPI Diagnostic State
External VREF select
SPIDST (F64H - Read Only)
0 = Internal voltage reference
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
selected
1 = External voltage reference
SPI State
selected
Transmit Clock Enable
Reserved
0 = Internal transmit clock enable
signal is deasserted
Conversion Enable
1 = Internal transmit clock enable
signal is asserted
0 = Conversion is complete
1 = Begin conversion
Shift Clock Enable
0 = Internal shift clock enable signal
is deasserted
1 = Internal shift clock enable signal
is asserted
ADC Data High Byte
ADCD_H (F72H - Read Only)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
SPI Baud Rate Generator High Byte
ADC Data [9:2]
SPIBRH (F66H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
ADC Data Low Bits
SPI Baud Rate divisor [15:8]
ADCD_L (F73H - Read Only)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
SPI Baud Rate Generator Low Byte
SPIBRL (F67H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Reserved
ADC Data [1:0]
SPI Baud Rate divisor [7:0]
PS019921-0308
Control Register Summary
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
36
DMA0 Control
DMA0CTL (FB0H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
DMA0 Address High Nibble
DMA0H (FB2H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Request Trigger Source Select
000 = Timer 0
DMA0 Start Address [11:8]
001 = Timer 1
010 = Timer 2
DMA0 End Address [11:8]
011 = Timer 3
100 = UART0 Received Data
register
contains valid data
DMA0 Start/Current Address Low Byte
DMA0START (FB3H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
101 = UART1 Received Data
register
contains valid data
110 = I2C receiver contains valid
DMA0 Start Address [7:0]
data
111 = Reserved
Word Select
DMA0 End Address Low Byte
DMA0END (FB4H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
0 = DMA transfers 1 byte per
request
1 = DMA transfers 2 bytes per
request
DMA0 End Address [7:0]
DMA0 Interrupt Enable
0 = DMA0 does not generate
interrupts
1 = DMA0 generates an interrupt
when
End Address data is transferred
DMA0 Data Transfer Direction
0 = Register File to peripheral
registers
1 = Peripheral registers to Register
File
DMA0 Loop Enable
0 = DMA disables after End Address
1 = DMA reloads Start Address after
End Address and continues to
run
DMA0 Enable
0 = DMA0 is disabled
1 = DMA0 is enabled
DMA0 I/O Address
DMA0IO (FB1H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
DMA0 Peripheral Register Address
Low byte of on-chip peripheral
control
registers on Register File page FH
PS019921-0308
Control Register Summary
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
37
DMA1 Control
DMA1 Address High Nibble
DMA1CTL (FB8H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
DMA1H (FBAH - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Request Trigger Source Select
DMA1 Start Address [11:8]
000 = Timer 0
001 = Timer 1
DMA1 End Address [11:8]
010 = Timer 2
011 = Timer 3
100 = UART0 Transmit Data register
is empty
DMA1 Start/Current Address Low Byte
DMA1START (FBBH - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
101 = UART1 Transmit Data register
is empty
110 = I2C Transmit Data register
is empty
DMA1 Start Address [7:0]
111 = Reserved
Word Select
0 = DMA transfers 1 byte per
DMA1 End Address Low Byte
DMA1END (FBCH - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
request
1 = DMA transfers 2 bytes per
request
DMA1 Interrupt Enable
DMA1 End Address [7:0]
0 = DMA1 does not generate
interrupts
1 = DMA1 generates an interrupt
DMA_ADC Address
when
End Address data is transferred
DMAA_ADDR (FBDH - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
DMA1 Data Transfer Direction
0 = Register File to peripheral
Reserved
registers
1 = Peripheral registers to Register
DMA_ADC Address
File
DMA1 Loop Enable
0 = DMA disables after End Address
1 = DMA reloads Start Address after
End Address and continues to
run
DMA1 Enable
0 = DMA1 is disabled
1 = DMA1 is enabled
DMA1 I/O Address
DMA1IO (FB9H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
DMA1 Peripheral Register Address
Low byte of on-chip peripheral
control
registers on Register File page FH
PS019921-0308
Control Register Summary
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
38
DMA_ADC Control
Interrupt Request 0
DMAACTL (FBEH - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
IRQ0 (FC0H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
ADC Analog Input Number
ADC Interrupt Request
0000 = Analog input 0 updated
0001 = Analog input 0-1 updated
0010 = Analog input 0-2 updated
0011 = Analog input 0-3 updated
0100 = Analog input 0-4 updated
0101 = Analog input 0-5 updated
0100 = Analog input 0-6 updated
0101 = Analog input 0-7 updated
1000 = Analog input 0-8 updated
1001 = Analog input 0-9 updated
1010 = Analog input 0-10 updated
1011 = Analog inputs 0-11 updated
11xx = Reserved
SPI Interrupt Request
I2C Interrupt Request
UART 0 Transmitter Interrupt
UART 0 Receiver Interrupt Request
Timer 0 Interrupt Request
Timer 1 Interrupt Request
Timer 2 Interrupt Request
Reserved
For all of the above peripherals:
0 = Peripheral IRQ is not pending
1 = Peripheral IRQ is awaiting
service
Interrupt request enable
0 = DMA_ADC does not generate
interrupt requests
1 = DMA_ADC generates interrupt
requests after last analog input
DMA_ADC Enable
IRQ0 Enable High Bit
0 = DMA_ADC is disabled
1 = DMA_ADC is enabled
IRQ0ENH (FC1H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
ADC IRQ Enable Hit Bit
DMA Status
DMAA_STAT (FBFH - Read Only)
SPI IRQ Enable High Bit
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
I2C IRQ Enable High Bit
DMA0 Interrupt Request Indicator
UART 0 Transmitter IRQ Enable
UART 0 Receiver IRQ Enable High
Timer 0 IRQ Enable High Bit
Timer 1 IRQ Enable High Bit
Timer 2 IRQ Enable High Bit
0 = DMA0 is not the source of the
IRQ
1 = DMA0 is the source of the IRQ
DMA1 Interrupt Request Indicator
0 = DMA1 is not the source of the
IRQ
1 = DMA1 is the source of the IRQ
DMA_ADC Interrupt Request
0 = DMA_ADC is not the source of
the
IRQ
1 = DMA_ADC is the source of the
IRQ
Reserved
Current ADC analog input
Identifies the analog input the ADC
is
currently converting
PS019921-0308
Control Register Summary
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
39
Interrupt Request 2
IRQ0 Enable Low Bit
IRQ2 (FC6H - Read/Write)
IRQ0ENL (FC2H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Port C Pin Interrupt Request
ADC IRQ Enable Hit Bit
0 = IRQ from corresponding pin [3:0]
is not pending
SPI IRQ Enable Low Bit
1 = IRQ from corresponding pin [3:0]
is awaiting service
I2C IRQ Enable Low Bit
DMA Interrupt Request
UART 0 Transmitter IRQ Enable
UART 0 Receiver IRQ Enable Low
Timer 0 IRQ Enable Low Bit
Timer 1 IRQ Enable Low Bit
Timer 2 IRQ Enable Low Bit
UART 1 Transmitter Interrupt
UART 1 Receiver Interrupt Request
Timer 3 Interrupt Request
For all of the above peripherals:
0 = Peripheral IRQ is not pending
1 = Peripheral IRQ is awaiting
service
Interrupt Request 1
IRQ1 (FC3H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
IRQ2 Enable High Bit
IRQ2ENH (FC7H - Read/Write)
Port A or D Pin Interrupt Request
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
0 = IRQ from corresponding pin [7:0]
is not pending
Port C Pin IRQ Enable High Bit
1 = IRQ from corresponding pin [7:0]
is awaiting service
DMA IRQ Enable High Bit
UART 1 Transmitter IRQ Enable
UART 1 Receiver IRQ Enable High
Timer 3 IRQ Enable High Bit
IRQ1 Enable High Bit
IRQ1ENH (FC4H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Port A or D Pin IRQ Enable High Bit
IRQ2 Enable Low Bit
IRQ2ENL (FC8H - Read/Write)
IRQ1 Enable Low Bit
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
IRQ1ENL (FC5H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Port C Pin IRQ Enable Low Bit
Port A or D Pin IRQ Enable Low Bit
DMA IRQ Enable Low Bit
UART 1 Transmitter IRQ Enable
UART 1 Receiver IRQ Enable Low
Timer 3 IRQ Enable Low Bit
Interrupt Edge Select
IRQES (FCDH - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Port A or D Interrupt Edge Select
0 = Falling edge
1 = Rising edge
PS019921-0308
Control Register Summary
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
40
Interrupt Port Select
IRQPS (FCEH - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Port B Address
PBADDR (FD4H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Port A or D Port Pin Select [7:0]
Port B Address[7:0]
0 = Port A pin is the interrupt source
1 = Port D pin is the interrupt source
Selects Port Sub-Registers:
00H = No function
01H = Data direction
02H = Alternate function
03H = Output control (open-drain)
04H = High drive enable
05H = Stop Mode Recovery enable
06H-FFH = No function
Interrupt Control
IRQCTL (FCFH - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Reserved
Port B Control
Interrupt Request Enable
PBCTL (FD5H - Read/Write)
0 = Interrupts are disabled
1 = Interrupts are enabled
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Port B Control[7:0]
Provides Access to Port Sub-
Registers
Port A Address
PAADDR (FD0H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Port B Input Data
Port A Address[7:0]
PBIN (FD6H - Read Only)
Selects Port Sub-Registers:
00H = No function
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
01H = Data direction
02H = Alternate function
03H = Output control (open-drain)
04H = High drive enable
05H = Stop Mode Recovery enable
06H-FFH = No function
Port B Input Data [7:0]
Port B Output Data
PBOUT (FD7H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Port A Control
Port B Output Data [7:0]
PACTL (FD1H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Port A Control[7:0]
Port C Address
Provides Access to Port Sub-
Registers
PCADDR (FD8H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Port C Address[7:0]
Selects Port Sub-Registers:
00H = No function
Port A Input Data
PAIN (FD2H - Read Only)
01H = Data direction
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
02H = Alternate function
03H = Output control (open-drain)
04H = High drive enable
05H = Stop Mode Recovery enable
06H-FFH = No function
Port A Input Data [7:0]
Port A Output Data
PAOUT (FD3H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Port A Output Data [7:0]
PS019921-0308
Control Register Summary
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
41
Port C Control
Port D Output Data
PCCTL (FD9H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
PDOUT (FDFH - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Port C Control[7:0]
Port D Output Data [7:0]
Provides Access to Port Sub-
Registers
Port E Address
PEADDR (FE0H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Port C Input Data
PCIN (FDAH - Read Only)
Port E Address[7:0]
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Selects Port Sub-Registers:
00H = No function
Port C Input Data [7:0]
01H = Data direction
02H = Alternate function
03H = Output control (open-drain)
04H = High drive enable
05H = Stop Mode Recovery enable
06H-FFH = No function
Port C Output Data
PCOUT (FDBH - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Port C Output Data [7:0]
Port E Control
PECTL (FE1H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Port D Address
PDADDR (FDCH - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Port E Control[7:0]
Provides Access to Port Sub-
Registers
Port D Address[7:0]
Selects Port Sub-Registers:
00H = No function
01H = Data direction
Port E Input Data
02H = Alternate function
03H = Output control (open-drain)
04H = High drive enable
05H = Stop Mode Recovery enable
06H-FFH = No function
PEIN (FE2H - Read Only)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Port E Input Data [7:0]
Port D Control
Port E Output Data
PDCTL (FDDH - Read/Write)
PEOUT (FE3H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Port D Control[7:0]
Port E Output Data [7:0]
Provides Access to Port Sub-
Registers
Port F Address
PFADDR (FE4H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Port D Input Data
PDIN (FDE H- Read Only)
Port F Address[7:0]
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Selects Port Sub-Registers:
00H = No function
Port D Input Data [7:0]
01H = Data direction
02H = Alternate function
03H = Output control (open-drain)
04H = High drive enable
05H = Stop Mode Recovery enable
06H-FFH = No function
PS019921-0308
Control Register Summary
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
42
Port F Control
Port G Output Data
PFCTL (FE5H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
PGOUT (FEBH - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Port F Control[7:0]
Port G Output Data [7:0]
Provides Access to Port Sub-
Registers
Port H Address
PHADDR (FECH - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Port F Input Data
PFIN (FE6H - Read Only)
Port H Address[7:0]
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Selects Port Sub-Registers:
00H = No function
Port F Input Data [7:0]
01H = Data direction
02H = Alternate function
03H = Output control (open-drain)
04H = High drive enable
05H = Stop Mode Recovery enable
06H-FFH = No function
Port F Output Data
PFOUT (FE7H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Port F Output Data [7:0]
Port H Control
PHCTL (FEDH - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Port G Address
PGADDR (FE8H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Port H Control [3:0]
Provides Access to Port Sub-
Registers
Port G Address[7:0]
Selects Port Sub-Registers:
00H = No function
Reserved
01H = Data direction
02H = Alternate function
03H = Output control (open-drain)
04H = High drive enable
05H = Stop Mode Recovery enable
06H-FFH = No function
Port H Input Data
PHIN (FEEH - Read Only)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Port H Input Data [3:0]
Reserved
Port G Control
PGCTL (FE9H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Port H Output Data
Port G Control[7:0]
PHOUT (FEFH - Read/Write)
Provides Access to Port Sub-
Registers
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Port H Output Data [3:0]
Reserved
Port G Input Data
PGIN (FEAH - Read Only)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Port G Input Data [7:0]
PS019921-0308
Control Register Summary
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
43
Watchdog Timer Control
WDTCTL (FF0H - Read Only)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Flash Status
FSTAT (FF8H - Read Only)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
SM Configuration Indicator
Flash Controller Status
Reserved
00_0000 = Flash controller locked
00_0001 = First unlock received
00_0010 = Second unlock received
00_0011 = Flash controller unlocked
00_0100 = Flash Sector Protect
EXT
0 = Reset not generated by RESET
pin
1 = Reset generated by RESET pin
register
WDT
selected
0 = WDT timeout has not occurred
1 = WDT timeout occurred
00_1xxx = Programming in progress
01_0xxx = Page erase in progress
10_0xxx = Mass erase in progress
STOP
0 = SMR has not occurred
1 = SMR has occurred
Reserved
POR
0 = POR has not occurred
1 = POR has occurred
Page Select
FPS (FF9H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Page Select [6:0]
Watchdog Timer Reload Upper Byte
Identifies the Flash memory page for
Page Erase operation.
WDTU (FF1H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Information Area Enable
WDT reload value [23:16]
0 = Information Area access is
disabled
1 = Information Area access is
enabled
Watchdog Timer Reload Middle Byte
WDTH (FF2 H- Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Flash Sector Protect
WDT reload value [15:8]
FPROT (FF9H - Read/Write to 1’s)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Flash Sector Protect [7:0]
Watchdog Timer Reload Low Byte
WDTL (FF3H - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
0 = Sector can be programmed or
erased from user code
1 = Sector is protected and cannot
be
WDT reload value [7:0]
programmed or erased from
user
code
Flash Control
FCTL (FF8H - Write Only)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Flash Frequency High Byte
FFREQH (FFAH - Read/Write)
Flash Command
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
73H = First unlock command
8CH = Second unlock command
95H = Page erase command
63H = Mass erase command
5EH = Flash Sector Protect reg
Flash Frequency value [15:8]
select
Flash Frequency Low Byte
FFREQL (FFBH - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Flash Frequency value [7:0]
PS019921-0308
Control Register Summary
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
44
Flags
FLAGS (FFC - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
F1 - User Flag 1
F2 - User Flag 2
H - Half Carry
D - Decimal Adjust
V - Overflow Flag
S - Sign Flag
Z - Zero Flag
C - Carry Flag
Register Pointer
RP (FFDH - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Working Register Page Address
Working Register Group Address
Stack Pointer High Byte
SPH (FFEH - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Stack Pointer [15:8]
Stack Pointer Low Byte
SPL (FFFH - Read/Write)
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Stack Pointer [7:0]
PS019921-0308
Control Register Summary
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
45
Reset and Stop Mode Recovery
The Reset Controller within the Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series controls Reset and Stop
Mode Recovery operation. In typical operation, the following events cause a Reset to
occur:
•
•
•
Power-On Reset
Voltage Brownout
Watchdog Timer time-out (when configured via the WDT_RES Option Bit to initiate
a Reset)
•
•
External RESET pin assertion
On-Chip Debugger initiated Reset (OCDCTL[0] set to 1)
When the Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series devices are in STOP mode, a Stop Mode Recov-
ery is initiated by either of the following:
•
•
•
Watchdog Timer time-out
GPIO Port input pin transition on an enabled Stop Mode Recovery source
DBG pin driven Low
Reset Types
The Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series provides two different types of reset operation (system
reset and Stop Mode Recovery). The type of Reset is a function of both the current operat-
ing mode of the Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series devices and the source of the Reset. Table 8
lists the types of Reset and their operating characteristics.
Table 8. Reset and Stop Mode Recovery Characteristics and Latency
Reset Characteristics and Latency
™
Reset Type
Control Registers
eZ8 CPU Reset Latency (Delay)
System reset
Reset (as applicable) Reset
66 WDT Oscillator cycles + 16 System Clock cycles
66 WDT Oscillator cycles + 16 System Clock cycles
Stop Mode
Recovery
Unaffected, except
WDT_CTL register
Reset
PS019921-0308
Reset and Stop Mode Recovery
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
46
System Reset
During a system reset, the Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series devices are held in Reset for 66
cycles of the Watchdog Timer oscillator followed by 16 cycles of the system clock. At the
beginning of Reset, all GPIO pins are configured as inputs.
During Reset, the eZ8 CPU and on-chip peripherals are idle; however, the on-chip crystal
oscillator and Watchdog Timer oscillator continue to run. The system clock begins
operating following the Watchdog Timer oscillator cycle count. The eZ8 CPU and on-chip
peripherals remain idle through the 16 cycles of the system clock.
Upon Reset, control registers within the Register File that have a defined Reset value are
loaded with their reset values. Other control registers (including the Stack Pointer,
Register Pointer, and Flags) and general-purpose RAM are undefined following Reset.
The eZ8 CPU fetches the Reset vector at Program Memory addresses 0002Hand 0003H
and loads that value into the Program Counter. Program execution begins at the Reset
vector address.
Reset Sources
Table 9 lists the reset sources as a function of the operating mode. The text following pro-
vides more detailed information on the individual Reset sources. A Power-On Reset/Volt-
age Brownout event always takes priority over all other possible reset sources to ensure a
full system reset occurs.
Table 9. Reset Sources and Resulting Reset Type
Operating Mode
Reset Source
Reset Type
NORMAL or HALT
modes
Power-On Reset/Voltage
Brownout
system reset
Watchdog Timer time-out
when configured for Reset
system reset
system reset
RESET pin assertion
On-Chip Debugger initiated Reset system reset except the On-Chip Debugger is
(OCDCTL[0] set to 1)
unaffected by the reset
system reset
STOP mode
Power-On Reset/Voltage
Brownout
RESET pin assertion
DBG pin driven Low
system reset
system reset
PS019921-0308
Reset and Stop Mode Recovery
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
47
Power-On Reset
Each device in the Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series contains an internal Power-On Reset cir-
cuit. The POR circuit monitors the supply voltage and holds the device in the Reset state
until the supply voltage reaches a safe operating level. After the supply voltage exceeds
the POR voltage threshold (VPOR), the POR Counter is enabled and counts 66 cycles of
the Watchdog Timer oscillator. After the POR counter times out, the XTAL Counter is
enabled to count a total of 16 system clock pulses. The devices are held in the Reset state
until both the POR Counter and XTAL counter have timed out. After the Z8 Encore! XP
F64XX Series devices exit the Power-On Reset state, the eZ8 CPU fetches the Reset vec-
tor. Following Power-On Reset, the PORstatus bit in the Watchdog Timer Control
(WDTCTL) register is set to 1.
Figure 7 displays Power-On Reset operation. For the POR threshold voltage (VPOR), see
Electrical Characteristics on page 211.
VCC = 3.3 V
VPOR
VVBO
Program
VCC = 0.0 V
WDT Clock
Execution
Primary
Oscillator
Oscillator
Start-up
Internal RESET
signal
POR
XTAL
counter delay
counter delay
Not to Scale
Figure 7. Power-On Reset Operation
Voltage Brownout Reset
The devices in the Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series provide low Voltage Brownout
protection. The VBO circuit senses when the supply voltage drops to an unsafe level
PS019921-0308
Reset and Stop Mode Recovery
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
48
(below the VBO threshold voltage) and forces the device into the Reset state. While the
supply voltage remains below the Power-On Reset voltage threshold (VPOR), the VBO
block holds the device in the Reset state.
After the supply voltage again exceeds the Power-On Reset voltage threshold, the devices
progress through a full system reset sequence, as described in the Power-On Reset section.
Following Power-On Reset, the PORstatus bit in the Watchdog Timer Control
(WDTCTL) register is set to 1. Figure 8 displays Voltage Brownout operation. For the
VBO and POR threshold voltages (VVBO and VPOR), see Electrical Characteristics on
page 211.
The Voltage Brownout circuit can be either enabled or disabled during STOP mode. Oper-
ation during STOP mode is set by the VBO_AOOption Bit. For information on configuring
VBO_AO, see Option Bits page 191.
VCC = 3.3 V
VCC = 3.3 V
VPOR
VVBO
Program
Voltage
Program
Execution
Brownout
Execution
WDT Clock
Primary
Oscillator
Internal RESET
Signal
POR
XTAL
Counter Delay Counter Delay
Figure 8. Voltage Brownout Reset Operation
Watchdog Timer Reset
If the device is in normal or HALT mode, the Watchdog Timer can initiate a system reset
at time-out if the WDT_RESOption Bit is set to 1. This capability is the default
PS019921-0308
Reset and Stop Mode Recovery
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
49
(unprogrammed) setting of the WDT_RESOption Bit. The WDTstatus bit in the WDT
Control register is set to signify that the reset was initiated by the Watchdog Timer.
External Pin Reset
The RESET pin has a Schmitt-triggered input, an internal pull-up, an analog filter and a
digital filter to reject noise. Once the RESET pin is asserted for at least 4 system clock
cycles, the devices progress through the system reset sequence. While the RESET input
pin is asserted Low, the Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series devices continue to be held in the
Reset state. If the RESET pin is held Low beyond the system reset time-out, the devices
exit the Reset state immediately following RESET pin deassertion. Following a system
reset initiated by the external RESET pin, the EXTstatus bit in the Watchdog Timer Con-
trol (WDTCTL) register is set to 1.
On-Chip Debugger Initiated Reset
A Power-On Reset can be initiated using the On-Chip Debugger by setting the RSTbit in
the OCD Control register. The On-Chip Debugger block is not reset but the rest of the chip
goes through a normal system reset. The RSTbit automatically clears during the system
reset. Following the system reset the PORbit in the WDT Control register is set.
Stop Mode Recovery
STOP mode is entered by the eZ8 executing a STOPinstruction. For detailed STOP mode
information, see Low-Power Modes on page 45. During Stop Mode Recovery, the devices
are held in reset for 66 cycles of the Watchdog Timer oscillator followed by 16 cycles of
the system clock. Stop Mode Recovery only affects the contents of the Watchdog Timer
Control register. Stop Mode Recovery does not affect any other values in the Register File,
including the Stack Pointer, Register Pointer, Flags, peripheral control registers, and
general-purpose RAM.
The eZ8™ CPU fetches the Reset vector at Program Memory addresses 0002Hand 0003H
and loads that value into the Program Counter. Program execution begins at the Reset
vector address. Following Stop Mode Recovery, the STOPbit in the Watchdog Timer
Control Register is set to 1. Table 10 lists the Stop Mode Recovery sources and resulting
actions.
PS019921-0308
Reset and Stop Mode Recovery
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
50
Table 10. Stop Mode Recovery Sources and Resulting Action
Operating Mode
Stop Mode Recovery Source
Action
STOP mode
Watchdog Timer time-out
when configured for Reset
Stop Mode Recovery
Watchdog Timer time-out
Stop Mode Recovery followed by interrupt
(if interrupts are enabled)
when configured for interrupt
Data transition on any GPIO Port pin Stop Mode Recovery
enabled as a Stop Mode Recovery
source
Stop Mode Recovery Using Watchdog Timer Time-Out
If the Watchdog Timer times out during STOP mode, the device undergoes a Stop Mode
Recovery sequence. In the Watchdog Timer Control register, the WDTand STOPbits are
set to 1. If the Watchdog Timer is configured to generate an interrupt upon time-out and
the Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series devices are configured to respond to interrupts, the eZ8
CPU services the Watchdog Timer interrupt request following the normal Stop Mode
Recovery sequence.
Stop Mode Recovery Using a GPIO Port Pin Transition HALT
Each of the GPIO Port pins may be configured as a Stop Mode Recovery input source. On
any GPIO pin enabled as a Stop Mode Recovery source, a change in the input pin value
(from High to Low or from Low to High) initiates Stop Mode Recovery. The GPIO Stop
Mode Recovery signals are filtered to reject pulses less than 10 ns (typical) in duration. In
the Watchdog Timer Control register, the STOPbit is set to 1.
Caution: In STOP mode, the GPIO Port Input Data registers (PxIN) are disabled. The
Port Input Data registers record the Port transition only if the signal stays on
the Port pin through the end of the Stop Mode Recovery delay. Thus, short puls-
es on the Port pin can initiate Stop Mode Recovery without being written to the
Port Input Data register or without initiating an interrupt (if enabled for that
pin).
PS019921-0308
Reset and Stop Mode Recovery
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
51
Low-Power Modes
The Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series products contain power-saving features. The highest
level of power reduction is provided by STOP mode. The next level of power reduction is
provided by the HALT mode.
STOP Mode
Execution of the eZ8™ CPU’s STOP instruction places the device into STOP mode. In
STOP mode, the operating characteristics are:
•
Primary crystal oscillator is stopped; the XIN pin is driven High and the XOUT pin is
driven Low.
•
•
•
•
System clock is stopped.
eZ8 CPU is stopped.
Program counter (PC) stops incrementing.
The Watchdog Timer and its internal RC oscillator continue to operate, if enabled for
operation during STOP mode.
•
•
The Voltage Brownout protection circuit continues to operate, if enabled for operation
in STOP mode using the associated Option Bit.
All other on-chip peripherals are idle.
To minimize current in STOP mode, all GPIO pins that are configured as digital inputs
must be driven to one of the supply rails (VCC or GND), the Voltage Brownout protection
must be disabled, and the Watchdog Timer must be disabled. The devices can be brought
out of STOP mode using Stop Mode Recovery. For more information on Stop Mode
Recovery, see Reset and Stop Mode Recovery on page 45.
STOP mode must not be used when driving the Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series
devices with an external clock driver source.
Caution:
HALT Mode
Execution of the eZ8 CPU’s HALT instruction places the device into HALT mode. In
HALT mode, the operating characteristics are:
•
•
•
Primary crystal oscillator is enabled and continues to operate.
System clock is enabled and continues to operate.
eZ8 CPU is stopped.
PS019921-0308
Low-Power Modes
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
52
•
•
•
•
Program Counter stops incrementing.
Watchdog Timer’s internal RC oscillator continues to operate.
The Watchdog Timer continues to operate, if enabled.
All other on-chip peripherals continue to operate.
The eZ8 CPU can be brought out of HALT mode by any of the following operations:
•
•
•
•
•
Interrupt
Watchdog Timer time-out (interrupt or reset)
Power-On Reset
Voltage Brownout Reset
External RESET pin assertion
To minimize current in HALT mode, all GPIO pins which are configured as inputs must be
driven to one of the supply rails (VCC or GND).
PS019921-0308
Low-Power Modes
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
53
General-Purpose I/O
The Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series products support a maximum of seven 8-bit ports (Ports
A–G) and one 4-bit port (Port H) for general-purpose input/output (GPIO) operations.
Each port consists of control and data registers. The GPIO control registers are used to
determine data direction, open-drain, output drive current and alternate pin functions.
Each port pin is individually programmable. All ports (except B and H) support 5 V-toler-
ant inputs.
GPIO Port Availability By Device
Table 11 lists the port pins available with each device and package type.
Table 11. Port Availability by Device and Package Type
Device
Packages
Port A Port B Port C Port D Port E Port F Port G Port H
Z8X1621
Z8X1622
Z8X2421
Z8X2422
Z8X3221
Z8X3222
Z8X4821
Z8X4822
Z8X4823
Z8X6421
Z8X6422
Z8X6423
44-pin
[7:0]
[7:0]
[7:0]
[7:0]
[7:0]
[7:0]
[7:0]
[7:0]
[7:0]
[7:0]
[7:0]
[7:0]
[7:0]
[7:0]
[7:0]
[7:0]
[7:0]
[7:0]
[7:0]
[7:0]
[7:0]
[7:0]
[7:0]
[7:0]
[7:0]
[6:0]
[7:0]
[6:0]
[7:0]
[6:0]
[7:0]
[6:0]
[7:0]
[7:0]
[6:0]
[7:0]
[7:0]
-
-
-
-
64- and 68-pin [7:0]
44-pin [7:0]
64- and 68-pin [7:0]
44-pin [7:0]
64- and 68-pin [7:0]
44-pin [7:0]
64- and 68-pin [7:0]
[7:0]
-
[7]
-
[3]
-
[3:0]
-
[7:0]
-
[7]
-
[3]
-
[3:0]
-
[7:0]
-
[7]
-
[3]
-
[3:0]
-
[7:0]
[7:0]
-
[7]
[7:0]
-
[3]
[7:0]
-
[3:0]
[3:0]
-
80-pin
44-pin
[7:0]
[7:0]
64- and 68-pin [7:0]
80-pin [7:0]
[7:0]
[7:0]
[7]
[7:0]
[3]
[7:0]
[3:0]
[3:0]
Architecture
Figure 9 displays a simplified block diagram of a GPIO port pin. In Figure 9, the ability to
accommodate alternate functions and variable port current drive strength are not illus-
trated.
PS019921-0308
General-Purpose I/O
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
54
Port Input
Schmitt-Trigger
Data Register
Q
D
System
Clock
VDD
Port Output Control
Port Output
Data Register
DATA
Bus
D
Q
Port
Pin
System
Clock
Port Data Direction
GND
Figure 9. GPIO Port Pin Block Diagram
GPIO Alternate Functions
Many of the GPIO port pins can be used as both general-purpose I/O and to provide access
to on-chip peripheral functions such as the timers and serial communication devices. The
Port A–H Alternate Function sub-registers configure these pins for either general-purpose
I/O or alternate function operation. When a pin is configured for alternate function, control
of the port pin direction (input/output) is passed from the Port A–H Data Direction regis-
ters to the alternate function assigned to this pin. Table 12 lists the alternate functions
associated with each port pin.
PS019921-0308
General-Purpose I/O
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
55
Table 12. Port Alternate Function Mapping
Port
Pin
Mnemonic
T0IN
Alternate Function Description
Port A PA0
PA1
Timer 0 Input
T0OUT
DE0
Timer 0 Output
PA2
UART 0 Driver Enable
UART 0 Clear to Send
PA3
CTS0
PA4
RXD0/IRRX0 UART 0/IrDA 0 Receive Data
PA5
TXD0/IRTX0
SCL
UART 0/IrDA 0 Transmit Data
2
PA6
I C Clock (automatically open-drain)
2
PA7
SDA
I C Data (automatically open-drain)
Port B PB0
PB1
ANA0
ANA1
ANA2
ANA3
ANA4
ANA5
ANA6
ANA7
T1IN
ADC Analog Input 0
ADC Analog Input 1
ADC Analog Input 2
ADC Analog Input 3
ADC Analog Input 4
ADC Analog Input 5
ADC Analog Input 6
ADC Analog Input 7
Timer 1 Input
PB2
PB3
PB4
PB5
PB6
PB7
Port C PC0
PC1
T1OUT
SS
Timer 1 Output
PC2
SPI Slave Select
SPI Serial Clock
PC3
SCK
PC4
MOSI
MISO
T2IN
SPI Master Out/Slave In
SPI Master In/Slave Out
Timer 2 In
PC5
PC6
PC7
T2OUT
Timer 2 Out
PS019921-0308
General-Purpose I/O
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
56
Table 12. Port Alternate Function Mapping (Continued)
Port
Pin
Mnemonic
T3IN
Alternate Function Description
Port D PD0
PD1
Timer 3 In (unavailable in 44-pin packages)
Timer 3 Out (unavailable in 44-pin packages)
No alternate function
T3OUT
N/A
PD2
PD3
DE1
UART 1 Driver Enable
PD4
RXD1/IRRX1 UART 1/IrDA 1 Receive Data
PD5
TXD1/IRTX1
CTS1
UART 1/IrDA 1 Transmit Data
UART 1 Clear to Send
Watchdog Timer RC Oscillator Output
No alternate functions
No alternate functions
No alternate functions
ADC Analog Input 8
PD6
PD7
RCOUT
Port E
Port F
PE[7:0] N/A
PF[7:0] N/A
Port G PG[7:0] N/A
Port H PH0
PH1
ANA8
ANA9
ADC Analog Input 9
PH2
ANA10
ANA11
ADC Analog Input 10
PH3
ADC Analog Input 11
GPIO Interrupts
Many of the GPIO port pins can be used as interrupt sources. Some port pins may be con-
figured to generate an interrupt request on either the rising edge or falling edge of the pin
input signal. Other port pin interrupts generate an interrupt when any edge occurs (both
rising and falling). For more information on interrupts using the GPIO pins, see Interrupt
Controller on page 63.
GPIO Control Register Definitions
Four registers for each Port provide access to GPIO control, input data, and output data.
Table 13 lists these Port registers. Use the Port A–H Address and Control registers
together to provide access to sub-registers for Port configuration and control.
PS019921-0308
General-Purpose I/O
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
57
Table 13. GPIO Port Registers and Sub-Registers
Port Register Mnemonic
Port Register Name
PxADDR
Port A–H Address Register
(Selects sub-registers)
PxCTL
Port A–H Control Register
(Provides access to sub-registers)
PxIN
Port A–H Input Data Register
Port A–H Output Data Register
PxOUT
Port Sub-Register Mnemonic Port Register Name
PxDD
Data Direction
PxAF
Alternate Function
Output Control (Open-Drain)
High Drive Enable
PxOC
PxDD
PxSMRE
Stop Mode Recovery Source
Enable
Port A–H Address Registers
The Port A–H Address registers select the GPIO Port functionality accessible through the
Port A–H Control registers. The Port A–H Address and Control registers combine to pro-
vide access to all GPIO Port control (Table 14).
Table 14. Port A–H GPIO Address Registers (PxADDR)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PADDR[7:0]
FIELD
RESET
R/W
00H
R/W
FD0H, FD4H, FD8H, FDCH, FE0H, FE4H, FE8H, FECH
ADDR
PS019921-0308
General-Purpose I/O
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
58
PADDR[7:0]—Port Address
The Port Address selects one of the sub-registers accessible through the Port Control reg-
ister.
Port Control sub-register accessible using the Port A–H Control
PADDR[7:0]
Registers
00H
No function. Provides some protection against accidental Port
reconfiguration
01H
Data Direction
02H
Alternate Function
03H
04H
Output Control (Open-Drain)
High Drive Enable
05H
06H-FFH
Stop Mode Recovery Source Enable
No function
Port A–H Control Registers
The Port A–H Control registers set the GPIO port operation. The value in the correspond-
ing Port A–H Address register determines the control sub-registers accessible using the
Port A–H Control register (Table 15).
Table 15. Port A–H Control Registers (PxCTL)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
BITS
PCTL
00H
FIELD
RESET
R/W
R/W
FD1H, FD5H, FD9H, FDDH, FE1H, FE5H, FE9H, FEDH
ADDR
PCTL[7:0]—Port Control
The Port Control register provides access to all sub-registers that configure the GPIO Port
operation.
PS019921-0308
General-Purpose I/O
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
59
Port A–H Data Direction Sub-Registers
The Port A–H Data Direction sub-register is accessed through the Port A–H Control regis-
ter by writing 01H to the Port A–H Address register (Table 16).
Table 16. Port A–H Data Direction Sub-Registers
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DD7
DD6
DD5
DD4
DD3
DD2
DD1
DD0
FIELD
RESET
R/W
1
R/W
If 01H in Port A–H Address Register, accessible through Port A–H Control Register
ADDR
DD[7:0]—Data Direction
These bits control the direction of the associated port pin. Port Alternate Function opera-
tion overrides the Data Direction register setting.
0 = Output. Data in the Port A–H Output Data register is driven onto the port pin.
1 = Input. The port pin is sampled and the value written into the Port A–H Input Data
Register. The output driver is tri-stated.
Port A–H Alternate Function Sub-Registers
The Port A–H Alternate Function sub-register (Table 17) is accessed through the
Port A–H Control register by writing 02Hto the Port A–H Address register. The Port A–H
Alternate Function sub-registers select the alternate functions for the selected pins. To
determine the alternate function associated with each port pin, see GPIO Alternate Func-
tions on page 54.
Caution: Do not enable alternate function for GPIO port pins which do not have an as-
sociated alternate function. Failure to follow this guideline may result in un-
predictable operation.
Table 17. Port A–H Alternate Function Sub-Registers
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
AF7
AF6
AF5
AF4
AF3
AF2
AF1
AF0
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
R/W
If 02H in Port A–H Address Register, accessible through Port A–H Control Register
ADDR
PS019921-0308
General-Purpose I/O
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
60
AF[7:0]—Port Alternate Function enabled
0 = The port pin is in NORMAL mode and the DDxbit in the Port A–H Data Direction
sub-register determines the direction of the pin.
1 = The alternate function is selected. Port pin operation is controlled by the
alternate function.
Port A–H Output Control Sub-Registers
The Port A–H Output Control sub-register (Table 18) is accessed through the
Port A–H Control register by writing 03Hto the Port A–H Address register. Setting the
bits in the Port A–H Output Control sub-registers to 1 configures the specified port pins
for open-drain operation. These sub-registers affect the pins directly and, as a result, alter-
nate functions are also affected.
Table 18. Port A–H Output Control Sub-Registers
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
POC7
POC6
POC5
POC4
POC3
POC2
POC1
POC0
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
R/W
If 03H in Port A–H Address Register, accessible through Port A–H Control Register
ADDR
POC[7:0]—Port Output Control
These bits function independently of the alternate function bit and disables the drains if set
to 1.
0 = The drains are enabled for any output mode.
1 = The drain of the associated pin is disabled (open-drain mode).
Port A–H High Drive Enable Sub-Registers
The Port A–H High Drive Enable sub-register (Table 19) is accessed through the Port A–
H Control register by writing 04Hto the Port A–H Address register. Setting the bits in the
Port A–H High Drive Enable sub-registers to 1 configures the specified port pins for high
current output drive operation. The Port A–H High Drive Enable sub-register affects the
pins directly and, as a result, alternate functions are also affected.
PS019921-0308
General-Purpose I/O
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
61
Table 19. Port A–H High Drive Enable Sub-Registers
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PHDE7
PHDE6
PHDE5
PHDE4
PHDE3
PHDE2
PHDE1
PHDE0
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
R/W
If 04H in Port A-H Address Register, accessible through Port A-H Control Register
ADDR
PHDE[7:0]—Port High Drive Enabled
0 = The Port pin is configured for standard output current drive.
1 = The Port pin is configured for high output current drive.
Port A–H Stop Mode Recovery Source Enable Sub-Registers
The Port A–H Stop Mode Recovery Source Enable sub-register (Table 20) is accessed
through the Port A–H Control register by writing 05Hto the Port A–H Address register.
Setting the bits in the Port A–H Stop Mode Recovery Source Enable sub-registers to 1
configures the specified Port pins as a Stop Mode Recovery source. During STOP Mode,
any logic transition on a Port pin enabled as a Stop Mode Recovery source initiates Stop
Mode Recovery.
Table 20. Port A–H Stop Mode Recovery Source Enable Sub-Registers
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PSMRE7 PSMRE6 PSMRE5 PSMRE4 PSMRE3 PSMRE2 PSMRE1 PSMRE0
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
R/W
If 05H in Port A–H Address Register, accessible through Port A–H Control Register
ADDR
PSMRE[7:0]—Port Stop Mode Recovery Source Enabled
0 = The Port pin is not configured as a Stop Mode Recovery source. Transitions on this
pin during STOP mode do not initiate Stop Mode Recovery.
1 = The Port pin is configured as a Stop Mode Recovery source. Any logic transition
on this pin during STOP mode initiates Stop Mode Recovery.
PS019921-0308
General-Purpose I/O
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
62
Port A–H Input Data Registers
Reading from the Port A–H Input Data registers (Table 21) returns the sampled values
from the corresponding port pins. The Port A–H Input Data registers are Read-only.
Table 21. Port A–H Input Data Registers (PxIN)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PIN7
PIN6
PIN5
PIN4
PIN3
PIN2
PIN1
PIN0
FIELD
RESET
R/W
X
R
FD2H, FD6H, FDAH, FDEH, FE2H, FE6H, FEAH, FEEH
ADDR
PIN[7:0]—Port Input Data
Sampled data from the corresponding port pin input.
0 = Input data is logical 0 (Low).
1 = Input data is logical 1 (High).
Port A–H Output Data Register
The Port A–H Output Data register (Table 22) writes output data to the pins.
Table 22. Port A–H Output Data Register (PxOUT)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
POUT7
POUT6
POUT5
POUT4
POUT3
POUT2
POUT1
POUT0
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
R/W
FD3H, FD7H, FDBH, FDFH, FE3H, FE7H, FEBH, FEFH
ADDR
POUT[7:0]—Port Output Data
These bits contain the data to be driven out from the port pins. The values are only driven
if the corresponding pin is configured as an output and the pin is not configured for alter-
nate function operation.
0 = Drive a logical 0 (Low).
1= Drive a logical 1 (High). High value is not driven if the drain has been disabled by
setting the corresponding Port Output Control register bit to 1.
PS019921-0308
General-Purpose I/O
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
63
Interrupt Controller
The interrupt controller on the Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series products prioritizes the inter-
rupt requests from the on-chip peripherals and the GPIO port pins. The features of the
interrupt controller include the following:
•
24 unique interrupt vectors:
–
–
12 GPIO port pin interrupt sources
12 on-chip peripheral interrupt sources
•
Flexible GPIO interrupts
–
–
Eight selectable rising and falling edge GPIO interrupts
Four dual-edge interrupts
•
•
Three levels of individually programmable interrupt priority
Watchdog Timer can be configured to generate an interrupt
Interrupt requests (IRQs) allow peripheral devices to suspend CPU operation in an orderly
manner and force the CPU to start an interrupt service routine (ISR). Usually this interrupt
service routine is involved with the exchange of data, status information, or control
information between the CPU and the interrupting peripheral. When the service routine is
completed, the CPU returns to the operation from which it was interrupted.
The eZ8 CPU supports both vectored and polled interrupt handling. For polled interrupts,
the interrupt control has no effect on operation. For more information on interrupt
servicing by the eZ8 CPU, refer to eZ8™ CPU Core User Manual (UM0128) available for
download at www.zilog.com.
Interrupt Vector Listing
Table 23 lists all of the interrupts available in order of priority. The interrupt vector is
stored with the most-significant byte (MSB) at the even Program Memory address and the
least-significant byte (LSB) at the following odd Program Memory address.
Table 23. Interrupt Vectors in Order of Priority
Program Memory
Priority Vector Address
Highest 0002H
0004H
Interrupt Source
Reset (not an interrupt)
Watchdog Timer (see Watchdog Timer on page 93)
Illegal Instruction Trap (not an interrupt)
Timer 2
0006H
0008H
PS019921-0308
Interrupt Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
64
Table 23. Interrupt Vectors in Order of Priority (Continued) (Continued)
Program Memory
Priority Vector Address
000AH
Interrupt Source
Timer 1
000CH
Timer 0
000EH
UART 0 receiver
UART 0 transmitter
0010H
2
0012H
I C
0014H
SPI
0016H
ADC
0018H
Port A7 or Port D7, rising or falling input edge
Port A6 or Port D6, rising or falling input edge
Port A5 or Port D5, rising or falling input edge
Port A4 or Port D4, rising or falling input edge
Port A3 or Port D3, rising or falling input edge
Port A2 or Port D2, rising or falling input edge
Port A1 or Port D1, rising or falling input edge
Port A0 or Port D0, rising or falling input edge
Timer 3 (not available in 44-pin packages)
UART 1 receiver
001AH
001CH
001EH
0020H
0022H
0024H
0026H
0028H
002AH
002CH
UART 1 transmitter
002EH
DMA
0030H
Port C3, both input edges
0032H
Port C2, both input edges
0034H
Port C1, both input edges
Lowest 0036H
Port C0, both input edges
Architecture
Figure 10 displays a block diagram of the interrupt controller.
PS019921-0308
Interrupt Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
65
High
Port Interrupts
Priority
Vector
Priority
IRQ Request
Mux
Medium
Priority
Internal Interrupts
Low
Priority
Figure 10. Interrupt Controller Block Diagram
Operation
Master Interrupt Enable
The master interrupt enable bit (IRQE) in the Interrupt Control register globally enables
and disables interrupts.
Interrupts are globally enabled by any of the following actions:
•
•
•
Executing an Enable Interrupt (EI) instruction.
Executing an Return from Interrupt (IRET) instruction.
Writing a 1 to the IRQEbit in the Interrupt Control register.
Interrupts are globally disabled by any of the following actions:
•
•
Execution of a Disable Interrupt (DI) instruction.
eZ8 CPU acknowledgement of an interrupt service request from the interrupt
controller.
•
•
•
•
Writing a 0 to the IRQEbit in the Interrupt Control register.
Reset.
Executing a Trap instruction.
Illegal Instruction trap.
PS019921-0308
Interrupt Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
66
Interrupt Vectors and Priority
The interrupt controller supports three levels of interrupt priority. Level 3 is the highest
priority, Level 2 is the second highest priority, and Level 1 is the lowest priority. If all of
the interrupts were enabled with identical interrupt priority (all as Level 2 interrupts, for
example), then interrupt priority would be assigned from highest to lowest as specified in
Table 23 on page 63. Level 3 interrupts always have higher priority than Level 2 interrupts
which, in turn, always have higher priority than Level 1 interrupts. Within each interrupt
priority level (Level 1, Level 2, or Level 3), priority is assigned as specified in Table 23 on
page 63. Reset, Watchdog Timer interrupt (if enabled), and Illegal Instruction Trap always
have highest priority.
Interrupt Assertion
Interrupt sources assert their interrupt requests for only a single system clock period
(single pulse). When the interrupt request is acknowledged by the eZ8 CPU, the
corresponding bit in the Interrupt Request register is cleared until the next interrupt
occurs. Writing a 0 to the corresponding bit in the Interrupt Request register likewise
clears the interrupt request.
Caution: The following style of coding to clear bits in the Interrupt Request registers is
NOT recommended. All incoming interrupts that are received between
execution of the first LDX command and the last LDX command are lost.
Poor coding style that can result in lost interrupt requests:
LDX r0, IRQ0
AND r0, MASK
LDX IRQ0, r0
To avoid missing interrupts, the following style of coding to clear bits in
the Interrupt Request 0 register is recommended:
Good coding style that avoids lost interrupt requests:
ANDX IRQ0, MASK
Software Interrupt Assertion
Program code can generate interrupts directly. Writing a 1 to the desired bit in the Interrupt
Request register triggers an interrupt (assuming that interrupt is enabled). When the inter-
rupt request is acknowledged by the eZ8 CPU, the bit in the Interrupt Request register is
automatically cleared to 0.
Caution: The following style of coding to generate software interrupts by setting bits in
the Interrupt Request registers is NOT recommended. All incoming interrupts
PS019921-0308
Interrupt Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
67
that are received between execution of the first LDX command and the last
LDX command are lost.
Poor coding style that can result in lost interrupt requests:
LDX r0, IRQ0
OR r0, MASK
LDX IRQ0, r0
To avoid missing interrupts, the following style of coding to set bits in the
Interrupt Request registers is recommended:
Good coding style that avoids lost interrupt requests:
ORX IRQ0, MASK
Interrupt Control Register Definitions
For all interrupts other than the Watchdog Timer interrupt, the interrupt control registers
enable individual interrupts, set interrupt priorities, and indicate interrupt requests.
Interrupt Request 0 Register
The Interrupt Request 0 (IRQ0) register (Table 24) stores the interrupt requests for both
vectored and polled interrupts. When a request is presented to the interrupt controller, the
corresponding bit in the IRQ0 register becomes 1. If interrupts are globally enabled (vec-
tored interrupts), the interrupt controller passes an interrupt request to the eZ8™ CPU. If
interrupts are globally disabled (polled interrupts), the eZ8 CPU can read the Interrupt
Request 0 register to determine if any interrupt requests are pending
Table 24. Interrupt Request 0 Register (IRQ0)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
T2I
T1I
T0I
U0RXI
U0TXI
I2CI
SPII
ADCI
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
R/W
FC0H
ADDR
T2I—Timer 2 Interrupt Request
0 = No interrupt request is pending for Timer 2.
1 = An interrupt request from Timer 2 is awaiting service.
PS019921-0308
Interrupt Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
68
T1I—Timer 1 Interrupt Request
0 = No interrupt request is pending for Timer 1.
1 = An interrupt request from Timer 1 is awaiting service.
T0I—Timer 0 Interrupt Request
0 = No interrupt request is pending for Timer 0.
1 = An interrupt request from Timer 0 is awaiting service.
U0RXI—UART 0 Receiver Interrupt Request
0 = No interrupt request is pending for the UART 0 receiver.
1 = An interrupt request from the UART 0 receiver is awaiting service.
U0TXI—UART 0 Transmitter Interrupt Request
0 = No interrupt request is pending for the UART 0 transmitter.
1 = An interrupt request from the UART 0 transmitter is awaiting service.
I2CI— I2C Interrupt Request
0 = No interrupt request is pending for the I2C.
1 = An interrupt request from the I2C is awaiting service.
SPII—SPI Interrupt Request
0 = No interrupt request is pending for the SPI.
1 = An interrupt request from the SPI is awaiting service.
ADCI—ADC Interrupt Request
0 = No interrupt request is pending for the Analog-to-Digital Converter.
1 = An interrupt request from the Analog-to-Digital Converter is awaiting service.
Interrupt Request 1 Register
The Interrupt Request 1 (IRQ1) register (Table 25) stores interrupt requests for both vec-
tored and polled interrupts. When a request is presented to the interrupt controller, the cor-
responding bit in the IRQ1 register becomes 1. If interrupts are globally enabled (vectored
interrupts), the interrupt controller passes an interrupt request to the eZ8 CPU. If interrupts
are globally disabled (polled interrupts), the eZ8 CPU can read the Interrupt Request 1
register to determine if any interrupt requests are pending.
Table 25. Interrupt Request 1 Register (IRQ1)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PAD7I
PAD6I
PAD5I
PAD4I
PAD3I
PAD2I
PAD1I
PAD0I
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
R/W
FC3H
ADDR
PS019921-0308
Interrupt Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
69
PADxI—Port A or Port D Pin x Interrupt Request
0 = No interrupt request is pending for GPIO Port A or Port D pin x.
1 = An interrupt request from GPIO Port A or Port D pin x is awaiting service.
where x indicates the specific GPIO Port pin number (0 through 7). For each pin, only 1 of
either Port A or Port D can be enabled for interrupts at any one time. Port selection (A or
D) is determined by the values in the Interrupt Port Select Register.
Interrupt Request 2 Register
The Interrupt Request 2 (IRQ2) register (Table 26) stores interrupt requests for both vec-
tored and polled interrupts. When a request is presented to the interrupt controller, the cor-
responding bit in the IRQ2 register becomes 1. If interrupts are globally enabled (vectored
interrupts), the interrupt controller passes an interrupt request to the eZ8 CPU. If interrupts
are globally disabled (polled interrupts), the eZ8 CPU can read the Interrupt Request 1
register to determine if any interrupt requests are pending.
Table 26. Interrupt Request 2 Register (IRQ2)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
T3I
U1RXI
U1TXI
DMAI
PC3I
PC2I
PC1I
PC0I
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
R/W
FC6H
ADDR
T3I—Timer 3 Interrupt Request
0 = No interrupt request is pending for Timer 3.
1 = An interrupt request from Timer 3 is awaiting service.
U1RXI—UART 1 Receive Interrupt Request
0 = No interrupt request is pending for the UART1 receiver.
1 = An interrupt request from UART1 receiver is awaiting service.
U1TXI—UART 1 Transmit Interrupt Request
0 = No interrupt request is pending for the UART 1 transmitter.
1 = An interrupt request from the UART 1 transmitter is awaiting service.
DMAI—DMA Interrupt Request
0 = No interrupt request is pending for the DMA.
1 = An interrupt request from the DMA is awaiting service.
PCxI—Port C Pin x Interrupt Request
0 = No interrupt request is pending for GPIO Port C pin x.
1 = An interrupt request from GPIO Port C pin x is awaiting service.
PS019921-0308
Interrupt Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
70
where x indicates the specific GPIO Port C pin number (0 through 3).
IRQ0 Enable High and Low Bit Registers
The IRQ0 Enable High and Low Bit registers (see Table 28 and Table 29 on page 71) form
a priority encoded enabling for interrupts in the Interrupt Request 0 register. Priority is
generated by setting bits in each register. Table 27 describes the priority control for IRQ0.
Table 27. IRQ0 Enable and Priority Encoding
IRQ0ENH[x] IRQ0ENL[x]
Priority
Disabled
Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
Description
Disabled
Low
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Nominal
High
Note: where x indicates the register bits from 0 through 7.
Table 28. IRQ0 Enable High Bit Register (IRQ0ENH)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
T2ENH
T1ENH
T0ENH
U0RENH U0TENH I2CENH
SPIENH ADCENH
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
R/W
FC1H
ADDR
T2ENH—Timer 2 Interrupt Request Enable High Bit
T1ENH—Timer 1 Interrupt Request Enable High Bit
T0ENH—Timer 0 Interrupt Request Enable High Bit
U0RENH—UART 0 Receive Interrupt Request Enable High Bit
U0TENH—UART 0 Transmit Interrupt Request Enable High Bit
I2CENH—I2C Interrupt Request Enable High Bit
SPIENH—SPI Interrupt Request Enable High Bit
ADCENH—ADC Interrupt Request Enable High Bit
PS019921-0308
Interrupt Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
71
Table 29. IRQ0 Enable Low Bit Register (IRQ0ENL)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
T2ENL
T1ENL
T0ENL
U0RENL U0TENL
I2CENL
SPIENL
ADCENL
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
R/W
FC2H
ADDR
T2ENL—Timer 2 Interrupt Request Enable Low Bit
T1ENL—Timer 1 Interrupt Request Enable Low Bit
T0ENL—Timer 0 Interrupt Request Enable Low Bit
U0RENL—UART 0 Receive Interrupt Request Enable Low Bit
U0TENL—UART 0 Transmit Interrupt Request Enable Low Bit
I2CENL—I2C Interrupt Request Enable Low Bit
SPIENL—SPI Interrupt Request Enable Low Bit
ADCENL—ADC Interrupt Request Enable Low Bit
IRQ1 Enable High and Low Bit Registers
The IRQ1 Enable High and Low Bit registers (see Table 31 and Table 32 on page 72) form
a priority encoded enabling for interrupts in the Interrupt Request 1 register. Priority is
generated by setting bits in each register. Table 30 describes the priority control for IRQ1.
Table 30. IRQ1 Enable and Priority Encoding
IRQ1ENH[x] IRQ1ENL[x]
Priority
Disabled
Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
Description
Disabled
Low
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Nominal
High
Note: where x indicates the register bits from 0 through 7.
PS019921-0308
Interrupt Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
72
Table 31. IRQ1 Enable High Bit Register (IRQ1ENH)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PAD7ENH PAD6ENH PAD5ENH PAD4ENH PAD3ENH PAD2ENH PAD1ENH PAD0ENH
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
FC4H
ADDR
PADxENH—Port A or Port D Bit[x] Interrupt Request Enable High Bit.
For selection of either Port A or Port D as the interrupt source, see Interrupt Port Select
Register on page 74.
Table 32. IRQ1 Enable Low Bit Register (IRQ1ENL)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PAD7ENL PAD6ENL PAD5ENL PAD4ENL PAD3ENL PAD2ENL PAD1ENL PAD0ENL
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
FC5H
ADDR
PADxENL—Port A or Port D Bit[x] Interrupt Request Enable Low Bit
For selection of either Port A or Port D as the interrupt source, see Interrupt Port Select
Register on page 74.
IRQ2 Enable High and Low Bit Registers
The IRQ2 Enable High and Low Bit registers (see Table 34 and Table 35 on page 73) form
a priority encoded enabling for interrupts in the Interrupt Request 2 register. Priority is
generated by setting bits in each register. Table 33 describes the priority control for IRQ2.
Table 33. IRQ2 Enable and Priority Encoding
IRQ2ENH[x] IRQ2ENL[x]
Priority
Disabled
Level 1
Level 2
Description
Disabled
Low
0
0
1
0
1
0
Nominal
PS019921-0308
Interrupt Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
73
Table 33. IRQ2 Enable and Priority Encoding (Continued)
IRQ2ENH[x] IRQ2ENL[x]
Priority
Level 3
Description
High
1
1
Note: where x indicates the register bits from 0 through 7.
Table 34. IRQ2 Enable High Bit Register (IRQ2ENH)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
T3ENH
U1RENH U1TENH DMAENH C3ENH
C2ENH
C1ENH
C0ENH
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
R/W
FC7H
ADDR
T3ENH—Timer 3 Interrupt Request Enable High Bit
U1RENH—UART 1 Receive Interrupt Request Enable High Bit
U1TENH—UART 1 Transmit Interrupt Request Enable High Bit
DMAENH—DMA Interrupt Request Enable High Bit
C3ENH—Port C3 Interrupt Request Enable High Bit
C2ENH—Port C2 Interrupt Request Enable High Bit
C1ENH—Port C1 Interrupt Request Enable High Bit
C0ENH—Port C0 Interrupt Request Enable High Bit
Table 35. IRQ2 Enable Low Bit Register (IRQ2ENL)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
T3ENL
U1RENL U1TENL DMAENL
C3ENL
C2ENL
C1ENL
C0ENL
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
R/W
FC8H
ADDR
T3ENL—Timer 3 Interrupt Request Enable Low Bit
U1RENL—UART 1 Receive Interrupt Request Enable Low Bit
U1TENL—UART 1 Transmit Interrupt Request Enable Low Bit
DMAENL—DMA Interrupt Request Enable Low Bit
C3ENL—Port C3 Interrupt Request Enable Low Bit
C2ENL—Port C2 Interrupt Request Enable Low Bit
PS019921-0308
Interrupt Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
74
C1ENL—Port C1 Interrupt Request Enable Low Bit
C0ENL—Port C0 Interrupt Request Enable Low Bit
Interrupt Edge Select Register
The Interrupt Edge Select (IRQES) register (Table 36) determines whether an interrupt is
generated for the rising edge or falling edge on the selected GPIO Port input pin. The
Interrupt Port Select register selects between Port A and Port D for the individual inter-
rupts.
Table 36. Interrupt Edge Select Register (IRQES)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
IES7
IES6
IES5
IES4
IES3
IES2
IES1
IES0
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
R/W
FCDH
ADDR
IESx—Interrupt Edge Select x
The minimum pulse width should be greater than 1 system clock to guarantee capture of
the edge triggered interrupt. Shorter pulses may be captured but not guaranteed.
0 = An interrupt request is generated on the falling edge of the PAx/PDx input.
1 = An interrupt request is generated on the rising edge of the PAx/PDx input.
where x indicates the specific GPIO Port pin number (0 through 7).
Interrupt Port Select Register
The Port Select (IRQPS) register (Table 37) determines the port pin that generates the
PAx/PDx interrupts. This register allows either Port A or Port D pins to be used as
interrupts. The Interrupt Edge Select register controls the active interrupt edge.
Table 37. Interrupt Port Select Register (IRQPS)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PAD7S
PAD6S
PAD5S
PAD4S
PAD3S
PAD2S
PAD1S
PAD0S
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
R/W
FCEH
ADDR
PS019921-0308
Interrupt Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
75
PADxS—PAx/PDx Selection
0 = PAx is used for the interrupt for PAx/PDx interrupt request.
1 = PDx is used for the interrupt for PAx/PDx interrupt request.
where x indicates the specific GPIO Port pin number (0 through 7).
Interrupt Control Register
The Interrupt Control (IRQCTL) register (Table 38) contains the master enable bit for all
interrupts.
Table 38. Interrupt Control Register (IRQCTL)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
IRQE
Reserved
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
R/W
R
FCFH
ADDR
IRQE—Interrupt Request Enable
This bit is set to 1 by execution of an EI or IRET instruction, or by a direct register write of
a 1 to this bit. It is reset to 0 by executing a DI instruction, eZ8 CPU acknowledgement of
an interrupt request, or Reset.
0 = Interrupts are disabled
1 = Interrupts are enabled
Reserved—Must be 0.
PS019921-0308
Interrupt Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
76
PS019921-0308
Interrupt Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
77
Timers
The Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series products contain up to four 16-bit reloadable timers
that can be used for timing, event counting, or generation of pulse width modulated sig-
nals. The timers’ features include:
•
•
•
•
•
16-bit reload counter
Programmable prescaler with prescale values from 1 to 128
PWM output generation
Capture and compare capability
External input pin for timer input, clock gating, or capture signal. External input pin
signal frequency is limited to a maximum of one-fourth the system clock frequency.
•
•
Timer output pin
Timer interrupt
In addition to the timers described in this chapter, the Baud Rate Generators for any
unused UART, SPI, or I2C peripherals may also be used to provide basic timing function-
ality. For information on using the Baud Rate Generators as timers, see the respective
serial communication peripheral. Timer 3 is unavailable in the 44-pin package devices.
Architecture
Figure 11 displays the architecture of the timers.
PS019921-0308
Timers
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
78
Timer Block
Timer
Control
Data
Bus
Block
Control
16-Bit
Interrupt,
PWM,
Timer
Reload Register
Interrupt
and
Timer Output
Control
Timer
Output
System
Clock
16-Bit Counter
with Prescaler
Timer
Input
Gate
Input
16-Bit
PWM/Compare
Capture
Input
Figure 11. Timer Block Diagram
Operation
The timers are 16-bit up-counters. Minimum time-out delay is set by loading the value
0001Hinto the Timer Reload High and Low Byte registers and setting the prescale value
to 1. Maximum time-out delay is set by loading the value 0000Hinto the Timer Reload
High and Low Byte registers and setting the prescale value to 128. If the Timer reaches
FFFFH, the timer rolls over to 0000Hand continues counting.
Timer Operating Modes
The timers can be configured to operate in the following modes:
ONE-SHOT Mode
In ONE-SHOT mode, the timer counts up to the 16-bit Reload value stored in the Timer
Reload High and Low Byte registers. The timer input is the system clock. Upon reaching
the Reload value, the timer generates an interrupt and the count value in the Timer High
and Low Byte registers is reset to 0001H. Then, the timer is automatically disabled and
stops counting.
Also, if the Timer Output alternate function is enabled, the Timer Output pin changes state
for one system clock cycle (from Low to High or from High to Low) upon timer Reload. If
it is desired to have the Timer Output make a permanent state change upon
PS019921-0308
Timers
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
79
One-Shot time-out, first set the TPOLbit in the Timer Control 1 Register to the start value
before beginning ONE-SHOT mode. Then, after starting the timer, set TPOLto the oppo-
site bit value.
Follow the steps below for configuring a timer for ONE-SHOT mode and initiating the
count:
1. Write to the Timer Control 1 register to:
–
–
–
–
Disable the timer
Configure the timer for ONE-SHOT mode
Set the prescale value
If using the Timer Output alternate function, set the initial output level (High or
Low)
2. Write to the Timer High and Low Byte registers to set the starting count value
3. Write to the Timer Reload High and Low Byte registers to set the Reload value
4. If desired, enable the timer interrupt and set the timer interrupt priority by writing to
the relevant interrupt registers
5. If using the Timer Output function, configure the associated GPIO port pin for the
Timer Output alternate function
6. Write to the Timer Control 1 register to enable the timer and initiate counting
In ONE-SHOT mode, the system clock always provides the timer input. The timer period
is given by the following equation:
(Reload Value – Start Value) × Prescale
ONE-SHOT Mode Time-Out Period (s) = ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
System Clock Frequency (Hz)
CONTINUOUS Mode
In CONTINUOUS mode, the timer counts up to the 16-bit Reload value stored in the
Timer Reload High and Low Byte registers. The timer input is the system clock. Upon
reaching the Reload value, the timer generates an interrupt, the count value in the Timer
High and Low Byte registers is reset to 0001Hand counting resumes. Also, if the Timer
Output alternate function is enabled, the Timer Output pin changes state (from Low to
High or from High to Low) upon timer Reload.
Follow the steps below for configuring a timer for CONTINUOUS mode and initiating the
count:
1. Write to the Timer Control 1 register to:
–
–
–
–
Disable the timer
Configure the timer for CONTINUOUS mode
Set the prescale value
If using the Timer Output alternate function, set the initial output level (High or
Low)
PS019921-0308
Timers
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
80
2. Write to the Timer High and Low Byte registers to set the starting count value (usually
0001H), affecting only the first pass in CONTINUOUS mode. After the first timer
Reload in CONTINUOUS mode, counting always begins at the reset value of 0001H.
3. Write to the Timer Reload High and Low Byte registers to set the Reload value.
4. If desired, enable the timer interrupt and set the timer interrupt priority by writing to
the relevant interrupt registers.
5. If using the Timer Output function, configure the associated GPIO port pin for the
Timer Output alternate function.
6. Write to the Timer Control 1 register to enable the timer and initiate counting.
In CONTINUOUS mode, the system clock always provides the timer input. The timer
period is given by the following equation:
Reload Value × Prescale
CONTINUOUS Mode Time-Out Period (s) = ------------------------------------------------------------------------
System Clock Frequency (Hz)
If an initial starting value other than 0001His loaded into the Timer High and Low Byte
registers, the ONE-SHOT mode equation must be used to determine the first time-out
period.
COUNTER Mode
In COUNTER mode, the timer counts input transitions from a GPIO port pin. The timer
input is taken from the GPIO Port pin Timer Input alternate function. The TPOLbit in the
Timer Control 1 Register selects whether the count occurs on the rising edge or the falling
edge of the Timer Input signal. In COUNTER mode, the prescaler is disabled.
Caution: The input frequency of the Timer Input signal must not exceed one-fourth the
system clock frequency.
Upon reaching the Reload value stored in the Timer Reload High and Low Byte registers,
the timer generates an interrupt, the count value in the Timer High and Low Byte registers
is reset to 0001Hand counting resumes. Also, if the Timer Output alternate function is
enabled, the Timer Output pin changes state (from Low to High or from High to Low) at
timer Reload.
Follow the steps below for configuring a timer for COUNTER mode and initiating the
count:
1. Write to the Timer Control 1 register to:
–
–
Disable the timer
Configure the timer for COUNTER mode
PS019921-0308
Timers
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
81
–
Select either the rising edge or falling edge of the Timer Input signal for the count.
This also sets the initial logic level (High or Low) for the Timer Output alternate
function. However, the Timer Output function does not have to be enabled
2. Write to the Timer High and Low Byte registers to set the starting count value. This
only affects the first pass in COUNTER mode. After the first timer Reload in
COUNTER mode, counting always begins at the reset value of 0001H. Generally, in
COUNTER mode the Timer High and Low Byte registers must be written with the
value 0001H.
3. Write to the Timer Reload High and Low Byte registers to set the Reload value.
4. If desired, enable the timer interrupt and set the timer interrupt priority by writing to
the relevant interrupt registers.
5. Configure the associated GPIO port pin for the Timer Input alternate function.
6. If using the Timer Output function, configure the associated GPIO port pin for the
Timer Output alternate function.
7. Write to the Timer Control 1 register to enable the timer.
In COUNTER mode, the number of Timer Input transitions since the timer start is given
by the following equation:
COUNTER Mode Timer Input Transitions = Current Count Value – Start Value
PWM Mode
In PWM mode, the timer outputs a Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM) output signal through
a GPIO Port pin. The timer input is the system clock. The timer first counts up to the 16-
bit PWM match value stored in the Timer PWM High and Low Byte registers. When the
timer count value matches the PWM value, the Timer Output toggles. The timer continues
counting until it reaches the Reload value stored in the Timer Reload High and Low Byte
registers. Upon reaching the Reload value, the timer generates an interrupt, the count
value in the Timer High and Low Byte registers is reset to 0001Hand counting resumes.
If the TPOLbit in the Timer Control 1 register is set to 1, the Timer Output signal begins
as a High (1) and then transitions to a Low (0) when the timer value matches the PWM
value. The Timer Output signal returns to a High (1) after the timer reaches the Reload
value and is reset to 0001H.
If the TPOLbit in the Timer Control 1 register is set to 0, the Timer Output signal begins
as a Low (0) and then transitions to a High (1) when the timer value matches the PWM
value. The Timer Output signal returns to a Low (0) after the timer reaches the Reload
value and is reset to 0001H.
PS019921-0308
Timers
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
82
Follow the steps below for configuring a timer for PWM mode and initiating the PWM
operation:
1. Write to the Timer Control 1 register to:
–
–
–
–
Disable the timer
Configure the timer for PWM mode
Set the prescale value
Set the initial logic level (High or Low) and PWM High/Low transition for the
Timer Output alternate function
2. Write to the Timer High and Low Byte registers to set the starting count value
(typically 0001H). This only affects the first pass in PWM mode. After the first timer
reset in PWM mode, counting always begins at the reset value of 0001H.
3. Write to the PWM High and Low Byte registers to set the PWM value.
4. Write to the Timer Reload High and Low Byte registers to set the Reload value (PWM
period). The Reload value must be greater than the PWM value.
5. If desired, enable the timer interrupt and set the timer interrupt priority by writing to
the relevant interrupt registers.
6. Configure the associated GPIO port pin for the Timer Output alternate function.
7. Write to the Timer Control 1 register to enable the timer and initiate counting.
The PWM period is given by the following equation:
Reload Value × Prescale
PWM Period (s) = ------------------------------------------------------------------------
System Clock Frequency (Hz)
If an initial starting value other than 0001His loaded into the Timer High and Low Byte
registers, the ONE-SHOT mode equation must be used to determine the first PWM time-
out period.
If TPOLis set to 0, the ratio of the PWM output High time to the total period is given by:
Reload Value – PWM Value
--------------------------------------------------------------------
PWM Output High Time Ratio (%) =
× 100
Reload Value
If TPOLis set to 1, the ratio of the PWM output High time to the total period is given by:
PWM Value
--------------------------------
Reload Value
PWM Output High Time Ratio (%) =
× 100
CAPTURE Mode
In CAPTURE mode, the current timer count value is recorded when the desired external
Timer Input transition occurs. The Capture count value is written to the Timer PWM High
and Low Byte Registers. The timer input is the system clock. The TPOLbit in the Timer
Control 1 register determines if the Capture occurs on a rising edge or a falling edge of the
Timer Input signal. When the Capture event occurs, an interrupt is generated and the timer
continues counting.
PS019921-0308
Timers
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
83
The timer continues counting up to the 16-bit Reload value stored in the Timer Reload
High and Low Byte registers. Upon reaching the Reload value, the timer generates an
interrupt and continues counting.
Follow the steps below for configuring a timer for CAPTURE mode and initiating the
count:
1. Write to the Timer Control 1 register to:
–
–
–
–
Disable the timer
Configure the timer for CAPTURE mode.
Set the prescale value.
Set the Capture edge (rising or falling) for the Timer Input.
2. Write to the Timer High and Low Byte registers to set the starting count value
(typically 0001H).
3. Write to the Timer Reload High and Low Byte registers to set the Reload value.
4. Clear the Timer PWM High and Low Byte registers to 0000H. This allows the
software to determine if interrupts were generated by either a capture event or a
reload. If the PWM High and Low Byte registers still contain 0000Hafter the
interrupt, then the interrupt was generated by a Reload.
5. If desired, enable the timer interrupt and set the timer interrupt priority by writing to
the relevant interrupt registers.
6. Configure the associated GPIO port pin for the Timer Input alternate function.
7. Write to the Timer Control 1 register to enable the timer and initiate counting.
In CAPTURE mode, the elapsed time from timer start to Capture event can be calculated
using the following equation:
(Capture Value – Start Value) × Prescale
Capture Elapsed Time (s) = --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
System Clock Frequency (Hz)
COMPARE Mode
In COMPARE mode, the timer counts up to the 16-bit maximum Compare value stored in
the Timer Reload High and Low Byte registers. The timer input is the system clock. Upon
reaching the Compare value, the timer generates an interrupt and counting continues (the
timer value is not reset to 0001H). Also, if the Timer Output alternate function is enabled,
the Timer Output pin changes state (from Low to High or from High to Low) upon Com-
pare.
If the Timer reaches FFFFH, the timer rolls over to 0000Hand continue counting.
PS019921-0308
Timers
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
84
Follow the steps below for configuring a timer for COMPARE mode and initiating the
count:
1. Write to the Timer Control 1 register to:
–
–
–
–
Disable the timer
Configure the timer for COMPARE mode
Set the prescale value
Set the initial logic level (High or Low) for the Timer Output alternate function, if
desired
2. Write to the Timer High and Low Byte registers to set the starting count value.
3. Write to the Timer Reload High and Low Byte registers to set the Compare value.
4. If desired, enable the timer interrupt and set the timer interrupt priority by writing to
the relevant interrupt registers.
5. If using the Timer Output function, configure the associated GPIO port pin for the
Timer Output alternate function.
6. Write to the Timer Control 1 register to enable the timer and initiate counting.
In COMPARE mode, the system clock always provides the timer input. The Compare time
is given by the following equation:
(Compare Value – Start Value) × Prescale
COMPARE Mode Time (s) = -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
System Clock Frequency (Hz)
GATED Mode
In GATED mode, the timer counts only when the Timer Input signal is in its active state
(asserted), as determined by the TPOLbit in the Timer Control 1 register. When the Timer
Input signal is asserted, counting begins. A timer interrupt is generated when the Timer
Input signal is deasserted or a timer reload occurs. To determine if a Timer Input signal
deassertion generated the interrupt, read the associated GPIO input value and compare to
the value stored in the TPOLbit.
The timer counts up to the 16-bit Reload value stored in the Timer Reload High and Low
Byte registers. The timer input is the system clock. When reaching the Reload value, the
timer generates an interrupt, the count value in the Timer High and Low Byte registers is
reset to 0001Hand counting resumes (assuming the Timer Input signal is still asserted).
Also, if the Timer Output alternate function is enabled, the Timer Output pin changes state
(from Low to High or from High to Low) at timer reset.
Follow the steps below for configuring a timer for GATED mode and initiating the count:
1. Write to the Timer Control 1 register to:
–
–
Disable the timer
Configure the timer for GATED mode
PS019921-0308
Timers
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
85
–
Set the prescale value
2. Write to the Timer High and Low Byte registers to set the starting count value. This
only affects the first pass in GATED mode. After the first timer reset in GATED mode,
counting always begins at the reset value of 0001H.
3. Write to the Timer Reload High and Low Byte registers to set the Reload value.
4. If desired, enable the timer interrupt and set the timer interrupt priority by writing to
the relevant interrupt registers.
5. Configure the associated GPIO port pin for the Timer Input alternate function.
6. Write to the Timer Control 1 register to enable the timer.
7. Assert the Timer Input signal to initiate the counting.
CAPTURE/COMPARE Mode
In CAPTURE/COMPARE mode, the timer begins counting on the first external Timer
Input transition. The desired transition (rising edge or falling edge) is set by the TPOLbit
in the Timer Control 1 Register. The timer input is the system clock.
Every subsequent desired transition (after the first) of the Timer Input signal captures the
current count value. The Capture value is written to the Timer PWM High and Low Byte
Registers. When the Capture event occurs, an interrupt is generated, the count value in the
Timer High and Low Byte registers is reset to 0001H, and counting resumes.
If no Capture event occurs, the timer counts up to the 16-bit Compare value stored in the
Timer Reload High and Low Byte registers. Upon reaching the Compare value, the timer
generates an interrupt, the count value in the Timer High and Low Byte registers is reset to
0001H and counting resumes.
Follow the steps below for configuring a timer for CAPTURE/COMPARE mode and initi-
ating the count:
1. Write to the Timer Control 1 register to:
–
–
–
–
Disable the timer
Configure the timer for CAPTURE/COMPARE mode
Set the prescale value
Set the Capture edge (rising or falling) for the Timer Input
2. Write to the Timer High and Low Byte registers to set the starting count value
(typically 0001H).
3. Write to the Timer Reload High and Low Byte registers to set the Compare value.
4. If desired, enable the timer interrupt and set the timer interrupt priority by writing to
the relevant interrupt registers.
5. Configure the associated GPIO port pin for the Timer Input alternate function.
PS019921-0308
Timers
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
86
6. Write to the Timer Control 1 register to enable the timer.
7. Counting begins on the first appropriate transition of the Timer Input signal. No
interrupt is generated by this first edge.
In m/COMPARE mode, the elapsed time from timer start to Capture event can be calcu-
lated using the following equation:
(Capture Value – Start Value) × Prescale
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
System Clock Frequency (Hz)
Capture Elapsed Time (s) =
Reading the Timer Count Values
The current count value in the timers can be read while counting (enabled). This capability
has no effect on timer operation. When the timer is enabled and the Timer High Byte
register is read, the contents of the Timer Low Byte register are placed in a holding
register. A subsequent read from the Timer Low Byte register returns the value in the
holding register. This operation allows accurate reads of the full 16-bit timer count value
while enabled. When the timers are not enabled, a read from the Timer Low Byte register
returns the actual value in the counter.
Timer Output Signal Operation
Timer Output is a GPIO Port pin alternate function. Generally, the Timer Output is toggled
every time the counter is reloaded.
Timer Control Register Definitions
Timers 0-2 are available in all packages. Timer 3 is only available in the 64-, 68-, and
80-pin packages.
Timer 0-3 High and Low Byte Registers
The Timer 0-3 High and Low Byte (TxH and TxL) registers (see Table 39 and Table 40 on
page 87) contain the current 16-bit timer count value. When the timer is enabled, a read
from TxH causes the value in TxL to be stored in a temporary holding register. A read
from TMRL always returns this temporary register when the timers are enabled. When the
timer is disabled, reads from the TMRL reads the register directly.
Writing to the Timer High and Low Byte registers while the timer is enabled is not
recommended. There are no temporary holding registers available for write operations, so
simultaneous 16-bit writes are not possible. If either the Timer High or Low Byte registers
are written during counting, the 8-bit written value is placed in the counter (High or Low
Byte) at the next clock edge. The counter continues counting from the new value.
Timer 3 is unavailable in the 44-pin packages.
PS019921-0308
Timers
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
87
Table 39. Timer 0-3 High Byte Register (TxH)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
2
1
1
0
TH
0
FIELD
RESET
R/W
R/W
F00H, F08H, F10H, F18H
ADDR
Table 40. Timer 0-3 Low Byte Register (TxL)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
0
TL
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
1
R/W
F01H, F09H, F11H, F19H
ADDR
TH and TL—Timer High and Low Bytes
These 2 bytes, {TMRH[7:0], TMRL[7:0]}, contain the current 16-bit timer count value.
Timer Reload High and Low Byte Registers
The Timer 0-3 Reload High and Low Byte (TxRH and TxRL) registers (see Table 41and
Table 42 on page 88) store a 16-bit reload value, {TRH[7:0], TRL[7:0]}. Values written to
the Timer Reload High Byte register are stored in a temporary holding register. When a
write to the Timer Reload Low Byte register occurs, the temporary holding register value
is written to the Timer High Byte register. This operation allows simultaneous updates of
the 16-bit Timer Reload value.
In COMPARE mode, the Timer Reload High and Low Byte registers store the 16-bit
Compare value.
Table 41. Timer 0-3 Reload High Byte Register (TxRH)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TRH
1
FIELD
RESET
R/W
R/W
F02H, F0AH, F12H, F1AH
ADDR
PS019921-0308
Timers
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
88
Table 42. Timer 0-3 Reload Low Byte Register (TxRL)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TRL
1
FIELD
RESET
R/W
R/W
F03H, F0BH, F13H, F1BH
ADDR
TRH and TRL—Timer Reload Register High and Low
These two bytes form the 16-bit Reload value, {TRH[7:0], TRL[7:0]}. This value sets the
maximum count value which initiates a timer reload to 0001H. In COMPARE mode, these
two byte form the 16-bit Compare value.
Timer 0-3 PWM High and Low Byte Registers
The Timer 0-3 PWM High and Low Byte (TxPWMH and TxPWML) registers (see
Table 43 and Table 44 on page 88) are used for Pulse-Width Modulator (PWM) opera-
tions. These registers also store the Capture values for the Capture and Capture/COM-
PARE modes.
Table 43. Timer 0-3 PWM High Byte Register (TxPWMH)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PWMH
0
FIELD
RESET
R/W
R/W
F04H, F0CH, F14H, F1CH
ADDR
Table 44. Timer 0-3 PWM Low Byte Register (TxPWML)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PWML
0
FIELD
RESET
R/W
R/W
F05H, F0DH, F15H, F1DH
ADDR
PS019921-0308
Timers
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
89
PWMH and PWML—Pulse-Width Modulator High and Low Bytes
These two bytes, {PWMH[7:0], PWML[7:0]}, form a 16-bit value that is compared to the
current 16-bit timer count. When a match occurs, the PWM output changes state. The
PWM output value is set by the TPOLbit in the Timer Control 1 Register (TxCTL1) regis-
ter.
The TxPWMH and TxPWML registers also store the 16-bit captured timer value when
operating in CAPTURE or CAPTURE/COMPARE modes.
Timer 0-3 Control 0 Registers
The Timer 0-3 Control 0 (TxCTL0) registers (see Table 45 and Table 46) allow cascading
of the Timers.
Table 45. Timer 0-3 Control 0 Register (TxCTL0)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reserved
CSC
Reserved
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
R/W
F06H, F0EH, F16H, F1EH
ADDR
CSC—Cascade Timers
0 = Timer Input signal comes from the pin.
1 = For Timer 0, Input signal is connected to Timer 3 output.
For Timer 1, Input signal is connected to Timer 0 output.
For Timer 2, Input signal is connected to Timer 1 output.
For Timer 3, Input signal is connected to Timer 2 output.
PS019921-0308
Timers
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
90
Timer 0-3 Control 1 Registers
The Timer 0-3 Control 1 (TxCTL1) registers enable/disable the timers, set the prescaler
value, and determine the timer operating mode.
Table 46. Timer 0-3 Control 1 Register (TxCTL1)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TEN
TPOL
PRES
TMODE
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
R/W
F07H, F0FH, F17H, F1FH
ADDR
TEN—Timer Enable
0 = Timer is disabled.
1 = Timer enabled to count.
TPOL—Timer Input/Output Polarity
Operation of this bit is a function of the current operating mode of the timer.
ONE-SHOT mode
When the timer is disabled, the Timer Output signal is set to the value of this bit.
When the timer is enabled, the Timer Output signal is complemented upon timer
Reload.
CONTINUOUS mode
When the timer is disabled, the Timer Output signal is set to the value of this bit.
When the timer is enabled, the Timer Output signal is complemented upon timer
Reload.
COUNTER mode
When the timer is disabled, the Timer Output signal is set to the value of this bit.
When the timer is enabled, the Timer Output signal is complemented upon timer
Reload.
0 = Count occurs on the rising edge of the Timer Input signal.
1 = Count occurs on the falling edge of the Timer Input signal.
PWM mode
0 = Timer Output is forced Low (0) when the timer is disabled. When enabled,
the Timer Output is forced High (1) upon PWM count match and forced
Low (0) upon Reload.
PS019921-0308
Timers
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
91
1 = Timer Output is forced High (1) when the timer is disabled. When enabled, the
Timer Output is forced Low (0) upon PWM count match and forced High (1) upon
Reload.
CAPTURE mode
0 = Count is captured on the rising edge of the Timer Input signal.
1 = Count is captured on the falling edge of the Timer Input signal.
COMPARE mode
When the timer is disabled, the Timer Output signal is set to the value of this bit.
When the timer is enabled, the Timer Output signal is complemented upon timer
Reload.
GATED mode
0 = Timer counts when the Timer Input signal is High (1) and interrupts are
generated on the falling edge of the Timer Input.
1 = Timer counts when the Timer Input signal is Low (0) and interrupts are
generated on the rising edge of the Timer Input.
CAPTURE/COMPARE mode
0 = Counting is started on the first rising edge of the Timer Input signal. The
current count is captured on subsequent rising edges of the Timer Input signal.
1 = Counting is started on the first falling edge of the Timer Input signal. The
current count is captured on subsequent falling edges of the Timer Input signal.
When the Timer Output alternate function TxOUT on a GPIO port pin is en-
abled, TxOUT will change to whatever state the TPOL bit is in. The timer does
not need to be enabled for that to happen. Also, the Port data direction sub reg-
ister is not needed to be set to output on TxOUT. Changing the TPOL bit with
the timer enabled and running does not immediately change the TxOUT.
Caution:
PRES—Prescale value.
The timer input clock is divided by 2PRES, where PRES can be set from 0 to 7. The
prescaler is reset each time the Timer is disabled. This insures proper clock division
each time the Timer is restarted.
000 = Divide by 1
001 = Divide by 2
010 = Divide by 4
011 = Divide by 8
100 = Divide by 16
101 = Divide by 32
PS019921-0308
Timers
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
92
110 = Divide by 64
111 = Divide by 128
TMODE—TIMER mode
000 = ONE-SHOT mode
001 = CONTINUOUS mode
010 = COUNTER mode
011 = PWM mode
100 = CAPTURE mode
101 = COMPARE mode
110 = GATED mode
111 = CAPTURE/COMPARE mode
PS019921-0308
Timers
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
93
Watchdog Timer
The Watchdog Timer (WDT) helps protect against corrupt or unreliable software, power
faults, and other system-level problems which may place the Z8 Encore! XP into unsuit-
able operating states. The features of Watchdog Timer include:
•
•
•
•
On-chip RC oscillator.
A selectable time-out response.
WDT Time-out response: Reset or interrupt.
24-bit programmable time-out value.
Operation
The Watchdog Timer (WDT) is a retriggerable one-shot timer that resets or interrupts the
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series devices when the WDT reaches its terminal count. The
Watchdog Timer uses its own dedicated on-chip RC oscillator as its clock source. The
Watchdog Timer has only two modes of operation—ON and OFF. Once enabled, it always
counts and must be refreshed to prevent a time-out. An enable can be performed by exe-
cuting the WDT instruction or by setting the WDT_AOOption Bit. The WDT_AObit
enables the Watchdog Timer to operate all the time, even if a WDT instruction has not
been executed.
The Watchdog Timer is a 24-bit reloadable downcounter that uses three 8-bit registers in
the eZ8™ CPU register space to set the reload value. The nominal WDT time-out period is
given by the following equation:
WDT Reload Value
-----------------------------------------------
10
WDT Time-out Period (ms) =
where the WDT reload value is the decimal value of the 24-bit value given by
{WDTU[7:0], WDTH[7:0], WDTL[7:0]} and the typical Watchdog Timer RC oscillator
frequency is 10 kHz. The Watchdog Timer cannot be refreshed once it reaches 000002H.
The WDT Reload Value must not be set to values below 000004H. Table 47 provides
information on approximate time-out delays for the minimum and maximum WDT reload
values.
PS019921-0308
Watchdog Timer
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
94
Table 47. Watchdog Timer Approximate Time-Out Delays
Approximate Time-Out Delay
(with 10 kHz typical WDT oscillator frequency)
WDT Reload Value WDT Reload Value
(Hex)
000004
FFFFFF
(Decimal)
4
Typical
400 µs
Description
Minimum time-out delay
Maximum time-out delay
16,777,215
1677.5 s
Watchdog Timer Refresh
When first enabled, the Watchdog Timer is loaded with the value in the Watchdog Timer
Reload registers. The Watchdog Timer then counts down to 000000Hunless a WDT
instruction is executed by the eZ8™ CPU. Execution of the WDT instruction causes the
downcounter to be reloaded with the WDT Reload value stored in the Watchdog Timer
Reload registers. Counting resumes following the reload operation.
When the Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series devices are operating in DEBUG Mode
(through the On-Chip Debugger), the Watchdog Timer is continuously refreshed to pre-
vent spurious Watchdog Timer time-outs.
Watchdog Timer Time-Out Response
The Watchdog Timer times out when the counter reaches 000000H. A time-out of the
Watchdog Timer generates either an interrupt or a Reset. The WDT_RESOption Bit
determines the time-out response of the Watchdog Timer. For information on
programming of the WDT_RESOption Bit, see Option Bits on page 191.
WDT Interrupt in Normal Operation
If configured to generate an interrupt when a time-out occurs, the Watchdog Timer issues
an interrupt request to the interrupt controller and sets the WDTstatus bit in the Watchdog
Timer Control register. If interrupts are enabled, the eZ8 CPU responds to the interrupt
request by fetching the Watchdog Timer interrupt vector and executing code from the
vector address. After time-out and interrupt generation, the Watchdog Timer counter rolls
over to its maximum value of FFFFFHand continues counting. The Watchdog Timer
counter is not automatically returned to its Reload Value.
WDT Interrupt in STOP Mode
If configured to generate an interrupt when a time-out occurs and the Z8 Encore! XP
F64XX Series devices are in STOP mode, the Watchdog Timer automatically initiates a
Stop Mode Recovery and generates an interrupt request. Both the WDTstatus bit and the
STOPbit in the Watchdog Timer Control register are set to 1 following WDT time-out in
PS019921-0308
Watchdog Timer
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
95
STOP mode. For more information on Stop Mode Recovery, see Reset and Stop Mode
Recovery on page 45.
If interrupts are enabled, following completion of the Stop Mode Recovery the eZ8 CPU
responds to the interrupt request by fetching the Watchdog Timer interrupt vector and exe-
cuting code from the vector address.
WDT Reset in Normal Operation
If configured to generate a Reset when a time-out occurs, the Watchdog Timer forces the
device into the Reset state. The WDTstatus bit in the Watchdog Timer Control register is
set to 1. For more information on Reset, see Reset and Stop Mode Recovery on page 45.
WDT Reset in STOP Mode
If enabled in STOP mode and configured to generate a Reset when a time-out occurs and
the device is in STOP mode, the Watchdog Timer initiates a Stop Mode Recovery. Both
the WDTstatus bit and the STOPbit in the Watchdog Timer Control register are set to 1
following WDT time-out in STOP mode. Default operation is for the WDT and its RC
oscillator to be enabled during STOP mode.
WDT RC Disable in STOP Mode
To minimize power consumption in STOP Mode, the WDT and its RC oscillator can be
disabled in STOP mode. The following sequence configures the WDT to be disabled when
the Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series devices enter STOP Mode following execution of a
STOP instruction:
1. Write 55Hto the Watchdog Timer Control register (WDTCTL).
2. Write AAHto the Watchdog Timer Control register (WDTCTL).
3. Write 81Hto the Watchdog Timer Control register (WDTCTL) to configure the WDT
and its oscillator to be disabled during STOP Mode. Alternatively, write 00Hto the
Watchdog Timer Control register (WDTCTL) as the third step in this sequence to
reconfigure the WDT and its oscillator to be enabled during STOP mode.
This sequence only affects WDT operation in STOP mode.
Watchdog Timer Reload Unlock Sequence
Writing the unlock sequence to the Watchdog Timer (WDTCTL) Control register address
unlocks the three Watchdog Timer Reload Byte registers (WDTU, WDTH, and WDTL) to
allow changes to the time-out period. These write operations to the WDTCTL register
address produce no effect on the bits in the WDTCTL register. The locking mechanism
prevents spurious writes to the Reload registers. Follow the steps below to unlock the
Watchdog Timer Reload Byte registers (WDTU, WDTH, and WDTL) for write access.
1. Write 55Hto the Watchdog Timer Control register (WDTCTL).
PS019921-0308
Watchdog Timer
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
96
2. Write AAHto the Watchdog Timer Control register (WDTCTL).
3. Write the Watchdog Timer Reload Upper Byte register (WDTU).
4. Write the Watchdog Timer Reload High Byte register (WDTH).
5. Write the Watchdog Timer Reload Low Byte register (WDTL).
All steps of the Watchdog Timer Reload Unlock sequence must be written in the order just
listed. There must be no other register writes between each of these operations. If a regis-
ter write occurs, the lock state machine resets and no further writes can occur, unless the
sequence is restarted. The value in the Watchdog Timer Reload registers is loaded into the
counter when the Watchdog Timer is first enabled and every time a WDT instruction is
executed.
Watchdog Timer Control Register Definitions
Watchdog Timer Control Register
The Watchdog Timer Control (WDTCTL) register (Table 48) is a Read-Only register that
indicates the source of the most recent Reset event, indicates a Stop Mode Recovery event,
and indicates a Watchdog Timer time-out. Reading this register resets the upper four bits
to 0.
Writing the 55H, AAHunlock sequence to the Watchdog Timer Control (WDTCTL) regis-
ter address unlocks the three Watchdog Timer Reload Byte registers (WDTU, WDTH, and
WDTL) to allow changes to the time-out period. These write operations to the WDTCTL
register address produce no effect on the bits in the WDTCTL register. The locking mech-
anism prevents spurious writes to the Reload registers.
Table 48. Watchdog Timer Control Register (WDTCTL)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
POR
STOP
WDT
EXT
Reserved
SM
FIELD
RESET
R/W
See descriptions below
0
R
FF0H
ADDR
PS019921-0308
Watchdog Timer
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
97
Reset or Stop Mode Recovery Event
Power-On Reset
Reset using RESET pin assertion
Reset using Watchdog Timer time-out
POR STOP WDT EXT
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
0
0
1
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
Reset using the On-Chip Debugger (OCDCTL[1] set to 1) 1
Reset from STOP Mode using DBG Pin driven Low
Stop Mode Recovery using GPIO pin transition
Stop Mode Recovery using Watchdog Timer time-out
1
0
0
POR—Power-On Reset Indicator
If this bit is set to 1, a Power-On Reset event occurred. This bit is reset to 0 if a WDT time-
out or Stop Mode Recovery occurs. This bit is also reset to 0 when the register is read.
STOP—Stop Mode Recovery Indicator
If this bit is set to 1, a Stop Mode Recovery occurred. If the STOPand WDTbits are both
set to 1, the Stop Mode Recovery occurred due to a WDT time-out. If the STOPbit is 1
and the WDTbit is 0, the Stop Mode Recovery was not caused by a WDT time-out. This bit
is reset by a Power-On Reset or a WDT time-out that occurred while not in STOP mode.
Reading this register also resets this bit.
WDT—Watchdog Timer Time-Out Indicator
If this bit is set to 1, a WDT time-out occurred. A Power-On Reset resets this pin. A Stop
Mode Recovery from a change in an input pin also resets this bit. Reading this register
resets this bit.
EXT—External Reset Indicator
If this bit is set to 1, a Reset initiated by the external RESET pin occurred. A Power-On
Reset or a Stop Mode Recovery from a change in an input pin resets this bit. Reading this
register resets this bit.
Reserved
These bits are reserved and must be 0.
SM—STOP Mode Configuration Indicator
0 = Watchdog Timer and its internal RC oscillator will continue to operate in STOP Mode.
1 = Watchdog Timer and its internal RC oscillator will be disabled in STOP Mode.
Watchdog Timer Reload Upper, High and Low Byte Registers
The Watchdog Timer Reload Upper, High and Low Byte (WDTU, WDTH, WDTL) regis-
ters (see Table 49 on page 98 through Table 51 on page 98) form the 24-bit reload value
that is loaded into the Watchdog Timer when a WDT instruction executes. The 24-bit
reload value is {WDTU[7:0], WDTH[7:0], WDTL[7:0]}. Writing to these registers sets
the desired Reload Value. Reading from these registers returns the current Watchdog
Timer count value.
PS019921-0308
Watchdog Timer
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
98
Caution: The 24-bit WDT Reload Value must not be set to a value less than 000004H.
Table 49. Watchdog Timer Reload Upper Byte Register (WDTU)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
WDTU
1
FIELD
RESET
R/W
R/W*
FF1H
ADDR
Note: R/W* - Read returns the current WDT count value. Write sets the desired Reload Value.
WDTU—WDT Reload Upper Byte
Most significant byte, Bits[23:16], of the 24-bit WDT reload value.
Table 50. Watchdog Timer Reload High Byte Register (WDTH)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
WDTH
1
FIELD
RESET
R/W
R/W*
FF2H
ADDR
Note: R/W* - Read returns the current WDT count value. Write sets the desired Reload Value.
WDTH—WDT Reload High Byte
Middle byte, Bits[15:8], of the 24-bit WDT reload value.
Table 51. Watchdog Timer Reload Low Byte Register (WDTL)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
WDTL
1
FIELD
RESET
R/W
R/W*
FF3H
ADDR
Note: R/W* - Read returns the current WDT count value. Write sets the desired Reload Value.
WDTL—WDT Reload Low
Least significant byte, Bits[7:0], of the 24-bit WDT reload value.
PS019921-0308
Watchdog Timer
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
99
UART
The Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter (UART) is a full-duplex communica-
tion channel capable of handling asynchronous data transfers. The UART uses a single
8-bit data mode with selectable parity. Features of the UART include:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
8-bit asynchronous data transfer
Selectable even- and odd-parity generation and checking
Option of one or two Stop bits
Separate transmit and receive interrupts
Framing, parity, overrun and break detection
Separate transmit and receive enables
16-bit Baud Rate Generator (BRG)
Selectable MULTIPROCESSOR (9-bit) mode with three configurable interrupt
schemes
•
•
Baud Rate Generator timer mode
Driver Enable output for external bus transceivers
Architecture
The UART consists of three primary functional blocks: Transmitter, Receiver, and Baud
rate generator. The UART’s transmitter and receiver function independently, but employ
the same baud rate and data format. Figure 12 on page 100 displays the UART architec-
ture.
PS019921-0308
UART
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
100
Parity Checker
Receive Shifter
Receiver Control
with address compare
RXD
Receive Data
Register
Control Registers
System Bus
Transmit Data
Register
Status Register
Baud Rate
Generator
Transmit Shift
Register
TXD
Transmitter Control
Parity Generator
CTS
DE
Figure 12. UART Block Diagram
Operation
Data Format
The UART always transmits and receives data in an 8-bit data format, least-significant bit
first. An even or odd parity bit can be optionally added to the data stream. Each character
begins with an active Low Start bit and ends with either 1 or 2 active High Stop bits.
Figure 13 and Figure 14 on page 101 displays the asynchronous data format employed by
the UART without parity and with parity, respectively.
PS019921-0308
UART
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
101
Data Field
Stop Bit(s)
msb
Idle State
of Line
lsb
1
0
Start
Bit0
Bit1
Bit2
Bit3
Bit4
Bit5
Bit6
Bit7
1
2
Figure 13. UART Asynchronous Data Format without Parity
Data Field
Stop Bit(s)
Idle State
of Line
lsb
msb
Bit7
1
0
Start
Bit0
Bit1
Bit2
Bit3
Bit4
Bit5
Bit6
Parity
1
2
Figure 14. UART Asynchronous Data Format with Parity
Transmitting Data using the Polled Method
Follow the steps below to transmit data using the polled method of operation:
1. Write to the UART Baud Rate High and Low Byte registers to set the desired baud
rate.
2. Enable the UART pin functions by configuring the associated GPIO Port pins for
alternate function operation.
3. If MULTIPROCESSOR mode is desired, write to the UART Control 1 register to
enable MULTIPROCESSOR (9-bit) mode functions.
–
Set the MULTIPROCESSOR Mode Select (MPEN) to Enable
MULTIPROCESSOR mode.
4. Write to the UART Control 0 register to:
–
–
Set the transmit enable bit (TEN) to enable the UART for data transmission
If parity is desired and MULTIPROCESSOR mode is not enabled, set the parity
enable bit (PEN) and select either Even or Odd parity (PSEL).
PS019921-0308
UART
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
102
–
Set or clear the CTSEbit to enable or disable control from the remote receiver
using the CTS pin.
5. Check the TDREbit in the UART Status 0 register to determine if the Transmit Data
register is empty (indicated by a 1). If empty, continue to step 6. If the Transmit Data
register is full (indicated by a 0), continue to monitor the TDREbit until the Transmit
Data register becomes available to receive new data.
6. Write the UART Control 1 register to select the outgoing address bit.
7. Set the MULTIPROCESSOR Bit Transmitter (MPBT) if sending an address byte, clear
it if sending a data byte.
8. Write the data byte to the UART Transmit Data register. The transmitter automatically
transfers the data to the Transmit Shift register and transmits the data.
9. If desired and MULTIPROCESSOR mode is enabled, make any changes to the
MULTIPROCESSOR Bit Transmitter (MPBT) value.
10. To transmit additional bytes, return to step 5.
Transmitting Data using the Interrupt-Driven Method
The UART transmitter interrupt indicates the availability of the Transmit Data register to
accept new data for transmission. Follow the steps below to configure the UART for inter-
rupt-driven data transmission:
1. Write to the UART Baud Rate High and Low Byte registers to set the desired baud
rate.
2. Enable the UART pin functions by configuring the associated GPIO Port pins for
alternate function operation.
3. Execute a DI instruction to disable interrupts.
4. Write to the Interrupt control registers to enable the UART Transmitter interrupt and
set the desired priority.
5. If MULTIPROCESSOR mode is desired, write to the UART Control 1 register to
enable MULTIPROCESSOR (9-bit) mode functions.
6. Set the MULTIPROCESSOR Mode Select (MPEN) to Enable MULTIPROCESSOR
mode.
7. Write to the UART Control 0 register to:
–
–
Set the transmit enable bit (TEN) to enable the UART for data transmission.
Enable parity, if desired and if MULTIPROCESSOR mode is not enabled, and
select either even or odd parity.
–
Set or clear the CTSEbit to enable or disable control from the remote receiver via
the CTS pin.
PS019921-0308
UART
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
103
8. Execute an EI instruction to enable interrupts.
The UART is now configured for interrupt-driven data transmission. Because the UART
Transmit Data register is empty, an interrupt is generated immediately. When the UART
Transmit interrupt is detected, the associated interrupt service routine performs the follow-
ing:
1. Write the UART Control 1 register to select the outgoing address bit:
–
Set the MULTIPROCESSOR Bit Transmitter (MPBT) if sending an address byte,
clear it if sending a data byte.
2. Write the data byte to the UART Transmit Data register. The transmitter automatically
transfers the data to the Transmit Shift register and transmits the data.
3. Clear the UART Transmit interrupt bit in the applicable Interrupt Request register.
4. Execute the IRET instruction to return from the interrupt-service routine and wait for
the Transmit Data register to again become empty.
Receiving Data using the Polled Method
Follow the steps below to configure the UART for polled data reception:
1. Write to the UART Baud Rate High and Low Byte registers to set the desired baud
rate.
2. Enable the UART pin functions by configuring the associated GPIO Port pins for
alternate function operation.
3. Write to the UART Control 1 register to enable MULTIPROCESSOR mode functions,
if desired.
4. Write to the UART Control 0 register to:
–
–
Set the receive enable bit (REN) to enable the UART for data reception.
Enable parity, if desired and if MULTIPROCESSOR mode is not enabled, and
select either even or odd parity.
5. Check the RDAbit in the UART Status 0 register to determine if the Receive Data
register contains a valid data byte (indicated by a 1). If RDAis set to 1 to indicate
available data, continue to step 6. If the Receive Data register is empty (indicated by a
0), continue to monitor the RDA bit awaiting reception of the valid data.
6. Read data from the UART Receive Data register. If operating in MULTIPROCESSOR
(9-bit) mode, further actions may be required depending on the MULTIPROCESSOR
Mode bits MPMD[1:0].
7. Return to step 5 to receive additional data.
PS019921-0308
UART
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
104
Receiving Data using the Interrupt-Driven Method
The UART Receiver interrupt indicates the availability of new data (as well as error con-
ditions). Follow the steps below to configure the UART receiver for interrupt-driven oper-
ation:
1. Write to the UART Baud Rate High and Low Byte registers to set the desired baud
rate.
2. Enable the UART pin functions by configuring the associated GPIO Port pins for
alternate function operation.
3. Execute a DIinstruction to disable interrupts.
4. Write to the Interrupt control registers to enable the UART Receiver interrupt and set
the desired priority.
5. Clear the UART Receiver interrupt in the applicable Interrupt Request register.
6. Write to the UART Control 1 Register to enable MULTIPROCESSOR (9-bit) mode
functions, if desired.
–
–
–
Set the MULTIPROCESSOR Mode Select (MPEN) to Enable
MULTIPROCESSOR mode.
Set the MULTIPROCESSOR Mode Bits, MPMD[1:0],to select the desired
address matching scheme.
Configure the UART to interrupt on received data and errors or errors only
(interrupt on errors only is unlikely to be useful for Z8 Encore! XP devices
without a DMA block).
7. Write the device address to the Address Compare Register (automatic multiprocessor
modes only).
8. Write to the UART Control 0 register to:
–
–
Set the receive enable bit (REN) to enable the UART for data reception.
Enable parity, if desired and if MULTIPROCESSOR mode is not enabled, and
select either even or odd parity.
9. Execute an EIinstruction to enable interrupts.
The UART is now configured for interrupt-driven data reception. When the UART
Receiver interrupt is detected, the associated interrupt service routine performs the follow-
ing:
1. Check the UART Status 0 register to determine the source of the interrupt - error,
break, or received data.
2. If the interrupt was caused by data available, read the data from the UART Receive
Data register. If operating in MULTIPROCESSOR (9-bit) mode, further actions may
be required depending on the MULTIPROCESSOR Mode bits MPMD[1:0].
PS019921-0308
UART
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
105
3. Clear the UART Receiver interrupt in the applicable Interrupt Request register.
4. Execute the IRET instruction to return from the interrupt-service routine and await
more data.
Clear To Send (CTS) Operation
The CTS pin, if enabled by the CTSE bit of the UART Control 0 register, performs flow
control on the outgoing transmit datastream. The Clear To Send (CTS) input pin is sam-
pled one system clock before beginning any new character transmission. To delay trans-
mission of the next data character, an external receiver must deassert CTS at least one
system clock cycle before a new data transmission begins. For multiple character trans-
missions, this would typically be done during Stop Bit transmission. If CTS deasserts in
the middle of a character transmission, the current character is sent completely.
MULTIPROCESSOR (9-bit) Mode
The UART has a MULTIPROCESSOR (9-bit) mode that uses an extra (9th) bit for selec-
tive communication when a number of processors share a common UART bus. In MULTI-
PROCESSOR mode (also referred to as 9-Bit mode), the multiprocessor bit (MP) is
transmitted immediately following the 8-bits of data and immediately preceding the Stop
bit(s) as displayed in Figure 15. The character format is:
Data Field
Stop Bit(s)
Idle State
of Line
lsb
msb
Bit7
1
0
Start
Bit0
Bit1
Bit2
Bit3
Bit4
Bit5
Bit6
MP
1
2
Figure 15. UART Asynchronous MULTIPROCESSOR Mode Data Format
In MULTIPROCESSOR (9-bit) mode, the Parity bit location (9th bit) becomes the MUL-
TIPROCESSOR control bit. The UART Control 1 and Status 1 registers provide MULTI-
PROCESSOR (9-bit) mode control and status information. If an automatic address
matching scheme is enabled, the UART Address Compare register holds the network
address of the device.
MULTIPROCESSOR (9-bit) Mode Receive Interrupts
When MULTIPROCESSOR mode is enabled, the UART only processes frames addressed
to it. The determination of whether a frame of data is addressed to the UART can be made
in hardware, software or some combination of the two, depending on the multiprocessor
PS019921-0308
UART
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
106
configuration bits. In general, the address compare feature reduces the load on the CPU,
since it does not need to access the UART when it receives data directed to other devices
on the multi-node network. The following three MULTIPROCESSOR modes are avail-
able in hardware:
•
•
•
Interrupt on all address bytes.
Interrupt on matched address bytes and correctly framed data bytes.
Interrupt only on correctly framed data bytes.
These modes are selected with MPMD[1:0]in the UART Control 1 Register. For all
MULTIPROCESSOR modes, bit MPENof the UART Control 1 Register must be set to 1.
The first scheme is enabled by writing 01b to MPMD[1:0]. In this mode, all incoming
address bytes cause an interrupt, while data bytes never cause an interrupt. The interrupt
service routine must manually check the address byte that caused triggered the interrupt. If
it matches the UART address, the software clears MPMD[0]. At this point, each new
incoming byte interrupts the CPU. The software is then responsible for determining the
end of the frame. It checks for end-of-frame by reading the MPRXbit of the UART Status
1 Register for each incoming byte. If MPRX=1, a new frame has begun. If the address of
this new frame is different from the UART’s address, then set MPMD[0]to 1 causing the
UART interrupts to go inactive until the next address byte. If the new frame’s address
matches the UART’s, the data in the new frame is processed as well.
The second scheme is enabled by setting MPMD[1:0]to 10b and writing the UART’s
address into the UART Address Compare Register. This mode introduces more hardware
control, interrupting only on frames that match the UART’s address. When an incoming
address byte does not match the UART’s address, it is ignored. All successive data bytes in
this frame are also ignored. When a matching address byte occurs, an interrupt is issued
and further interrupts now occur on each successive data byte. The first data byte in the
frame contains the NEWFRM=1 in the UART Status 1 Register. When the next address byte
occurs, the hardware compares it to the UART’s address. If there is a match, the interrupts
continue sand the NEWFRMbit is set for the first byte of the new frame. If there is no
match, then the UART ignores all incoming bytes until the next address match.
The third scheme is enabled by setting MPMD[1:0]to 11b and by writing the UART’s
address into the UART Address Compare Register. This mode is identical to the second
scheme, except that there are no interrupts on address bytes. The first data byte of each
frame is still accompanied by a NEWFRMassertion.
External Driver Enable
The UART provides a Driver Enable (DE) signal for off-chip bus transceivers. This feature
reduces the software overhead associated with using a GPIO pin to control the transceiver
when communicating on a multi-transceiver bus, such as RS-485.
Driver Enable is an active High signal that envelopes the entire transmitted data frame
including parity and Stop bits as displayed in Figure 16. The Driver Enable signal asserts
PS019921-0308
UART
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
107
when a byte is written to the UART Transmit Data register. The Driver Enable signal
asserts at least one UART bit period and no greater than two UART bit periods before the
Start bit is transmitted. This timing allows a setup time to enable the transceiver. The
Driver Enable signal deasserts one system clock period after the last Stop bit is transmit-
ted. This one system clock delay allows both time for data to clear the transceiver before
disabling it, as well as the ability to determine if another character follows the current
character. In the event of back to back characters (new data must be written to the Trans-
mit Data Register before the previous character is completely transmitted) the DEsignal is
not deasserted between characters. The DEPOLbit in the UART Control Register 1 sets the
polarity of the Driver Enable signal.
1
DE
0
Data Field
Stop Bit
Idle State
of Line
lsb
msb
Bit7
1
0
Start
Bit0
Bit1
Bit2
Bit3
Bit4
Bit5
Bit6
Parity
1
Figure 16. UART Driver Enable Signal Timing (shown with 1 Stop Bit and Parity)
The Driver Enable to Start bit setup time is calculated as follows:
1
2
-------------------------------------
-------------------------------------
≤ DE to Start Bit Setup Time (s) ≤
Baud Rate (Hz)
Baud Rate (Hz)
UART Interrupts
The UART features separate interrupts for the transmitter and the receiver. In addition,
when the UART primary functionality is disabled, the Baud Rate Generator can also func-
tion as a basic timer with interrupt capability.
Transmitter Interrupts
The transmitter generates a single interrupt when the Transmit Data Register Empty bit
(TDRE) is set to 1. This indicates that the transmitter is ready to accept new data for trans-
mission. The TDREinterrupt occurs after the Transmit shift register has shifted the first bit
of data out. At this point, the Transmit Data register may be written with the next character
to send. This provides 7 bit periods of latency to load the Transmit Data register before the
Transmit shift register completes shifting the current character. Writing to the UART
Transmit Data register clears the TDREbit to 0.
PS019921-0308
UART
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
108
Receiver Interrupts
The receiver generates an interrupt when any of the following occurs:
•
A data byte has been received and is available in the UART Receive Data register.
This interrupt can be disabled independent of the other receiver interrupt sources. The
received data interrupt occurs once the receive character has been received and placed
in the Receive Data register. Software must respond to this received data available
condition before the next character is completely received to avoid an overrun error.
In MULTIPROCESSOR mode (MPEN = 1), the receive data interrupts are dependent on
Note:
the multiprocessor configuration and the most recent address byte.
•
•
•
A break is received
An overrun is detected
A data framing error is detected
UART Overrun Errors
When an overrun error condition occurs the UART prevents overwriting of the valid data
currently in the Receive Data register. The Break Detect and Overrun status bits are not
displayed until after the valid data has been read.
After the valid data has been read, the UART Status 0 register is updated to indicate the
overrun condition (and Break Detect, if applicable). The RDAbit is set to 1 to indicate that
the Receive Data register contains a data byte. However, because the overrun error
occurred, this byte may not contain valid data and should be ignored. The BRKDbit indi-
cates if the overrun was caused by a break condition on the line. After reading the status
byte indicating an overrun error, the Receive Data register must be read again to clear the
error bits is the UART Status 0 register. Updates to the Receive Data register occur only
when the next data word is received.
UART Data and Error Handling Procedure
Figure 17 on page 109 displays the recommended procedure for use in UART receiver
interrupt service routines.
PS019921-0308
UART
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
109
Receiver
Ready
Receiver
Interrupt
Read Status
No
Errors?
Yes
Read Data which
clears RDA bit and
resets error bits
Read Data
Discard Data
Figure 17. UART Receiver Interrupt Service Routine Flow
Baud Rate Generator Interrupts
If the Baud Rate Generator interrupt enable is set, the UART Receiver interrupt asserts
when the UART Baud Rate Generator reloads. This action allows the Baud Rate Genera-
tor to function as an additional counter if the UART functionality is not employed.
UART Baud Rate Generator
The UART Baud Rate Generator creates a lower frequency baud rate clock for data trans-
mission. The input to the Baud Rate Generator is the system clock. The UART Baud Rate
High and Low Byte registers combine to create a 16-bit baud rate divisor value
PS019921-0308
UART
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
110
(BRG[15:0]) that sets the data transmission rate (baud rate) of the UART. The UART data
rate is calculated using the following equation:
System Clock Frequency (Hz)
------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
UART Data Rate (bits/s) =
16 × UART Baud Rate Divisor Value
When the UART is disabled, the Baud Rate Generator can function as a basic 16-bit timer
with interrupt on time-out. To configure the Baud Rate Generator as a timer with interrupt
on time-out, complete the following procedure:
1. Disable the UART by clearing the RENand TENbits in the UART Control 0 register
to 0.
2. Load the desired 16-bit count value into the UART Baud Rate High and Low Byte
registers.
3. Enable the Baud Rate Generator timer function and associated interrupt by setting the
BRGCTLbit in the UART Control 1 register to 1.
When configured as a general purpose timer, the interrupt interval is calculated using the
following equation:
Interrupt Interval(s) = System Clock Period (s) × BRG[15:0]
UART Control Register Definitions
The UART control registers support the UART and the associated Infrared Encoder/
Decoders. For more information on the infrared operation, see Infrared Encoder/Decoder
on page 121.
UART Transmit Data Register
Data bytes written to the UART Transmit Data register (Table 52) are shifted out on the
TXDx pin. The Write-only UART Transmit Data register shares a Register File address
with the Read-only UART Receive Data register.
Table 52. UART Transmit Data Register (UxTXD)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TXD
X
FIELD
RESET
R/W
W
F40H and F48H
ADDR
PS019921-0308
UART
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
111
TXD—Transmit Data
UART transmitter data byte to be shifted out through the TXDx pin.
UART Receive Data Register
Data bytes received through the RXDx pin are stored in the UART Receive Data register
(Table 53). The Read-only UART Receive Data register shares a Register File address
with the Write-only UART Transmit Data register.
Table 53. UART Receive Data Register (UxRXD)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RXD
X
FIELD
RESET
R/W
R
F40H and F48H
ADDR
RXD—Receive Data
UART receiver data byte from the RXDx pin
UART Status 0 Register
The UART Status 0 and Status 1 registers (Table 54 and Table 55 on page 113) identify the
current UART operating configuration and status.
Table 54. UART Status 0 Register (UxSTAT0)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RDA
PE
OE
FE
BRKD
TDRE
TXE
CTS
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
1
X
R
F41H and F49H
ADDR
RDA—Receive Data Available
This bit indicates that the UART Receive Data register has received data. Reading the
UART Receive Data register clears this bit.
0 = The UART Receive Data register is empty.
1 = There is a byte in the UART Receive Data register.
PS019921-0308
UART
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
112
PE—Parity Error
This bit indicates that a parity error has occurred. Reading the UART Receive Data regis-
ter clears this bit.
0 = No parity error occurred.
1 = A parity error occurred.
OE—Overrun Error
This bit indicates that an overrun error has occurred. An overrun occurs when new data is
received and the UART Receive Data register has not been read. If the RDA bit is reset to
0, then reading the UART Receive Data register clears this bit.
0 = No overrun error occurred.
1 = An overrun error occurred.
FE—Framing Error
This bit indicates that a framing error (no Stop bit following data reception) was detected.
Reading the UART Receive Data register clears this bit.
0 = No framing error occurred.
1 = A framing error occurred.
BRKD—Break Detect
This bit indicates that a break occurred. If the data bits, parity/multiprocessor bit, and Stop
bit(s) are all zeros then this bit is set to 1. Reading the UART Receive Data register clears
this bit.
0 = No break occurred.
1 = A break occurred.
TDRE—Transmitter Data Register Empty
This bit indicates that the UART Transmit Data register is empty and ready for additional
data. Writing to the UART Transmit Data register resets this bit.
0 = Do not write to the UART Transmit Data register.
1 = The UART Transmit Data register is ready to receive an additional byte to be transmit-
ted.
TXE—Transmitter Empty
This bit indicates that the transmit shift register is empty and character transmission is fin-
ished.
0 = Data is currently transmitting.
1 = Transmission is complete.
CTS—CTS signal
When this bit is read it returns the level of the CTS signal.
UART Status 1 Register
This register contains multiprocessor control and status bits.
PS019921-0308
UART
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
113
Table 55. UART Status 1 Register (UxSTAT1)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reserved
NEWFRM
MPRX
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
R
R/W
R
F44H and F4CH
ADDR
Reserved—Must be 0.
NEWFRM—Status bit denoting the start of a new frame. Reading the UART Receive
Data register resets this bit to 0.
0 = The current byte is not the first data byte of a new frame.
1 = The current byte is the first data byte of a new frame.
MPRX—Multiprocessor Receive
Returns the value of the last multiprocessor bit received. Reading from the UART Receive
Data register resets this bit to 0.
UART Control 0 and Control 1 Registers
The UART Control 0 and Control 1 registers (see Table 56 and Table 57 on page 114) con-
figure the properties of the UART’s transmit and receive operations. The UART Control
registers must not been written while the UART is enabled.
Table 56. UART Control 0 Register (UxCTL0)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TEN
REN
CTSE
PEN
PSEL
SBRK
STOP
LBEN
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
R/W
F42H and F4AH
ADDR
TEN—Transmit Enable
This bit enables or disables the transmitter. The enable is also controlled by the CTS signal
and the CTSEbit. If the CTS signal is low and the CTSEbit is 1, the transmitter is
enabled.
0 = Transmitter disabled.
1 = Transmitter enabled.
PS019921-0308
UART
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
114
REN—Receive Enable
This bit enables or disables the receiver.
0 = Receiver disabled.
1 = Receiver enabled.
CTSE—CTS Enable
0 = The CTS signal has no effect on the transmitter.
1 = The UART recognizes the CTS signal as an enable control from the transmitter.
PEN—Parity Enable
This bit enables or disables parity. Even or odd is determined by the PSELbit. It is over-
ridden by the MPENbit.
0 = Parity is disabled.
1 = The transmitter sends data with an additional parity bit and the receiver receives an
additional parity bit.
PSEL—Parity Select
0 = Even parity is transmitted and expected on all received data.
1 = Odd parity is transmitted and expected on all received data.
SBRK—Send Break
This bit pauses or breaks data transmission. Sending a break interrupts any transmission in
progress, so ensure that the transmitter has finished sending data before setting this bit.
0 = No break is sent.
1 = The output of the transmitter is zero.
STOP—Stop Bit Select
0 = The transmitter sends one stop bit.
1 = The transmitter sends two stop bits.
LBEN—Loop Back Enable
0 = Normal operation.
1 = All transmitted data is looped back to the receiver.
Table 57. UART Control 1 Register (UxCTL1)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MPMD[1]
MPEN
MPMD[0]
MPBT
DEPOL BRGCTL
RDAIRQ
IREN
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
R/W
F43H and F4BH
ADDR
MPMD[1:0]—MULTIPROCESSOR Mode
If MULTIPROCESSOR (9-bit) mode is enabled,
00 = The UART generates an interrupt request on all received bytes (data and address).
PS019921-0308
UART
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
115
01 = The UART generates an interrupt request only on received address bytes.
10 = The UART generates an interrupt request when a received address byte matches
the value stored in the Address Compare Register and on all successive data
bytes until an address mismatch occurs.
11 = The UART generates an interrupt request on all received data bytes for which
the most recent address byte matched the value in the Address Compare Register.
MPEN—MULTIPROCESSOR (9-bit) Enable
This bit is used to enable MULTIPROCESSOR (9-bit) mode.
0 = Disable MULTIPROCESSOR (9-bit) mode.
1 = Enable MULTIPROCESSOR (9-bit) mode.
MPBT—MULTIPROCESSOR Bit Transmit
This bit is applicable only when MULTIPROCESSOR (9-bit) mode is enabled.
0 = Send a 0 in the multiprocessor bit location of the data stream (9th bit).
1 = Send a 1 in the multiprocessor bit location of the data stream (9th bit).
DEPOL—Driver Enable Polarity
0 = DEsignal is Active High.
1 = DEsignal is Active Low.
BRGCTL—Baud Rate Control
This bit causes different UART behavior depending on whether the UART receiver is
enabled (REN = 1 in the UART Control 0 Register).
When the UART receiver is not enabled, this bit determines whether the Baud Rate Gener-
ator issues interrupts.
0 = Reads from the Baud Rate High and Low Byte registers return the BRG Reload Value
1 = The Baud Rate Generator generates a receive interrupt when it counts down to 0.
Reads from the Baud Rate High and Low Byte registers return the current BRG count
value.
When the UART receiver is enabled, this bit allows reads from the Baud Rate Registers to
return the BRG count value instead of the Reload Value.
0 = Reads from the Baud Rate High and Low Byte registers return the BRG Reload Value.
1 = Reads from the Baud Rate High and Low Byte registers return the current BRG
count value. Unlike the Timers, there is no mechanism to latch the High Byte
when the Low Byte is read.
RDAIRQ—Receive Data Interrupt Enable
0 = Received data and receiver errors generates an interrupt request to the Interrupt
Controller.
1 = Received data does not generate an interrupt request to the Interrupt Controller.
Only receiver errors generate an interrupt request.
IREN—Infrared Encoder/Decoder Enable
0 = Infrared Encoder/Decoder is disabled. UART operates normally operation.
PS019921-0308
UART
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
116
1 = Infrared Encoder/Decoder is enabled. The UART transmits and receives data
through the Infrared Encoder/Decoder.
UART Address Compare Register
The UART Address Compare register (Table 58) stores the multi-node network address of
the UART. When the MPMD[1] bit of UART Control Register 0 is set, all incoming
address bytes are compared to the value stored in the Address Compare register. Receive
interrupts and RDA assertions only occur in the event of a match.
Table 58. UART Address Compare Register (UxADDR)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
COMP_ADDR
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
R/W
F45H and F4DH
ADDR
COMP_ADDR—Compare Address
This 8-bit value is compared to the incoming address bytes.
UART Baud Rate High and Low Byte Registers
The UART Baud Rate High and Low Byte registers (see Table 59 and Table 60 on
page 117) combine to create a 16-bit baud rate divisor value (BRG[15:0]) that sets the data
transmission rate (baud rate) of the UART. To configure the Baud Rate Generator as a
timer with interrupt on time-out, complete the following procedure:
1. Disable the UART by clearing the RENand TENbits in the UART Control 0 register
to 0.
2. Load the desired 16-bit count value into the UART Baud Rate High and Low Byte
registers.
3. Enable the Baud Rate Generator timer function and associated interrupt by setting the
BRGCTLbit in the UART Control 1 register to 1.
When configured as a general purpose timer, the UART BRG interrupt interval is calcu-
lated using the following equation:
UART BRG Interrupt Interval(s) = System Clock Period (s) × BRG[15:0]
PS019921-0308
UART
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
117
Table 59. UART Baud Rate High Byte Register (UxBRH)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
2
1
1
0
0
BRH
1
FIELD
RESET
R/W
R/W
F46H and F4EH
ADDR
Table 60. UART Baud Rate Low Byte Register (UxBRL)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
BRL
1
FIELD
RESET
R/W
R/W
F47H and F4FH
ADDR
For a given UART data rate, the integer baud rate divisor value is calculated using the
following equation:
System Clock Frequency (Hz)
------------------------------------------------------------------------
UART Baud Rate Divisor Value (BRG) = Round
16 × UART Data Rate (bits/s)
The baud rate error relative to the desired baud rate is calculated using the following
equation:
Actual Data Rate – Desired Data Rate
------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Desired Data Rate
UART Baud Rate Error (%) = 100 ×
For reliable communication, the UART baud rate error must never exceed 5 percent.
Table 61 provides information on data rate errors for popular baud rates and commonly
used crystal oscillator frequencies.
PS019921-0308
UART
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
118
Table 61. UART Baud Rates
20.0 MHz System Clock
18.432 MHz System Clock
Desired
Rate
BRG
Desired Rate BRG Divisor Actual Rate Error
Divisor
Actual Rate Error
(kHz)
1250.0
625.0
250.0
115.2
57.6
(Decimal)
1
(kHz)
1250.0
625.0
250.0
113.6
56.8
(%)
0.00
0.00
0.00
-1.36
-1.36
-1.36
0.16
0.16
0.16
-0.03
-0.03
0.02
-0.01
(kHz)
1250.0
625.0
250.0
115.2
57.6
(Decimal)
1
(kHz)
1152.0
576.0
230.4
115.2
57.6
(%)
-7.84%
-7.84%
-7.84%
0.00
2
2
5
5
11
10
22
20
0.00
38.4
33
37.9
38.4
30
38.4
0.00
19.2
65
19.2
19.2
60
19.2
0.00
9.60
130
260
521
1042
2083
4167
9.62
9.60
120
240
480
960
1920
3840
9.60
0.00
4.80
4.81
4.80
4.80
0.00
2.40
2.40
2.40
2.40
0.00
1.20
1.20
1.20
1.20
0.00
0.60
0.60
0.60
0.60
0.00
0.30
0.30
0.30
0.30
0.00
16.667 MHz System Clock
11.0592 MHz System Clock
Desired
Rate
BRG
Desired Rate BRG Divisor Actual Rate Error
Divisor
Actual Rate Error
(kHz)
1250.0
625.0
250.0
115.2
57.6
(Decimal)
(kHz)
1041.69
520.8
260.4
115.7
57.87
38.6
(%)
-16.67
-16.67
4.17
(kHz)
1250.0
625.0
250.0
115.2
57.6
(Decimal)
(kHz)
N/A
(%)
N/A
1
2
N/A
1
691.2
230.4
115.2
57.6
38.4
19.2
9.60
4.80
2.40
10.59
-7.84
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
4
3
9
0.47
6
18
27
54
109
217
434
0.47
12
18
36
72
144
288
38.4
0.47
38.4
19.2
19.3
0.47
19.2
9.60
9.56
-0.45
-0.83
0.01
9.60
4.80
4.80
4.80
2.40
2.40
2.40
PS019921-0308
UART
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
119
Table 61. UART Baud Rates (Continued)
1.20
0.60
0.30
868
1736
3472
1.20
0.60
0.30
0.01
0.01
0.01
1.20
0.60
0.30
576
1152
2304
1.20
0.60
0.30
0.00
0.00
0.00
10.0 MHz System Clock
5.5296 MHz System Clock
Desired
Rate
BRG
Desired Rate BRG Divisor Actual Rate Error
Divisor
Actual Rate Error
(kHz)
1250.0
625.0
250.0
115.2
57.6
(Decimal)
N/A
1
(kHz)
N/A
(%)
N/A
(kHz)
1250.0
625.0
250.0
115.2
57.6
(Decimal)
(kHz)
N/A
(%)
N/A
N/A
N/A
1
625.0
208.33
125.0
56.8
0.00
-16.67
8.51
-1.36
1.73
0.16
0.16
0.16
-0.03
-0.03
-0.03
0.2
N/A
N/A
3
345.6
115.2
57.6
38.4
19.2
9.60
4.80
2.40
1.20
0.60
0.30
38.24
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
5
3
11
6
38.4
16
39.1
38.4
9
19.2
33
18.9
19.2
18
9.60
65
9.62
4.81
2.40
1.20
0.60
0.30
9.60
36
4.80
130
260
521
1042
2083
4.80
72
2.40
2.40
144
288
576
1152
1.20
1.20
0.60
0.60
0.30
0.30
3.579545 MHz System Clock
1.8432 MHz System Clock
Desired
Rate
BRG
Desired Rate BRG Divisor Actual Rate Error
Divisor
Actual Rate Error
(kHz)
1250.0
625.0
250.0
115.2
57.6
(Decimal)
(kHz)
N/A
(%)
N/A
(kHz)
1250.0
625.0
250.0
115.2
57.6
(Decimal)
(kHz)
N/A
(%)
N/A
N/A
N/A
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
N/A
N/A
1
N/A
N/A
N/A
1
N/A
N/A
N/A
223.72
111.9
55.9
-10.51
-2.90
-2.90
-2.90
-2.90
N/A
2
115.2
57.6
38.4
19.2
4
2
38.4
6
37.3
38.4
3
19.2
12
18.6
19.2
6
PS019921-0308
UART
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
120
Table 61. UART Baud Rates (Continued)
9.60
4.80
2.40
1.20
0.60
0.30
23
47
9.73
4.76
2.41
1.20
0.60
0.30
1.32
-0.83
0.23
9.60
4.80
2.40
1.20
0.60
0.30
12
24
9.60
4.80
2.40
1.20
0.60
0.30
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
0.00
93
48
186
373
746
0.23
96
-0.04
-0.04
192
384
PS019921-0308
UART
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
121
Infrared Encoder/Decoder
The Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series products contain two fully-functional, high-perfor-
mance UART to Infrared Encoder/Decoders (Endecs). Each Infrared Endec is integrated
with an on-chip UART to allow easy communication between the Z8 Encore! XP®
F64XX Series and IrDA Physical Layer Specification, Version 1.3-compliant infrared
transceivers. Infrared communication provides secure, reliable, low-cost, point-to-point
communication between PCs, PDAs, cell phones, printers, and other infrared enabled
devices.
Architecture
Figure 18 displays the architecture of the Infrared Endec.
System
Clock
Zilog
ZHX1810
RxD
RXD
TXD
RXD
Infrared
Encoder/Decoder
(Endec)
TxD
TXD
Infrared
Transceiver
UART
I/O
Baud Rate
Clock
Interrupt
Data
Signal Address
Figure 18. Infrared Data Communication System Block Diagram
Operation
When the Infrared Endec is enabled, the transmit data from the associated on-chip UART
is encoded as digital signals in accordance with the IrDA standard and output to the infra-
red transceiver via the TXD pin. Likewise, data received from the infrared transceiver is
passed to the Infrared Endec via the RXD pin, decoded by the Infrared Endec, and then
passed to the UART. Communication is half-duplex, which means simultaneous data
transmission and reception is not allowed.
PS019921-0308
Infrared Encoder/Decoder
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
122
The baud rate is set by the UART’s Baud Rate Generator and supports IrDA standard baud
rates from 9600 baud to 115.2 Kbaud. Higher baud rates are possible, but do not meet
IrDA specifications. The UART must be enabled to use the Infrared Endec. The Infrared
Endec data rate is calculated using the following equation:
System Clock Frequency (Hz)
------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Infrared Data Rate (bits/s) =
16 × UART Baud Rate Divisor Value
Transmitting IrDA Data
The data to be transmitted using the infrared transceiver is first sent to the UART. The
UART’s transmit signal (TXD) and baud rate clock are used by the IrDA to generate the
modulation signal (IR_TXD) that drives the infrared transceiver. Each UART/Infrared
data bit is 16-clock wide. If the data to be transmitted is 1, the IR_TXD signal remains low
for the full 16-clock period. If the data to be transmitted is 0, a 3-clock high pulse is output
following a 7-clock low period. After the 3-clock high pulse, a 6-clock low pulse is output
to complete the full 16-clock data period. Figure 19 displays IrDA data transmission.
When the Infrared Endec is enabled, the UART’s TXD signal is internal to the Z8 Encore!
XP® F64XX Series products while the IR_TXD signal is output through the TXD pin.
16-clock
period
Baud Rate
Clock
UART’s
TXD
Start Bit = 0
Data Bit 0 = 1
Data Bit 1 = 0
Data Bit 2 = 1
Data Bit 3 = 1
3-clock
pulse
IR_TXD
7-clock
delay
Figure 19. Infrared Data Transmission
Receiving IrDA Data
Data received from the infrared transceiver via the IR_RXD signal through the RXDpin is
decoded by the Infrared Endec and passed to the UART. The UART’s baud rate clock is
used by the Infrared Endec to generate the demodulated signal (RXD) that drives the
UART. Each UART/Infrared data bit is 16-clocks wide. Figure 20 displays data reception.
PS019921-0308
Infrared Encoder/Decoder
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
123
When the Infrared Endec is enabled, the UART’s RXD signal is internal to the Z8 Encore!
XP® F64XX Series products while the IR_RXD signal is received through the RXDpin.
16-clock
period
Baud Rate
Clock
Start Bit = 0
Data Bit 0 = 1
Data Bit 1 = 0
Data Bit 2 = 1
Data Bit 3 = 1
IR_RXD
min. 1.6µs
pulse
UART’s
RXD
Start Bit = 0
Data Bit 0 = 1
Data Bit 1 = 0
Data Bit 2 = 1
Data Bit 3 = 1
8-clock
delay
16-clock
period
16-clock
period
16-clock
period
16-clock
period
Figure 20. Infrared Data Reception
Caution: The system clock frequency must be at least 1.0 MHz to ensure proper recep-
tion of the 1.6 µs minimum width pulses allowed by the IrDA standard.
Endec Receiver Synchronization
The IrDA receiver uses a local baud rate clock counter (0 to 15 clock periods) to generate
an input stream for the UART and to create a sampling window for detection of incoming
pulses. The generated UART input (UART RXD) is delayed by 8 baud rate clock periods
with respect to the incoming IrDA data stream. When a falling edge in the input data
stream is detected, the Endec counter is reset. When the count reaches a value of 8, the
UART RXD value is updated to reflect the value of the decoded data. When the count
reaches 12 baud clock periods, the sampling window for the next incoming pulse opens.
The window remains open until the count again reaches 8 (or in other words 24 baud clock
periods since the previous pulse was detected). This gives the Endec a sampling window
of minus four baudrate clocks to plus eight baudrate clocks around the expected time of an
incoming pulse. If an incoming pulse is detected inside this window this process is
repeated. If the incoming data is a logical 1 (no pulse), the Endec returns to the initial state
and waits for the next falling edge. As each falling edge is detected, the Endec clock
counter is reset, resynchronizing the Endec to the incoming signal. This action allows the
Endec to tolerate jitter and baud rate errors in the incoming data stream. Resynchronizing
the Endec does not alter the operation of the UART, which ultimately receives the data.
The UART is only synchronized to the incoming data stream when a Start bit is received.
PS019921-0308
Infrared Encoder/Decoder
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
124
Infrared Encoder/Decoder Control Register Definitions
All Infrared Endec configuration and status information is set by the UART control regis-
ters as defined in UART Control Register Definitions on page 110.
Caution: To prevent spurious signals during IrDA data transmission, set the IREN bit
in the UARTx Control 1 register to 1 to enable the Infrared Encoder/Decoder
before enabling the GPIO Port alternate function for the corresponding pin.
PS019921-0308
Infrared Encoder/Decoder
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
125
Serial Peripheral Interface
The Serial Peripheral Interface is a synchronous interface allowing several SPI-type
devices to be interconnected. SPI-compatible devices include EEPROMs, Analog-to-
Digital Converters, and ISDN devices. Features of the SPI include:
•
•
•
•
•
Full-duplex, synchronous, character-oriented communication
Four-wire interface
Data transfers rates up to a maximum of one-half the system clock frequency
Error detection
Dedicated Baud Rate Generator
Architecture
The SPI may be configured as either a Master (in single or multi-master systems) or a
Slave as displayed in Figure 21 through Figure 23.
SPI Master
To Slave’s SS Pin
From Slave
SS
8-bit Shift Register
Bit 0 Bit 7
MISO
MOSI
SCK
To Slave
To Slave
Baud Rate
Generator
Figure 21. SPI Configured as a Master in a Single Master, Single Slave System
PS019921-0308
Serial Peripheral Interface
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
126
VCC
SPI Master
SS
To Slave #2’s SS Pin
To Slave #1’s SS Pin
From Slave
GPIO
GPIO
8-bit Shift Register
Bit 0
Bit 7
MISO
MOSI
To Slave
To Slave
SCK
Baud Rate
Generator
Figure 22. SPI Configured as a Master in a Single Master, Multiple Slave System
SPI Slave
From Master
SS
8-bit Shift Register
Bit 7 Bit 0
MISO
MOSI
To Master
From Master
SCK
From Master
Figure 23. SPI Configured as a Slave
Operation
The SPI is a full-duplex, synchronous, character-oriented channel that supports a four-wire
interface (serial clock, transmit, receive and Slave select). The SPI block consists of a
transmit/receive shift register, a Baud Rate (clock) Generator and a control unit.
PS019921-0308
Serial Peripheral Interface
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
127
During an SPI transfer, data is sent and received simultaneously by both the Master and
the Slave SPI devices. Separate signals are required for data and the serial clock. When an
SPI transfer occurs, a multi-bit (typically 8-bit) character is shifted out one data pin and an
multi-bit character is simultaneously shifted in on a second data pin. An 8-bit shift register
in the Master and another 8-bit shift register in the Slave are connected as a circular buffer.
The SPI shift register is single-buffered in the transmit and receive directions. New data to
be transmitted cannot be written into the shift register until the previous transmission is
complete and receive data (if valid) has been read.
SPI Signals
The four basic SPI signals are:
•
•
•
•
Master-In/Slave-Out
Master-Out/Slave-In
Serial Clock
Slave Select
Each signal is described in both Master and Slave modes.
Master-In/Slave-Out
The Master-In/Slave-Out (MISO) pin is configured as an input in a Master device and as
an output in a Slave device. It is one of the two lines that transfer serial data, with the most
significant bit sent first. The MISO pin of a Slave device is placed in a high-impedance
state if the Slave is not selected. When the SPI is not enabled, this signal is in a high-
impedance state.
Master-Out/Slave-In
The Master-Out/Slave-In (MOSI) pin is configured as an output in a Master device and as
an input in a Slave device. It is one of the two lines that transfer serial data, with the most
significant bit sent first. When the SPI is not enabled, this signal is in a high-impedance
state.
Serial Clock
The Serial Clock (SCK) synchronizes data movement both in and out of the device
through its MOSI and MISO pins. In MASTER mode, the SPI’s Baud Rate Generator cre-
ates the serial clock. The Master drives the serial clock out its own SCK pin to the Slave’s
SCK pin. When the SPI is configured as a Slave, the SCK pin is an input and the clock sig-
nal from the Master synchronizes the data transfer between the Master and Slave devices.
Slave devices ignore the SCK signal, unless the SS pin is asserted. When configured as a
slave, the SPI block requires a minimum SCK period of greater than or equal to 8 times
the system (XIN) clock period.
PS019921-0308
Serial Peripheral Interface
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
128
The Master and Slave are each capable of exchanging a character of data during a
sequence of NUMBITS clock cycles (see NUMBITS field in the SPI Mode Register on
page 136). In both Master and Slave SPI devices, data is shifted on one edge of the SCK
and is sampled on the opposite edge where data is stable. Edge polarity is determined by
the SPI phase and polarity control.
Slave Select
The active Low Slave Select (SS) input signal selects a Slave SPI device. SS must be Low
prior to all data communication to and from the Slave device. SS must stay Low for the
full duration of each character transferred. The SS signal may stay Low during the transfer
of multiple characters or may deassert between each character.
When the SPI is configured as the only Master in an SPI system, the SS pin can be set as
either an input or an output. Other GPIO output pins can also be employed to select exter-
nal SPI Slave devices.
When the SPI is configured as one Master in a multi-master SPI system, the SS pin must
be set as an input. The SS input signal on the Master must be High. If the SS signal goes
Low (indicating another Master is driving the SPI bus), a Collision error Flag is set in the
SPI Status register.
SPI Clock Phase and Polarity Control
The SPI supports four combinations of serial clock phase and polarity using two bits in the
SPI Control register. The clock polarity bit, CLKPOL, selects an active high or active Low
clock and has no effect on the transfer format. Table 62 lists the SPI Clock Phase and
Polarity Operation parameters. The clock phase bit, PHASE, selects one of two fundamen-
tally different transfer formats. For proper data transmission, the clock phase and polarity
must be identical for the SPI Master and the SPI Slave. The Master always places data on
the MOSI line a half-cycle before the receive clock edge (SCK signal), in order for the
Slave to latch the data.
Table 62. SPI Clock Phase (PHASE) and Clock Polarity (CLKPOL) Operation
SCK Transmit
Edge
SCK Receive
Edge
SCK Idle
State
PHASE
CLKPOL
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Falling
Rising
Rising
Falling
Rising
Falling
Falling
Rising
Low
High
Low
High
PS019921-0308
Serial Peripheral Interface
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
129
Transfer Format PHASE Equals Zero
Figure 24 displays the timing diagram for an SPI transfer in which PHASEis cleared to 0.
The two SCK waveforms show polarity with CLKPOLreset to 0 and with CLKPOLset to
one. The diagram may be interpreted as either a Master or Slave timing diagram because
the SCK Master-In/Slave-Out (MISO) and Master-Out/Slave-In (MOSI) pins are directly
connected between the Master and the Slave.
SCK
(CLKPOL = 0)
SCK
(CLKPOL = 1)
MOSI
Bit7
Bit7
Bit6
Bit6
Bit5
Bit5
Bit4
Bit4
Bit3
Bit3
Bit2
Bit2
Bit1
Bit1
Bit0
Bit0
MISO
Input Sample Time
SS
Figure 24. SPI Timing When PHASEis 0
Transfer Format PHASE Equals One
Figure 25 on page 130 displays the timing diagram for an SPI transfer in which PHASEis
one. Two waveforms are depicted for SCK, one for CLKPOLreset to 0 and another for
CLKPOLset to 1.
PS019921-0308
Serial Peripheral Interface
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
130
SCK
(CLKPOL = 0)
SCK
(CLKPOL = 1)
MOSI
Bit7
Bit7
Bit6
Bit6
Bit5
Bit5
Bit4
Bit4
Bit3
Bit3
Bit2
Bit2
Bit1
Bit1
Bit0
Bit0
MISO
Input Sample Time
SS
Figure 25. SPI Timing When PHASEis 1
Multi-Master Operation
In a multi-master SPI system, all SCK pins are tied together, all MOSI pins are tied
together and all MISO pins are tied together. All SPI pins must then be configured in
OPEN-DRAIN mode to prevent bus contention. At any one time, only one SPI device is
configured as the Master and all other SPI devices on the bus are configured as Slaves.
The Master enables a single Slave by asserting the SS pin on that Slave only. Then, the
single Master drives data out its SCK and MOSI pins to the SCK and MOSI pins on the
Slaves (including those which are not enabled). The enabled Slave drives data out its
MISO pin to the MISO Master pin.
For a Master device operating in a multi-master system, if the SS pin is configured as an
input and is driven Low by another Master, the COLbit is set to 1 in the SPI Status Regis-
ter. The COLbit indicates the occurrence of a multi-master collision (mode fault error con-
dition).
Slave Operation
The SPI block is configured for SLAVE mode operation by setting the SPIEN bit to 1 and
the MMEN bit to 0 in the SPICTL register and setting the SSIO bit to 0 in the SPIMODE
PS019921-0308
Serial Peripheral Interface
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
131
register. The IRQE, PHASE, CLKPOL, WOR bits in the SPICTL register and the NUM-
BITS field in the SPIMODE register must be set to be consistent with the other SPI
devices. The STR bit in the SPICTL register may be used if desired to force a “startup”
interrupt. The BIRQ bit in the SPICTL register and the SSV bit in the SPIMODE register
are not used in SLAVE mode. The SPI baud rate generator is not used in SLAVE mode so
the SPIBRH and SPIBRL registers need not be initialized.
If the slave has data to send to the master, the data must be written to the SPIDAT register
before the transaction starts (first edge of SCK when SS is asserted). If the SPIDAT
register is not written prior to the slave transaction, the MISO pin outputs whatever value
is currently in the SPIDAT register.
Due to the delay resulting from synchronization of the SPI input signals to the internal
system clock, the maximum SPICLK baud rate that can be supported in SLAVE mode is
the system clock frequency (XIN) divided by 8. This rate is controlled by the SPI master.
Error Detection
The SPI contains error detection logic to support SPI communication protocols and
recognize when communication errors have occurred. The SPI Status register indicates
when a data transmission error has been detected.
Overrun (Write Collision)
An overrun error (write collision) indicates a write to the SPI Data register was attempted
while a data transfer is in progress (in either MASTER or SLAVE modes). An overrun sets
the OVRbit in the SPI Status register to 1. Writing a 1 to OVRclears this error Flag. The
data register is not altered when a write occurs while data transfer is in progress.
Mode Fault (Multi-Master Collision)
A mode fault indicates when more than one Master is trying to communicate at the same
time (a multi-master collision). The mode fault is detected when the enabled Master’s SS
pin is asserted. A mode fault sets the COLbit in the SPI Status register to 1. Writing a 1 to
COLclears this error Flag.
Slave Mode Abort
In SLAVE mode of operation if the SS pin deasserts before all bits in a character have
been transferred, the transaction is aborted. When this condition occurs the ABT bit is set
in the SPISTAT register as well as the IRQ bit (indicating the transaction is complete). The
next time SS asserts, the MISO pin outputs SPIDAT[7], regardless of where the previous
transaction left off. Writing a 1 to ABT clears this error Flag.
SPI Interrupts
When SPI interrupts are enabled, the SPI generates an interrupt after character transmis-
sion/reception completes in both MASTER and SLAVE modes. A character can be
PS019921-0308
Serial Peripheral Interface
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
132
defined to be 1 through 8 bits by the NUMBITSfield in the SPI Mode register. In slave
mode it is not necessary for SS to deassert between characters to generate the interrupt.
The SPI in Slave mode can also generate an interrupt if the SS signal deasserts prior to
transfer of all the bits in a character (see description of slave abort error above). Writing a
1 to the IRQbit in the SPI Status Register clears the pending SPI interrupt request. The
IRQ bit must be cleared to 0 by the Interrupt Service Routine to generate future interrupts.
To start the transfer process, an SPI interrupt may be forced by software writing a 1 to the
STR bit in the SPICTL register.
If the SPI is disabled, an SPI interrupt can be generated by a Baud Rate Generator time-
out. This timer function must be enabled by setting the BIRQ bit in the SPICTL register.
This Baud Rate Generator time-out does not set the IRQ bit in the SPISTAT register, just
the SPI interrupt bit in the interrupt controller.
SPI Baud Rate Generator
In SPI Master mode, the Baud Rate Generator creates a lower frequency serial clock
(SCK) for data transmission synchronization between the Master and the external Slave.
The input to the Baud Rate Generator is the system clock. The SPI Baud Rate High and
Low Byte registers combine to form a 16-bit reload value, BRG[15:0], for the SPI Baud
Rate Generator. The SPI baud rate is calculated using the following equation:
System Clock Frequency (Hz)
------------------------------------------------------------------------
SPI Baud Rate (bits/s) =
2 × BRG[15:0]
Minimum baud rate is obtained by setting BRG[15:0] to 0000Hfor a clock divisor value
of (2 X 65536 = 131072).
When the SPI is disabled, the Baud Rate Generator can function as a basic 16-bit timer
with interrupt on time-out. Follow the steps below to configure the Baud Rate Generator
as a timer with interrupt on time-out:
1. Disable the SPI by clearing the SPIENbit in the SPI Control register to 0.
2. Load the desired 16-bit count value into the SPI Baud Rate High and Low Byte
registers.
3. Enable the Baud Rate Generator timer function and associated interrupt by setting the
BIRQbit in the SPI Control register to 1.
When configured as a general purpose timer, the interrupt interval is calculated using the
following equation:
Interrupt Interval (s) = System Clock Period (s) × BRG[15:0]
PS019921-0308
Serial Peripheral Interface
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
133
SPI Control Register Definitions
SPI Data Register
The SPI Data register (Table 63) stores both the outgoing (transmit) data and the incoming
(receive) data. Reads from the SPI Data register always return the current contents of the
8-bit shift register. Data is shifted out starting with bit 7. The last bit received resides in bit
position 0.
With the SPI configured as a Master, writing a data byte to this register initiates the data
transmission. With the SPI configured as a Slave, writing a data byte to this register loads
the shift register in preparation for the next data transfer with the external Master. In either
the Master or Slave modes, if a transmission is already in progress, writes to this register
are ignored and the Overrun error Flag, OVR, is set in the SPI Status register.
When the character length is less than 8 bits (as set by the NUMBITSfield in the SPI Mode
register), the transmit character must be left justified in the SPI Data register. A received
character of less than 8 bits is right justified (last bit received is in bit position 0). For
example, if the SPI is configured for 4-bit characters, the transmit characters must be writ-
ten to SPIDATA[7:4] and the received characters are read from SPIDATA[3:0].
Table 63. SPI Data Register (SPIDATA)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DATA
X
FIELD
RESET
R/W
R/W
F60H
ADDR
DATA—Data
Transmit and/or receive data.
SPI Control Register
The SPI Control register (see Table 64 on page 134) configures the SPI for transmit and
receive operations.
PS019921-0308
Serial Peripheral Interface
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
134
Table 64. SPI Control Register (SPICTL)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
IRQE
STR
BIRQ
PHASE
CLKPOL
WOR
MMEN
SPIEN
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
R/W
F61H
ADDR
IRQE—Interrupt Request Enable
0 = SPI interrupts are disabled. No interrupt requests are sent to the Interrupt Controller.
1 = SPI interrupts are enabled. Interrupt requests are sent to the Interrupt Controller.
STR—Start an SPI Interrupt Request
0 = No effect.
1 = Setting this bit to 1 also sets the IRQbit in the SPI Status register to 1. Setting this
bit forces the SPI to send an interrupt request to the Interrupt Control. This bit can
be used by software for a function similar to transmit buffer empty in a UART.
Writing a 1 to the IRQbit in the SPI Status register clears this bit to 0.
BIRQ—BRG Timer Interrupt Request
If the SPI is enabled, this bit has no effect. If the SPI is disabled:
0 = The Baud Rate Generator timer function is disabled.
1 = The Baud Rate Generator timer function and time-out interrupt are enabled.
PHASE—Phase Select
Sets the phase relationship of the data to the clock. For more information on operation of
the PHASEbit, see SPI Clock Phase and Polarity Control on page 128.
CLKPOL—Clock Polarity
0 = SCK idles Low (0).
1 = SCK idle High (1).
WOR—Wire-OR (OPEN-DRAIN) Mode Enabled
0 = SPI signal pins not configured for open-drain.
1 = All four SPI signal pins (SCK, SS, MISO, MOSI) configured for open-drain function.
This setting is typically used for multi-master and/or multi-slave configurations.
MMEN—SPI Master Mode Enable
0 = SPI configured in Slave mode.
1 = SPI configured in Master mode.
SPIEN—SPI Enable
0 = SPI disabled.
1 = SPI enabled.
PS019921-0308
Serial Peripheral Interface
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
135
SPI Status Register
The SPI Status register (Table 65) indicates the current state of the SPI. All bits revert to
their reset state if the SPIEN bit in the SPICTL register = 0.
Table 65. SPI Status Register (SPISTAT)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
IRQ
OVR
COL
ABT
Reserved
TXST
SLAS
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
1
R/W*
R
F62H
ADDR
Note: R/W* = Read access. Write a 1 to clear the bit to 0.
IRQ—Interrupt Request
If SPIEN = 1, this bit is set if the STR bit in the SPICTL register is set, or upon completion
of an SPI master or slave transaction. This bit does not set if SPIEN = 0 and the SPI Baud
Rate Generator is used as a timer to generate the SPI interrupt.
0 = No SPI interrupt request pending.
1 = SPI interrupt request is pending.
OVR—Overrun
0 = An overrun error has not occurred.
1 = An overrun error has been detected.
COL—Collision
0 = A multi-master collision (mode fault) has not occurred.
1 = A multi-master collision (mode fault) has been detected.
ABT—Slave mode transaction abort
This bit is set if the SPI is configured in slave mode, a transaction is occurring and SS
deasserts before all bits of a character have been transferred as defined by the NUMBITS
field of the SPIMODE register. The IRQ bit also sets, indicating the transaction has com-
pleted.
0 = A slave mode transaction abort has not occurred.
1 = A slave mode transaction abort has been detected.
Reserved—Must be 0.
TXST—Transmit Status
0 = No data transmission currently in progress.
1 = Data transmission currently in progress.
SLAS—Slave Select
If SPI enabled as a Slave,
PS019921-0308
Serial Peripheral Interface
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
136
0 = SS input pin is asserted (Low).
1 = SS input is not asserted (High).
If SPI enabled as a Master, this bit is not applicable.
SPI Mode Register
The SPI Mode register (Table 66) configures the character bit width and the direction and
value of the SS pin.
Table 66. SPI Mode Register (SPIMODE)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reserved
R
DIAG
NUMBITS[2:0]
SSIO
SSV
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
R/W
F63H
ADDR
Reserved—Must be 0.
DIAG—Diagnostic Mode Control bit
This bit is for SPI diagnostics. Setting this bit allows the Baud Rate Generator value to be
read using the SPIBRH and SPIBRL register locations.
0 = Reading SPIBRH, SPIBRL returns the value in the SPIBRH and SPIBRL registers
1 = Reading SPIBRH returns bits [15:8] of the SPI Baud Rate Generator; and reading
SPIBRL returns bits [7:0] of the SPI Baud Rate Counter. The Baud Rate Counter
High and Low byte values are not buffered.
Exercise caution if reading the values while the BRG is counting.
Caution:
NUMBITS[2:0]—Number of Data Bits Per Character to Transfer
This field contains the number of bits to shift for each character transfer. For information
on valid bit positions when the character length is less than 8-bits, see SPI Data Register
description.
000 = 8 bits
001 = 1 bit
010 = 2 bits
011 = 3 bits
100 = 4 bits
101 = 5 bits
110 = 6 bits
111 = 7 bits
PS019921-0308
Serial Peripheral Interface
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
137
SSIO—Slave Select I/O
0 = SS pin configured as an input.
1 = SS pin configured as an output (Master mode only).
SSV—Slave Select Value
If SSIO = 1 and SPI configured as a Master:
0 = SS pin driven Low (0).
1 = SS pin driven High (1).
This bit has no effect if SSIO= 0 or SPI configured as a Slave.
SPI Diagnostic State Register
The SPI Diagnostic State register (Table 67) provides observability of internal state. This
is a read only register used for SPI diagnostics.
Table 67. SPI Diagnostic State Register (SPIDST)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
SCKEN
TCKEN
SPISTATE
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
R
F64H
ADDR
SCKEN—Shift Clock Enable
0 = The internal Shift Clock Enable signal is deasserted
1 = The internal Shift Clock Enable signal is asserted (shift register is updates on next
system clock)
TCKEN—Transmit Clock Enable
0 = The internal Transmit Clock Enable signal is deasserted.
1 = The internal Transmit Clock Enable signal is asserted. When this is asserted the
serial data out is updated on the next system clock (MOSI or MISO).
SPISTATE—SPI State Machine
Defines the current state of the internal SPI State Machine.
PS019921-0308
Serial Peripheral Interface
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
138
SPI Baud Rate High and Low Byte Registers
The SPI Baud Rate High and Low Byte registers (Table 68 and Table 69) combine to form
a 16-bit reload value, BRG[15:0], for the SPI Baud Rate Generator.
When configured as a general purpose timer, the SPI BRG interrupt interval is calculated
using the following equation:
SPI BRG Interrupt Interval (s) = System Clock Period (s) × BRG[15:0]
Table 68. SPI Baud Rate High Byte Register (SPIBRH)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
BRH
1
FIELD
RESET
R/W
R/W
F66H
ADDR
BRH = SPI Baud Rate High Byte
Most significant byte, BRG[15:8], of the SPI Baud Rate Generator’s reload value.
Table 69. SPI Baud Rate Low Byte Register (SPIBRL)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
BRL
1
FIELD
RESET
R/W
R/W
F67H
ADDR
BRL = SPI Baud Rate Low Byte
Least significant byte, BRG[7:0], of the SPI Baud Rate Generator’s reload value.
PS019921-0308
Serial Peripheral Interface
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
139
I2C Controller
The I2C Controller makes the Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series products bus-compatible
with the I2C protocol. The I2C Controller consists of two bidirectional bus lines—a serial
data signal (SDA) and a serial clock signal (SCL). Features of the I2C Controller include:
•
•
•
•
Transmit and Receive Operation in MASTER mode
Maximum data rate of 400 kbit/sec
7- and 10-bit addressing modes for Slaves
Unrestricted number of data bytes transmitted per transfer
The I2C Controller in the Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series products does not operate in
SLAVE mode.
PS019921-0308
I2C Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
140
Architecture
Figure 26 displays the architecture of the I2C Controller.
SDA
SCL
Shift
ISHIFT
Load
I2CDATA
Baud Rate Generator
I2CBRH
I2CBRL
Receive
Tx/Rx State Machine
I2CSTAT
I2CCTL
Register Bus
I2C Interrupt
Figure 26. I2C Controller Block Diagram
Operation
The I2C Controller operates in MASTER mode to transmit and receive data. Only a single
master is supported. Arbitration between two masters must be accomplished in software.
I2C supports the following operations:
•
•
Master transmits to a 7-bit slave
Master transmits to a 10-bit slave
PS019921-0308
I2C Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
141
•
•
Master receives from a 7-bit slave
Master receives from a 10-bit slave
SDA and SCL Signals
I2C sends all addresses, data and acknowledge signals over the SDA line, most-significant
bit first. SCL is the common clock for the I2C Controller. When the SDA and SCL pin
alternate functions are selected for their respective GPIO ports, the pins are automatically
configured for open-drain operation.
The master (I2C) is responsible for driving the SCL clock signal, although the clock signal
can become skewed by a slow slave device. During the low period of the clock, the slave
pulls the SCL signal Low to suspend the transaction. The master releases the clock at the
end of the low period and notices that the clock remains low instead of returning to a high
level. When the slave releases the clock, the I2C Controller continues the transaction. All
data is transferred in bytes and there is no limit to the amount of data transferred in one
operation. When transmitting data or acknowledging read data from the slave, the SDA
signal changes in the middle of the low period of SCL and is sampled in the middle of the
high period of SCL.
I2C Interrupts
The I2C Controller contains four sources of interrupts—Transmit, Receive, Not
Acknowledge and baud rate generator. These four interrupt sources are combined into a
single interrupt request signal to the Interrupt Controller. The Transmit interrupt is enabled
by the IEN and TXI bits of the Control register. The Receive and Not Acknowledge
interrupts are enabled by the IEN bit of the Control register. The baud rate generator
interrupt is enabled by the BIRQ and IEN bits of the Control register.
Not Acknowledge interrupts occur when a Not Acknowledge condition is received from
the slave or sent by the I2C Controller and neither the STARTor STOPbit is set. The Not
Acknowledge event sets the NCKI bit of the I2C Status register and can only be cleared by
setting the STARTor STOPbit in the I2C Control register. When this interrupt occurs, the
I2C Controller waits until either the STOP or START bit is set before performing any
action. In an interrupt service routine, the NCKI bit should always be checked prior to
servicing transmit or receive interrupt conditions because it indicates the transaction is
being terminated.
Receive interrupts occur when a byte of data has been received by the I2C Controller
(master reading data from slave). This procedure sets the RDRF bit of the I2C Status
register. The RDRF bit is cleared by reading the I2C Data register. The RDRF bit is set
during the acknowledge phase. The I2C Controller pauses after the acknowledge phase
until the receive interrupt is cleared before performing any other action.
PS019921-0308
I2C Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
142
Transmit interrupts occur when the TDRE bit of the I2C Status register sets and the TXI
bit in the I2C Control register is set. Transmit interrupts occur under the following condi-
tions when the transmit data register is empty:
•
•
The I2C Controller is enabled.
The first bit of the byte of an address is shifting out and the RDbit of the I2C Status
register is deasserted.
•
•
The first bit of a 10-bit address shifts out.
The first bit of write data shifts out.
Note: Writing to the I2C Data register always clears the TRDE bit to 0. When TDRE is asserted,
the I2C Controller pauses at the beginning of the Acknowledge cycle of the byte currently
shifting out until the Data register is written with the next value to send or the STOP or
START bits are set indicating the current byte is the last one to send.
The fourth interrupt source is the baud rate generator. If the I2C Controller is disabled
(IEN bit in the I2CCTL register = 0) and the BIRQ bit in the I2CCTL register = 1, an inter-
rupt is generated when the baud rate generator counts down to 1. This allows the I2C baud
rate generator to be used by software as a general purpose timer when IEN = 0.
2
Software Control of I C Transactions
Software can control I2C transactions by using the I2C Controller interrupt, by polling the
I2C Status register or by DMA. Note that not all products include a DMA Controller.
To use interrupts, the I2C interrupt must be enabled in the Interrupt Controller. The TXI bit
in the I2C Control register must be set to enable transmit interrupts.
To control transactions by polling, the interrupt bits (TDRE, RDRF and NCKI) in the I2C
Status register should be polled. The TDRE bit asserts regardless of the state of the TXI
bit.
Either or both transmit and receive data movement can be controlled by the DMA
Controller. The DMA Controller channel(s) must be initialized to select the I2C transmit
and receive requests. Transmit DMA requests require that the TXI bit in the I2C Control
register be set.
Caution: A transmit (write) DMA operation hangs if the slave responds with a Not
Acknowledge before the last byte has been sent. After receiving the Not
Acknowledge, the I2C Controller sets the NCKI bit in the Status register and
pauses until either the STOP or START bits in the Control register are set.
PS019921-0308
I2C Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
143
In order for a receive (read) DMA transaction to send a Not Acknowledge
on the last byte, the receive DMA must be set up to receive n-1 bytes, then
software must set the NAK bit and receive the last (nth) byte directly.
Start and Stop Conditions
The master (I2C) drives all Start and Stop signals and initiates all transactions. To start a
transaction, the I2C Controller generates a START condition by pulling the SDA signal
Low while SCL is High. To complete a transaction, the I2C Controller generates a Stop
condition by creating a low-to-high transition of the SDA signal while the SCL signal is
high. The START and STOP bits in the I2C Control register control the sending of the
Start and Stop conditions. A master is also allowed to end one transaction and begin a new
one by issuing a Restart. This is accomplished by setting the START bit at the end of a
transaction, rather than the STOP bit. Note that the Start condition not sent until the
START bit is set and data has been written to the I2C Data register.
Master Write and Read Transactions
The following sections provide a recommended procedure for performing I2C write and
read transactions from the I2C Controller (master) to slave I2C devices. In general
software should rely on the TDRE, RDRF and NCKI bits of the status register (these bits
generate interrupts) to initiate software actions. When using interrupts or DMA, the TXI
bit is set to start each transaction and cleared at the end of each transaction to eliminate a
‘trailing’ Transmit interrupt.
Caution should be used in using the ACK status bit within a transaction because it is
difficult for software to tell when it is updated by hardware.
When writing data to a slave, the I2C pauses at the beginning of the Acknowledge cycle if
the data register has not been written with the next value to be sent (TDRE bit in the I2C
Status register = 1). In this scenario where software is not keeping up with the I2C bus
(TDRE asserted longer than one byte time), the Acknowledge clock cycle for byte n is
delayed until the Data register is written with byte n + 1, and appears to be grouped with
the data clock cycles for byte n+1. If either the START or STOP bit is set, the I2C does not
pause prior to the Acknowledge cycle because no additional data is sent.
When a Not Acknowledge condition is received during a write (either during the address
or data phases), the I2C Controller generates the Not Acknowledge interrupt (NCKI = 1)
and pause until either the STOP or START bit is set. Unless the Not Acknowledge was
received on the last byte, the Data register will already have been written with the next
address or data byte to send. In this case the FLUSH bit of the Control register should be
set at the same time the STOP or START bit is set to remove the stale transmit data and
enable subsequent Transmit interrupts.
When reading data from the slave, the I2C pauses after the data Acknowledge cycle until
the receive interrupt is serviced and the RDRF bit of the status register is cleared by
PS019921-0308
I2C Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
144
reading the I2C Data register. Once the I2C data register has been read, the I2C reads the
next data byte.
Address Only Transaction with a 7-bit Address
In the situation where software determines if a slave with a 7-bit address is responding
without sending or receiving data, a transaction can be done which only consists of an
address phase. Figure 27 displays this ‘address only’ transaction to determine if a slave
with a 7-bit address will acknowledge. As an example, this transaction can be used after a
‘write’ has been done to a EEPROM to determine when the EEPROM completes its inter-
nal write operation and is once again responding to I2C transactions. If the slave does not
Acknowledge, the transaction can be repeated until the slave does Acknowledge.
S
Slave Address W = 0 A/A
P
Figure 27. 7-Bit Address Only Transaction Format
Follow the steps below for an address only transaction to a 7-bit addressed slave:
1. Software asserts the IENbit in the I2C Control register.
2. Software asserts the TXIbit of the I2C Control register to enable Transmit interrupts.
3. The I2C interrupt asserts, because the I2C Data register is empty (TDRE = 1)
4. Software responds to the TDREbit by writing a 7-bit slave address plus write bit (=0)
to the I2C Data register. As an alternative this could be a read operation instead of a
write operation.
5. Software sets the START and STOP bits of the I2C Control register and clears the TXI
bit.
6. The I2C Controller sends the START condition to the I2C slave.
7. The I2C Controller loads the I2C Shift register with the contents of the I2C Data
register.
8. Software polls the STOP bit of the I2C Control register. Hardware deasserts the STOP
bit when the address only transaction is completed.
9. Software checks the ACK bit of the I2C Status register. If the slave acknowledged, the
ACK bit is = 1. If the slave does not acknowledge, the ACK bit is = 0. The NCKI
interrupt does not occur in the not acknowledge case because the STOP bit was set.
PS019921-0308
I2C Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
145
Write Transaction with a 7-Bit Address
Figure 28 displays the data transfer format for a 7-bit addressed slave. Shaded regions
indicate data transferred from the I2C Controller to slaves and unshaded regions indicate
data transferred from the slaves to the I2C Controller.
S
Slave Address W = 0
A
Data
A
Data
A
Data
A/A P/S
Figure 28. 7-Bit Addressed Slave Data Transfer Format
Follow the steps below for a transmit operation to a 7-bit addressed slave:
1. Software asserts the IENbit in the I2C Control register.
2. Software asserts the TXIbit of the I2C Control register to enable Transmit interrupts.
3. The I2C interrupt asserts, because the I2C Data register is empty
4. Software responds to the TDREbit by writing a 7-bit slave address plus write bit (=0)
to the I2C Data register.
5. Software asserts the START bit of the I2C Control register.
6. The I2C Controller sends the START condition to the I2C slave.
7. The I2C Controller loads the I2C Shift register with the contents of the I2C Data
register.
8. After one bit of address has been shifted out by the SDA signal, the Transmit interrupt
is asserted (TDRE = 1).
9. Software responds by writing the transmit data into the I2C Data register.
10. The I2C Controller shifts the rest of the address and write bit out by the SDA signal.
11. If the I2C slave sends an acknowledge (by pulling the SDA signal low) during the next
high period of SCL the I2C Controller sets the ACKbit in the I2C Status register.
Continue with step 12.
If the slave does not acknowledge, the Not Acknowledge interrupt occurs (NCKI bit is
set in the Status register, ACK bit is cleared). Software responds to the Not
Acknowledge interrupt by setting the STOP and FLUSH bits and clearing the TXI bit.
The I2C Controller sends the STOP condition on the bus and clears the STOP and
NCKI bits. The transaction is complete (ignore the following steps).
12. The I2C Controller loads the contents of the I2C Shift register with the contents of the
I2C Data register.
PS019921-0308
I2C Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
146
13. The I2C Controller shifts the data out of using the SDA signal. After the first bit is
sent, the Transmit interrupt is asserted.
14. If more bytes remain to be sent, return to step 9.
15. Software responds by setting the STOPbit of the I2C Control register (or START bit
to initiate a new transaction). In the STOP case, software clears the TXIbit of the I2C
Control register at the same time.
16. The I2C Controller completes transmission of the data on the SDA signal.
17. The slave may either Acknowledge or Not Acknowledge the last byte. Because either
the STOP or START bit is already set, the NCKI interrupt does not occur.
18. The I2C Controller sends the STOP (or RESTART) condition to the I2C bus. The
STOP or START bit is cleared.
Address Only Transaction with a 10-bit Address
In the situation where software wants to determine if a slave with a 10-bit address is
responding without sending or receiving data, a transaction can be done which only con-
sists of an address phase. Figure 29 displays this ‘address only’ transaction to determine if
a slave with 10-bit address will acknowledge. As an example, this transaction can be used
after a ‘write’ has been done to a EEPROM to determine when the EEPROM completes its
internal write operation and is once again responding to I2C transactions. If the slave does
not Acknowledge the transaction can be repeated until the slave is able to Acknowledge.
Slave Address
1st 7 bits
Slave Address
2nd Byte
S
W = 0 A/A
A/A P
Figure 29. 10-Bit Address Only Transaction Format
Follow the steps below for an address only transaction to a 10-bit addressed slave:
1. Software asserts the IENbit in the I2C Control register.
2. Software asserts the TXIbit of the I2C Control register to enable Transmit interrupts.
3. The I2C interrupt asserts, because the I2C Data register is empty (TDRE = 1)
4. Software responds to the TDREinterrupt by writing the first slave address byte. The
least-significant bit must be 0 for the write operation.
5. Software asserts the START bit of the I2C Control register.
6. The I2C Controller sends the START condition to the I2C slave.
PS019921-0308
I2C Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
147
7. The I2C Controller loads the I2C Shift register with the contents of the I2C Data
register.
8. After one bit of address is shifted out by the SDA signal, the Transmit interrupt is
asserted.
9. Software responds by writing the second byte of address into the contents of the I2C
Data register.
10. The I2C Controller shifts the rest of the first byte of address and write bit out the SDA
signal.
11. If the I2C slave sends an acknowledge by pulling the SDA signal low during the next
high period of SCL the I2C Controller sets the ACKbit in the I2C Status register.
Continue with step 12.
If the slave does not acknowledge the first address byte, the I2C Controller sets the
NCKIbit and clears the ACK bit in the I2C Status register. Software responds to the
Not Acknowledge interrupt by setting the STOP and FLUSH bits and clearing the TXI
bit. The I2C Controller sends the STOP condition on the bus and clears the STOP and
NCKI bits. The transaction is complete (ignore following steps).
12. The I2C Controller loads the I2C Shift register with the contents of the I2C Data
register (2nd byte of address).
13. The I2C Controller shifts the second address byte out the SDA signal. After the first
bit has been sent, the Transmit interrupt is asserted.
14. Software responds by setting the STOP bit in the I2C Control register. The TXI bit can
be cleared at the same time.
15. Software polls the STOP bit of the I2C Control register. Hardware deasserts the STOP
bit when the transaction is completed (STOP condition has been sent).
16. Software checks the ACK bit of the I2C Status register. If the slave acknowledged, the
ACK bit is = 1. If the slave does not acknowledge, the ACK bit is = 0. The NCKI
interrupt do not occur because the STOP bit was set.
Write Transaction with a 10-Bit Address
Figure 30 displays the data transfer format for a 10-bit addressed slave. Shaded regions
indicate data transferred from the I2C Controller to slaves and unshaded regions indicate
data transferred from the slaves to the I2C Controller.
Slave Address
1st 7 bits
Slave Address
2nd Byte
S
W = 0 A
A Data A Data A/A P/S
Figure 30. 10-Bit Addressed Slave Data Transfer Format
PS019921-0308
I2C Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
148
The first seven bits transmitted in the first byte are 11110XX. The two bits XXare the two
most-significant bits of the 10-bit address. The lowest bit of the first byte transferred is the
read/write control bit (=0). The transmit operation is carried out in the same manner as 7-
bit addressing.
Follow the steps below for a transmit operation on a 10-bit addressed slave:
1. Software asserts the IENbit in the I2C Control register.
2. Software asserts the TXIbit of the I2C Control register to enable Transmit interrupts.
3. The I2C interrupt asserts because the I2C Data register is empty.
4. Software responds to the TDREinterrupt by writing the first slave address byte to the
I2C Data register. The least-significant bit must be 0 for the write operation.
5. Software asserts the START bit of the I2C Control register.
6. The I2C Controller sends the START condition to the I2C slave.
7. The I2C Controller loads the I2C Shift register with the contents of the I2C Data
register.
8. After one bit of address is shifted out by the SDA signal, the Transmit interrupt is
asserted.
9. Software responds by writing the second byte of address into the contents of the I2C
Data register.
10. The I2C Controller shifts the rest of the first byte of address and write bit out the SDA
signal.
11. If the I2C slave acknowledges the first address byte by pulling the SDA signal low
during the next high period of SCL, the I2C Controller sets the ACKbit in the I2C
Status register. Continue with step 12.
If the slave does not acknowledge the first address byte, the I2C Controller sets the
NCKIbit and clears the ACK bit in the I2C Status register. Software responds to the
Not Acknowledge interrupt by setting the STOP and FLUSH bits and clearing the TXI
bit. The I2C Controller sends the STOP condition on the bus and clears the STOP and
NCKI bits. The transaction is complete (ignore the following steps).
12. The I2C Controller loads the I2C Shift register with the contents of the I2C Data
register.
13. The I2C Controller shifts the second address byte out the SDA signal. After the first
bit has been sent, the Transmit interrupt is asserted.
14. Software responds by writing a data byte to the I2C Data register.
15. The I2C Controller completes shifting the contents of the shift register on the SDA
signal.
PS019921-0308
I2C Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
149
16. If the I2C slave sends an acknowledge by pulling the SDA signal low during the next
high period of SCL, the I2C Controller sets the ACKbit in the I2C Status register.
Continue with step 17.
If the slave does not acknowledge the second address byte or one of the data bytes, the
I2C Controller sets the NCKIbit and clears the ACK bit in the I2C Status register.
Software responds to the Not Acknowledge interrupt by setting the STOP and FLUSH
bits and clearing the TXI bit. The I2C Controller sends the STOP condition on the bus
and clears the STOP and NCKI bits. The transaction is complete (ignore the following
steps).
17. The I2C Controller shifts the data out by the SDA signal. After the first bit is sent, the
Transmit interrupt is asserted.
18. If more bytes remain to be sent, return to step 14.
19. If the last byte is currently being sent, software sets the STOPbit of the I2C Control
register (or START bit to initiate a new transaction). In the STOP case, software also
clears the TXIbit of the I2C Control register at the same time.
20. The I2C Controller completes transmission of the last data byte on the SDA signal.
21. The slave may either Acknowledge or Not Acknowledge the last byte. Because either
the STOP or START bit is already set, the NCKI interrupt does not occur.
22. The I2C Controller sends the STOP (or RESTART) condition to the I2C bus and clears
the STOP (or START) bit.
Read Transaction with a 7-Bit Address
Figure 31 displays the data transfer format for a read operation to a 7-bit addressed slave.
The shaded regions indicate data transferred from the I2C Controller to slaves and
unshaded regions indicate data transferred from the slaves to the I2C Controller.
S
Slave Address
R = 1
A
Data
A
Data
A
P/S
Figure 31. Receive Data Transfer Format for a 7-Bit Addressed Slave
Follow the steps below for a read operation to a 7-bit addressed slave:
1. Software writes the I2C Data register with a 7-bit slave address plus the read bit (=1).
2. Software asserts the START bit of the I2C Control register.
3. If this is a single byte transfer, Software asserts the NAKbit of the I2C Control register
so that after the first byte of data has been read by the I2C Controller, a Not
Acknowledge is sent to the I2C slave.
PS019921-0308
I2C Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
150
4. The I2C Controller sends the START condition.
5. The I2C Controller shifts the address and read bit out the SDA signal.
6. If the I2C slave acknowledges the address by pulling the SDA signal Low during the
next high period of SCL, the I2C Controller sets the ACK bit in the I2C Status register.
Continue with step 7.
If the slave does not acknowledge, the Not Acknowledge interrupt occurs (NCKI bit is
set in the Status register, ACK bit is cleared). Software responds to the Not
Acknowledge interrupt by setting the STOP bit and clearing the TXI bit. The I2C
Controller sends the STOP condition on the bus and clears the STOP and NCKI bits.
The transaction is complete (ignore the following steps).
7. The I2C Controller shifts in the byte of data from the I2C slave on the SDA signal. The
I2C Controller sends a Not Acknowledge to the I2C slave if the NAK bit is set (last
byte), else it sends an Acknowledge.
8. The I2C Controller asserts the Receive interrupt (RDRF bit set in the Status register).
9. Software responds by reading the I2C Data register which clears the RDRF bit. If there
is only one more byte to receive, set the NAK bit of the I2C Control register.
10. If there are more bytes to transfer, return to step 7.
11. After the last byte is shifted in, a Not Acknowledge interrupt is generated by the I2C
Controller.
12. Software responds by setting the STOPbit of the I2C Control register.
13. A STOP condition is sent to the I2C slave, the STOP and NCKI bits are cleared.
Read Transaction with a 10-Bit Address
Figure 32 displays the read transaction format for a 10-bit addressed slave. The shaded
regions indicate data transferred from the I2C Controller to slaves and unshaded regions
indicate data transferred from the slaves to the I2C Controller.
Slave Address
1st 7 bits
Slave Address
2nd Byte
Slave Address
1st 7 bits
S
W=0 A
A S
R=1 A Data A Data A P
Figure 32. Receive Data Format for a 10-Bit Addressed Slave
The first seven bits transmitted in the first byte are 11110XX. The two bits XXare the two
most-significant bits of the 10-bit address. The lowest bit of the first byte transferred is the
write control bit.
PS019921-0308
I2C Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
151
Follow the steps below for the data transfer for a read operation to a 10-bit addressed
slave:
1. Software writes 11110B followed by the two address bits and a 0 (write) to the I2C
Data register.
2. Software asserts the STARTand TXI bits of the I2C Control register.
3. The I2C Controller sends the Start condition.
4. The I2C Controller loads the I2C Shift register with the contents of the I2C Data
register.
5. After the first bit has been shifted out, a Transmit interrupt is asserted.
6. Software responds by writing the lower eight bits of address to the I2C Data register.
7. The I2C Controller completes shifting of the two address bits and a 0 (write).
8. If the I2C slave acknowledges the first address byte by pulling the SDA signal low
during the next high period of SCL, the I2C Controller sets the ACKbit in the I2C
Status register. Continue with step 9.
If the slave does not acknowledge the first address byte, the I2C Controller sets the
NCKIbit and clears the ACK bit in the I2C Status register. Software responds to the
Not Acknowledge interrupt by setting the STOP and FLUSH bits and clearing the TXI
bit. The I2C Controller sends the STOP condition on the bus and clears the STOP and
NCKI bits. The transaction is complete (ignore following steps).
9. The I2C Controller loads the I2C Shift register with the contents of the I2C Data
register (second address byte).
10. The I2C Controller shifts out the second address byte. After the first bit is shifted, the
I2C Controller generates a Transmit interrupt.
11. Software responds by setting the STARTbit of the I2C Control register to generate a
repeated START and by clearing the TXI bit.
12. Software responds by writing 11110Bfollowed by the 2-bit slave address and a 1
(read) to the I2C Data register.
13. If only one byte is to be read, software sets the NAK bit of the I2C Control register.
14. After the I2C Controller shifts out the 2nd address byte, the I2C slave sends an
acknowledge by pulling the SDA signal low during the next high period of SCL, the
I2C Controller sets the ACKbit in the I2C Status register. Continue with step 15.
If the slave does not acknowledge the second address byte, the I2C Controller sets the
NCKIbit and clears the ACK bit in the I2C Status register. Software responds to the
Not Acknowledge interrupt by setting the STOP and FLUSH bits and clearing the TXI
bit. The I2C Controller sends the STOP condition on the bus and clears the STOP and
NCKI bits. The transaction is complete (ignore the following steps).
PS019921-0308
I2C Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
152
15. The I2C Controller sends the repeated START condition.
16. The I2C Controller loads the I2C Shift register with the contents of the I2C Data
register (third address transfer).
17. The I2C Controller sends 11110Bfollowed by the two most significant bits of the
slave read address and a 1 (read).
18. The I2C slave sends an acknowledge by pulling the SDA signal Low during the next
high period of SCL
If the slave were to Not Acknowledge at this point (this should not happen because the
slave did acknowledge the first two address bytes), software would respond by setting
the STOP and FLUSH bits and clearing the TXI bit. The I2C Controller sends the
STOP condition on the bus and clears the STOP and NCKI bits. The transaction is
complete (ignore the following steps).
19. The I2C Controller shifts in a byte of data from the I2C slave on the SDA signal. The
I2C Controller sends a Not Acknowledge to the I2C slave if the NAK bit is set (last
byte), else it sends an Acknowledge.
20. The I2C Controller asserts the Receive interrupt (RDRF bit set in the Status register).
21. Software responds by reading the I2C Data register which clears the RDRF bit. If there
is only one more byte to receive, set the NAK bit of the I2C Control register.
22. If there are one or more bytes to transfer, return to step 19.
23. After the last byte is shifted in, a Not Acknowledge interrupt is generated by the I2C
Controller.
24. Software responds by setting the STOPbit of the I2C Control register.
25. A STOP condition is sent to the I2C slave and the STOP and NCKI bits are cleared.
2
I C Control Register Definitions
2
I C Data Register
The I2C Data register (see Table 70 on page 153) holds the data that is to be loaded into
the I2C Shift register during a write to a slave. This register also holds data that is loaded
from the I2C Shift register during a read from a slave. The I2C Shift Register is not acces-
sible in the Register File address space, but is used only to buffer incoming and outgoing
data.
PS019921-0308
I2C Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
153
Table 70. I2C Data Register (I2CDATA)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DATA
0
FIELD
RESET
R/W
R/W
F50H
ADDR
I2C Status Register
The Read-only I2C Status register (Table 71) indicates the status of the I2C Controller.
Table 71. I2C Status Register (I2CSTAT)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TDRE
RDRF
ACK
10B
RD
TAS
DSS
NCKI
FIELD
RESET
R/W
1
0
R
F51H
ADDR
TDRE—Transmit Data Register Empty
When the I2C Controller is enabled, this bit is 1 when the I2C Data register is empty.
When this bit is set, an interrupt is generated if the TXI bit is set, except when the I2C
Controller is shifting in data during the reception of a byte or when shifting an address and
the RDbit is set. This bit is cleared by writing to the I2CDATA register.
RDRF—Receive Data Register Full
This bit is set = 1 when the I2C Controller is enabled and the I2C Controller has received a
byte of data. When asserted, this bit causes the I2C Controller to generate an interrupt.
This bit is cleared by reading the I2C Data register (unless the read is performed using exe-
cution of the On-Chip Debugger’s Read Register command).
ACK—Acknowledge
This bit indicates the status of the Acknowledge for the last byte transmitted or received.
When set, this bit indicates that an Acknowledge occurred for the last byte transmitted or
received. This bit is cleared when IEN = 0 or when a Not Acknowledge occurred for the
last byte transmitted or received. It is not reset at the beginning of each transaction and is
not reset when this register is read.
PS019921-0308
I2C Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
154
Caution: Software must be cautious in making decisions based on this bit within a trans-
action because software cannot tell when the bit is updated by hardware. In the
case of write transactions, the I2C pauses at the beginning of the Acknowledge
cycle if the next transmit data or address byte has not been written (TDRE = 1)
and STOP and START = 0. In this case the ACK bit is not updated until the
transmit interrupt is serviced and the Acknowledge cycle for the previous byte
completes. For examples of how the ACK bit can be used, see Address Only
Transaction with a 7-bit Address on page 144 and Address Only Transaction
with a 10-bit Address on page 146.
10B—10-Bit Address
This bit indicates whether a 10- or 7-bit address is being transmitted. After the STARTbit
is set, if the five most-significant bits of the address are 11110B, this bit is set. When set,
it is reset once the first byte of the address has been sent.
RD—Read
This bit indicates the direction of transfer of the data. It is active high during a read. The
status of this bit is determined by the least-significant bit of the I2C Shift register after the
STARTbit is set.
TAS—Transmit Address State
This bit is active high while the address is being shifted out of the I2C Shift register.
DSS—Data Shift State
This bit is active high while data is being shifted to or from the I2C Shift register.
NCKI—NACK Interrupt
This bit is set high when a Not Acknowledge condition is received or sent and neither the
START nor the STOP bit is active. When set, this bit generates an interrupt that can only
be cleared by setting the STARTor STOPbit, allowing you to specify whether to perform
a STOPor a repeated START.
I2C Control Register
The I2C Control register (Table 72) enables the I2C operation.
2
Table 72. I C Control Register (I2CCTL)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
IEN
START
STOP
BIRQ
TXI
NAK
FLUSH
FILTEN
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
R/W
R/W1
R/W1
R/W
R/W
R/W1
W1
R/W
F52H
ADDR
PS019921-0308
I2C Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
155
IEN—I2C Enable
1 = The I2C transmitter and receiver are enabled.
0 = The I2C transmitter and receiver are disabled.
START—Send Start Condition
This bit sends the Start condition. Once asserted, it is cleared by the I2C Controller after it
sends the START condition or if the IENbit is deasserted. If this bit is 1, it cannot be
cleared to 0 by writing to the register. After this bit is set, the Start condition is sent if there
is data in the I2C Data or I2C Shift register. If there is no data in one of these registers, the
I2C Controller waits until the Data register is written. If this bit is set while the I2C
Controller is shifting out data, it generates a START condition after the byte shifts and the
acknowledge phase completes. If the STOPbit is also set, it also waits until the STOP
condition is sent before the sending the START condition.
STOP—Send Stop Condition
This bit causes the I2C Controller to issue a Stop condition after the byte in the I2C Shift
register has completed transmission or after a byte has been received in a receive
operation. Once set, this bit is reset by the I2C Controller after a Stop condition has been
sent or by deasserting the IENbit. If this bit is 1, it cannot be cleared to 0 by writing to the
register.
BIRQ—Baud Rate Generator Interrupt Request
This bit allows the I2C Controller to be used as an additional timer when the I2C
Controller is disabled. This bit is ignored when the I2C Controller is enabled.
1 = An interrupt occurs every time the baud rate generator counts down to one.
0 = No baud rate generator interrupt occurs.
TXI—Enable TDRE interrupts
This bit enables the transmit interrupt when the I2C Data register is empty (TDRE = 1).
1 = Transmit interrupt (and DMA transmit request) is enabled.
0 = Transmit interrupt (and DMA transmit request) is disabled.
NAK—Send NAK
This bit sends a Not Acknowledge condition after the next byte of data has been read from
the I2C slave. Once asserted, it is deasserted after a Not Acknowledge is sent or the IEN
bit is deasserted. If this bit is 1, it cannot be cleared to 0 by writing to the register.
FLUSH—Flush Data
Setting this bit to 1 clears the I2C Data register and sets the TDRE bit to 1. This bit allows
flushing of the I2C Data register when a Not Acknowledge interrupt is received after the
data has been sent to the I2C Data register. Reading this bit always returns 0.
FILTEN—I2C Signal Filter Enable
This bit enables low-pass digital filters on the SDA and SCL input signals. These filters
reject any input pulse with periods less than a full system clock cycle. The filters introduce
a 3-system clock cycle latency on the inputs.
1 = low-pass filters are enabled.
0 = low-pass filters are disabled.
PS019921-0308
I2C Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
156
I2C Baud Rate High and Low Byte Registers
The I2C Baud Rate High and Low Byte registers (Tables 73 and 73) combine to form a
16-bit reload value, BRG[15:0], for the I2C Baud Rate Generator.
When the I2C is disabled, the Baud Rate Generator can function as a basic 16-bit timer
with interrupt on time-out. To configure the Baud Rate Generator as a timer with interrupt
on time-out, complete the following procedure:
1. Disable the I2C by clearing the IENbit in the I2C Control register to 0.
2. Load the desired 16-bit count value into the I2C Baud Rate High and Low Byte
registers.
3. Enable the Baud Rate Generator timer function and associated interrupt by setting the
BIRQbit in the I2C Control register to 1.
When configured as a general purpose timer, the interrupt interval is calculated using the
following equation:
Interrupt Interval (s) = System Clock Period (s) × BRG[15:0]
Table 73. I2C Baud Rate High Byte Register (I2CBRH)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
BRH
FFH
FIELD
RESET
R/W
R/W
F53H
ADDR
BRH = I2C Baud Rate High Byte
Most significant byte, BRG[15:8], of the I2C Baud Rate Generator’s reload value.
Note: If the DIAG bit in the I2C Diagnostic Control Register is set to 1, a read of the I2CBRH
register returns the current value of the I2C Baud Rate Counter[15:8].
PS019921-0308
I2C Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
157
Table 74. I2C Baud Rate Low Byte Register (I2CBRL)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
BRL
FFH
R/W
F54H
FIELD
RESET
R/W
ADDR
BRL = I2C Baud Rate Low Byte
Least significant byte, BRG[7:0], of the I2C Baud Rate Generator’s reload value.
Note: If the DIAG bit in the I2C Diagnostic Control Register is set to 1, a read of the I2CBRL
register returns the current value of the I2C Baud Rate Counter[7:0].
I2C Diagnostic State Register
The I2C Diagnostic State register (Table 75) provides observability of internal state. This
is a read only register used for I2C diagnostics and manufacturing test.
Table 75. I2C Diagnostic State Register (I2CDST)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
SCLIN
SDAIN
STPCNT
TXRXSTATE
FIELD
RESET
R/W
X
0
R
F55H
ADDR
SCLIN—Value of Serial Clock input signal
SDAIN—Value of the Serial Data input signal
STPCNT—Value of the internal Stop Count control signal
TXRXSTATE—Value of the internal I2C state machine
PS019921-0308
I2C Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
158
TXRXSTATE
0_0000
0_0001
0_0010
0_0011
0_0100
0_0101
0_0110
0_0111
0_1000
0_1001
0_1010
0_1011
State Description
Idle State
START State
Send/Receive data bit 7
Send/Receive data bit 6
Send/Receive data bit 5
Send/Receive data bit 4
Send/Receive data bit 3
Send/Receive data bit 2
Send/Receive data bit 1
Send/Receive data bit 0
Data Acknowledge State
Second half of data Acknowledge State used only for not
acknowledge
0_1100
0_1101
0_1110
First part of STOP state
Second part of STOP state
10-bit addressing: Acknowledge State for 2nd address byte
7-bit addressing: Address Acknowledge State
0_1111
10-bit address: Bit 0 (Least significant bit) of 2nd address byte
7-bit address: Bit 0 (Least significant bit) (R/W) of address byte
1_0000
1_0001
1_0010
1_0011
1_0100
1_0101
1_0110
1_0111
1_1000
1_1001
10-bit addressing: Bit 7 (Most significant bit) of 1st address byte
10-bit addressing: Bit 6 of 1st address byte
10-bit addressing: Bit 5 of 1st address byte
10-bit addressing: Bit 4 of 1st address byte
10-bit addressing: Bit 3 of 1st address byte
10-bit addressing: Bit 2 of 1st address byte
10-bit addressing: Bit 1 of 1st address byte
10-bit addressing: Bit 0 (R/W) of 1st address byte
10-bit addressing: Acknowledge state for 1st address byte
10-bit addressing: Bit 7 of 2nd address byte
7-bit addressing: Bit 7 of address byte
1_1010
1_1011
1_1100
10-bit addressing: Bit 6 of 2nd address byte
7-bit addressing: Bit 6 of address byte
10-bit addressing: Bit 5 of 2nd address byte
7-bit addressing: Bit 5 of address byte
10-bit addressing: Bit 4 of 2nd address byte
7-bit addressing: Bit 4 of address byte
PS019921-0308
I2C Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
159
TXRXSTATE
State Description
1_1101
10-bit addressing: Bit 3 of 2nd address byte
7-bit addressing: Bit 3 of address byte
1_1110
1_1111
10-bit addressing: Bit 2 of 2nd address byte
7-bit addressing: Bit 2 of address byte
10-bit addressing: Bit 1 of 2nd address byte
7-bit addressing: Bit 1 of address byte
I2C Diagnostic Control Register
The I2C Diagnostic register (Table 76) provides control over diagnostic modes. This regis-
ter is a read/write register used for I2C diagnostics.
Table 76. I2C Diagnostic Control Register (I2CDIAG)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reserved
DIAG
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
R
R/W
F56H
ADDR
DIAG = Diagnostic Control Bit - Selects read back value of the Baud Rate Reload regis-
ters.
0 = NORMAL mode. Reading the Baud Rate High and Low Byte registers returns the
baud rate reload value.
1 = DIAGNOSTIC mode. Reading the Baud Rate High and Low Byte registers returns
the baud rate counter value.
PS019921-0308
I2C Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
160
PS019921-0308
I2C Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
161
Direct Memory Access Controller
The Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series Direct Memory Access (DMA) Controller provides
three independent Direct Memory Access channels. Two of the channels (DMA0 and
DMA1) transfer data between the on-chip peripherals and the Register File. The third
channel (DMA_ADC) controls the ADC operation and transfers SINGLE-SHOT mode
ADC output data to the Register File.
Operation
DMA0 and DMA1 Operation
DMA0 and DMA1, referred to collectively as DMAx, transfer data either from the on-chip
peripheral control registers to the Register File, or from the Register File to the on-chip
peripheral control registers. The sequence of operations in a DMAx data transfer is:
1. DMAx trigger source requests a DMA data transfer.
2. DMAx requests control of the system bus (address and data) from the eZ8 CPU.
3. After the eZ8 CPU acknowledges the bus request, DMAx transfers either a single byte
or a two-byte word (depending upon configuration) and then returns system bus
control back to the eZ8 CPU.
4. If Current Address equals End Address:
–
–
DMAx reloads the original Start Address
If configured to generate an interrupt, DMAx sends an interrupt request to the
Interrupt Controller
–
If configured for single-pass operation, DMAx resets the DENbit in the DMAx
Control register to 0 and the DMA is disabled.
If Current Address does not equal End Address, the Current Address increments by 1
(single-byte transfer) or 2 (two-byte word transfer).
Configuring DMA0 and DMA1 for Data Transfer
Follow the steps below to configure and enable DMA0 or DMA1:
1. Write to the DMAx I/O Address register to set the Register File address identifying the
on-chip peripheral control register. The upper nibble of the 12-bit address for on-chip
peripheral control registers is always FH. The full address is {FH, DMAx_IO[7:0]}.
2. Determine the 12-bit Start and End Register File addresses. The 12-bit Start Address
is given by {DMAx_H[3:0], DMA_START[7:0]}. The 12-bit End Address is given by
{DMAx_H[7:4], DMA_END[7:0]}.
PS019921-0308
Direct Memory Access Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
162
3. Write the Start and End Register File address high nibbles to the DMAx End/Start
Address High Nibble register.
4. Write the lower byte of the Start Address to the DMAx Start/Current Address register.
5. Write the lower byte of the End Address to the DMAx End Address register.
6. Write to the DMAx Control register to complete the following:
–
Select loop or single-pass mode operation
–
Select the data transfer direction (either from the Register File RAM to the on-
chip peripheral control register; or from the on-chip peripheral control register to
the Register File RAM)
–
–
–
–
Enable the DMAx interrupt request, if desired
Select Word or Byte mode
Select the DMAx request trigger
Enable the DMAx channel
DMA_ADC Operation
DMA_ADC transfers data from the ADC to the Register File. The sequence of operations
in a DMA_ADC data transfer is:
1. ADC completes conversion on the current ADC input channel and signals the DMA
controller that two-bytes of ADC data are ready for transfer.
2. DMA_ADC requests control of the system bus (address and data) from the eZ8 CPU.
3. After the eZ8 CPU acknowledges the bus request, DMA_ADC transfers the two-byte
ADC output value to the Register File and then returns system bus control back to the
eZ8 CPU.
4. If the current ADC Analog Input is the highest numbered input to be converted:
–
DMA_ADC resets the ADC Analog Input number to 0 and initiates data
conversion on ADC Analog Input 0.
–
If configured to generate an interrupt, DMA_ADC sends an interrupt request to
the Interrupt Controller
If the current ADC Analog Input is not the highest numbered input to be converted,
DMA_ADC initiates data conversion in the next higher numbered ADC Analog Input.
Configuring DMA_ADC for Data Transfer
Follow the steps below to configure and enable DMA_ADC:
1. Write the DMA_ADC Address register with the 7 most-significant bits of the Register
File address for data transfers.
2. Write to the DMA_ADC Control register to complete the following:
PS019921-0308
Direct Memory Access Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
163
–
–
–
Enable the DMA_ADC interrupt request, if desired
Select the number of ADC Analog Inputs to convert
Enable the DMA_ADC channel
Caution: When using the DMA_ADC to perform conversions on multiple ADC inputs,
the Analog-to-Digital Converter must be configured for SINGLE-SHOT mode.
If the ADC_IN field in the DMA_ADC Control Register is greater than 000b,
the ADC must be in SINGLE-SHOT mode.
CONTINUOUS mode operation of the ADC can only be used in conjunction
with DMA_ADC if the ADC_IN field in the DMA_ADC Control Register is re-
set to 000b to enable conversion on ADC Analog Input 0 only.
DMA Control Register Definitions
DMAx Control Register
The DMAx Control register (see Table 77 on page 163) enables and selects the mode of
operation for DMAx.
Table 77. DMAx Control Register (DMAxCTL)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DEN
DLE
DDIR
IRQEN
WSEL
RSS
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
R/W
FB0H, FB8H
ADDR
DEN—DMAx Enable
0 = DMAx is disabled and data transfer requests are disregarded.
1 = DMAx is enabled and initiates a data transfer upon receipt of a request from the
trigger source.
DLE—DMAx Loop Enable
0 = DMAx reloads the original Start Address and is then disabled after the End
Address data is transferred.
PS019921-0308
Direct Memory Access Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
164
1 = DMAx, after the End Address data is transferred, reloads the original Start
Address and continues operating.
DDIR—DMAx Data Transfer Direction
0 = Register File → on-chip peripheral control register.
1 = on-chip peripheral control register → Register File.
IRQEN—DMAx Interrupt Enable
0 = DMAx does not generate any interrupts.
1 = DMAx generates an interrupt when the End Address data is transferred.
WSEL—Word Select
0 = DMAx transfers a single byte per request.
1 = DMAx transfers a two-byte word per request. The address for the on-chip
peripheral control register must be an even address.
RSS—Request Trigger Source Select
The Request Trigger Source Select field determines the peripheral that can initiate a DMA
transfer. The corresponding interrupts do not need to be enabled within the Interrupt Con-
troller to initiate a DMA transfer. However, if the Request Trigger Source can enable or
disable the interrupt request sent to the Interrupt Controller, the interrupt request must be
enabled within the Request Trigger Source block.
000 = Timer 0.
001 = Timer 1.
010 = Timer 2.
011 = Timer 3.
100 = DMA0 Control register: UART0 Received Data register contains valid data.
DMA1 Control register: UART0 Transmit Data register empty.
101 = DMA0 Control register: UART1 Received Data register contains valid data. DMA1
Control register: UART1 Transmit Data register empty.
110 = DMA0 Control register: I2C Receiver Interrupt. DMA1 Control register: I2C
Transmitter Interrupt register empty.
111 = Reserved.
DMAx I/O Address Register
The DMAx I/O Address register (Table 78) contains the low byte of the on-chip peripheral
address for data transfer. The full 12-bit Register File address is given by {FH,
PS019921-0308
Direct Memory Access Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
165
DMAx_IO[7:0]}. When the DMA is configured for two-byte word transfers, the
DMAx I/O Address register must contain an even numbered address.
Table 78. DMAx I/O Address Register (DMAxIO)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DMA_IO
X
FIELD
RESET
R/W
R/W
FB1H, FB9H
ADDR
DMA_IO—DMA on-chip peripheral control register address
This byte sets the low byte of the on-chip peripheral control register address on Register
File Page FH(addresses F00Hto FFFH).
DMAx Address High Nibble Register
The DMAx Address High register (Table 79) specifies the upper four bits of address for
the Start/Current and End Addresses of DMAx.
Table 79. DMAx Address High Nibble Register (DMAxH)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DMA_END_H
DMA_START_H
FIELD
RESET
R/W
X
R/W
FB2H, FBAH
ADDR
DMA_END_H—DMAx End Address High Nibble
These bits, used with the DMAx End Address Low register, form a 12-bit End Address.
The full 12-bit address is given by {DMA_END_H[3:0], DMA_END[7:0]}.
DMA_START_H—DMAx Start/Current Address High Nibble
These bits, used with the DMAx Start/Current Address Low register, form a 12-bit
Start/Current Address. The full 12-bit address is given by {DMA_START_H[3:0],
DMA_START[7:0]}.
PS019921-0308
Direct Memory Access Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
166
DMAx Start/Current Address Low Byte Register
The DMAx Start/Current Address Low register, in conjunction with the DMAx Address
High Nibble register, forms a 12-bit Start/Current Address. Writes to this register set the
Start Address for DMA operations. Each time the DMA completes a data transfer, the
12-bit Start/Current Address increments by either 1 (single-byte transfer) or 2 (two-byte
word transfer). Reads from this register return the low byte of the Current Address to be
used for the next DMA data transfer.
Table 80. DMAx Start/Current Address Low Byte Register (DMAxSTART)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DMA_START
X
FIELD
RESET
R/W
R/W
FB3H, FBBH
ADDR
DMA_START—DMAx Start/Current Address Low
These bits, with the four lower bits of the DMAx_H register, form the 12-bit Start/Current
address. The full 12-bit address is given by {DMA_START_H[3:0], DMA_START[7:0]}.
DMAx End Address Low Byte Register
The DMAx End Address Low Byte register (Table 80), in conjunction with the DMAx_H
register (Table 81), forms a 12-bit End Address.
Table 81. DMAx End Address Low Byte Register (DMAxEND)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DMA_END
FIELD
RESET
R/W
X
R/W
FB4H, FBCH
ADDR
DMA_END—DMAx End Address Low
These bits, with the four upper bits of the DMAx_H register, form a 12-bit address. This
address is the ending location of the DMAx transfer. The full 12-bit address is given by
{DMA_END_H[3:0], DMA_END[7:0]}.
PS019921-0308
Direct Memory Access Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
167
DMA_ADC Address Register
The DMA_ADC Address register (Table 83) points to a block of the Register File to store
ADC conversion values as displayed in Table 82. This register contains the seven most-
significant bits of the 12-bit Register File addresses. The five least-significant bits are cal-
culated from the ADC Analog Input number (5-bit base address is equal to twice the ADC
Analog Input number). The 10-bit ADC conversion data is stored as two bytes with the
most significant byte of the ADC data stored at the even numbered Register File address.
Table 82 provides an example of the Register File addresses if the DMA_ADC Address
register contains the value 72H.
Table 82. DMA_ADC Register File Address Example
1
ADC Analog Input
Register File Address (Hex)
720H-721H
0
1
722H-723H
2
724H-725H
3
726H-727H
4
728H-729H
5
72AH-72BH
72CH-72DH
72EH-72FH
730H-731H
6
7
8
9
732H-733H
10
11
734H-735H
736H-737H
1DMAA_ADDR set to 72H.
Table 83. DMA_ADC Address Register (DMAA_ADDR)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DMAA_ADDR
Reserved
FIELD
RESET
R/W
X
R/W
FBDH
ADDR
PS019921-0308
Direct Memory Access Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
168
DMAA_ADDR—DMA_ADC Address
These bits specify the seven most-significant bits of the 12-bit Register File addresses
used for storing the ADC output data. The ADC Analog Input Number defines the five
least-significant bits of the Register File address. Full 12-bit address is
{DMAA_ADDR[7:1], 4-bit ADC Analog Input Number, 0}.
Reserved
This bit is reserved and must be 0.
DMA_ADC Control Register
The DMA_ADC Control register (Table 84 on page 168) enables and sets options (DMA
enable and interrupt enable) for ADC operation.
Table 84. DMA_ADC Control Register (DMAACTL)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DAEN
IRQEN
Reserved
ADC_IN
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
R/W
FBEH
ADDR
DAEN—DMA_ADC Enable
0 = DMA_ADC is disabled and the ADC Analog Input Number (ADC_IN) is reset to 0.
1 = DMA_ADC is enabled.
IRQEN—Interrupt Enable
0 = DMA_ADC does not generate any interrupts.
1 = DMA_ADC generates an interrupt after transferring data from the last ADC Analog
Input specified by the ADC_IN field.
Reserved
These bits are reserved and must be 0.
ADC_IN—ADC Analog Input Number
These bits set the number of ADC Analog Inputs to be used in the continuous update
(data conversion followed by DMA data transfer). The conversion always begins with
ADC Analog Input 0 and then progresses sequentially through the other selected ADC
Analog Inputs.
0000 = ADC Analog Input 0 updated.
0001 = ADC Analog Inputs 0-1 updated.
0010 = ADC Analog Inputs 0-2 updated.
0011 = ADC Analog Inputs 0-3 updated.
0100 = ADC Analog Inputs 0-4 updated.
PS019921-0308
Direct Memory Access Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
169
0101 = ADC Analog Inputs 0-5 updated.
0110 = ADC Analog Inputs 0-6 updated.
0111 = ADC Analog Inputs 0-7 updated.
1000 = ADC Analog Inputs 0-8 updated.
1001 = ADC Analog Inputs 0-9 updated.
1010 = ADC Analog Inputs 0-10 updated.
1011 = ADC Analog Inputs 0-11 updated.
1100-1111 = Reserved.
DMA Status Register
The DMA Status register (Table 85 on page 169) indicates the DMA channel that gener-
ated the interrupt and the ADC Analog Input that is currently undergoing conversion.
Reads from this register reset the Interrupt Request Indicator bits (IRQA, IRQ1, and
IRQ0) to 0. Therefore, software interrupt service routines that read this register must pro-
cess all three interrupt sources from the DMA.
Table 85. DMA_ADC Status Register (DMAA_STAT)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
CADC[3:0]
Reserved
IRQA
IRQ1
IRQ0
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
R
FBFH
ADDR
CADC[3:0]—Current ADC Analog Input
This field identifies the Analog Input that the ADC is currently converting.
Reserved
This bit is reserved and must be 0.
IRQA—DMA_ADC Interrupt Request Indicator
This bit is automatically reset to 0 each time a read from this register occurs.
0 = DMA_ADC is not the source of the interrupt from the DMA Controller.
1 = DMA_ADC completed transfer of data from the last ADC Analog Input and generated
an interrupt.
IRQ1—DMA1 Interrupt Request Indicator
This bit is automatically reset to 0 each time a read from this register occurs.
0 = DMA1 is not the source of the interrupt from the DMA Controller.
1 = DMA1 completed transfer of data to/from the End Address and generated an interrupt.
IRQ0—DMA0 Interrupt Request Indicator
This bit is automatically reset to 0 each time a read from this register occurs.
PS019921-0308
Direct Memory Access Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
170
0 = DMA0 is not the source of the interrupt from the DMA Controller.
1 = DMA0 completed transfer of data to/from the End Address and generated an interrupt.
PS019921-0308
Direct Memory Access Controller
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
171
Analog-to-Digital Converter
The Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) converts an analog input signal to a 10-bit binary
number. The features of the sigma-delta ADC include:
•
•
•
•
12 analog input sources are multiplexed with general-purpose I/O ports
Interrupt upon conversion complete
Internal voltage reference generator
Direct Memory Access (DMA) controller can automatically initiate data conversion
and transfer of the data from 1 to 12 of the analog inputs
Architecture
Figure 33 displays the three major functional blocks (converter, analog multiplexer, and
voltage reference generator) of the ADC. The ADC converts an analog input signal to its
digital representation. The 12-input analog multiplexer selects one of the 12 analog input
sources. The ADC requires an input reference voltage for the conversion. The voltage
reference for the conversion may be input through the external VREF pin or generated
internally by the voltage reference generator.
PS019921-0308
Analog-to-Digital Converter
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
172
VREF
Internal Voltage
Reference Generator
Analog Input
Multiplexer
ANA0
ANA1
ANA2
ANA3
ANA4
ANA5
ANA6
ANA7
ANA8
ANA9
ANA10
ANA11
Analog-to-Digital
Converter
Reference Input
Analog Input
ANAIN[3:0]
Figure 33. Analog-to-Digital Converter Block Diagram
The sigma-delta ADC architecture provides alias and image attenuation below the ampli-
tude resolution of the ADC in the frequency range of DC to one-half the ADC clock rate
(one-fourth the system clock rate). The ADC provides alias free conversion for frequen-
cies up to one-half the ADC clock rate. Thus the sigma-delta ADC exhibits high noise
immunity making it ideal for embedded applications. In addition, monotonicity (no miss-
ing codes) is guaranteed by design.
Operation
Automatic Power-Down
If the ADC is idle (no conversions in progress) for 160 consecutive system clock cycles,
portions of the ADC are automatically powered-down. From this power-down state, the
ADC requires 40 system clock cycles to power-up. The ADC powers up when a conver-
sion is requested using the ADC Control register.
PS019921-0308
Analog-to-Digital Converter
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
173
Single-Shot Conversion
When configured for single-shot conversion, the ADC performs a single analog-to-digital
conversion on the selected analog input channel. After completion of the conversion, the
ADC shuts down. Follow the steps below for setting up the ADC and initiating a single-
shot conversion:
1. Enable the desired analog inputs by configuring the general-purpose I/O pins for
alternate function. This configuration disables the digital input and output drivers.
2. Write to the ADC Control register to configure the ADC and begin the conversion.
The bit fields in the ADC Control register can be written simultaneously:
–
–
–
–
Write to the ANAIN[3:0]field to select one of the 12 analog input sources.
Clear CONTto 0 to select a single-shot conversion.
Write to the VREFbit to enable or disable the internal voltage reference generator.
Set CENto 1 to start the conversion.
3. CENremains 1 while the conversion is in progress. A single-shot conversion requires
5129 system clock cycles to complete. If a single-shot conversion is requested from an
ADC powered-down state, the ADC uses 40 additional clock cycles to power-up
before beginning the 5129 cycle conversion.
4. When the conversion is complete, the ADC control logic performs the following
operations:
–
–
–
10-bit data result written to {ADCD_H[7:0], ADCD_L[7:6]}.
CENresets to 0 to indicate the conversion is complete.
An interrupt request is sent to the Interrupt Controller.
5. If the ADC remains idle for 160 consecutive system clock cycles, it is automatically
powered-down.
Continuous Conversion
When configured for continuous conversion, the ADC continuously performs an analog-
to-digital conversion on the selected analog input. Each new data value over-writes the
previous value stored in the ADC Data registers. An interrupt is generated after each con-
version.
Caution: In CONTINUOUS mode, you must be aware that ADC updates are limited by
the input signal bandwidth of the ADC and the latency of the ADC and its dig-
ital filter. Step changes at the input are not seen at the next output from the
ADC. The response of the ADC (in all modes) is limited by the input signal
bandwidth and the latency.
PS019921-0308
Analog-to-Digital Converter
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
174
Follow the steps below for setting up the ADC and initiating continuous conversion:
1. Enable the desired analog input by configuring the general-purpose I/O pins for
alternate function. This disables the digital input and output driver.
2. Write to the ADC Control register to configure the ADC for continuous conversion.
The bit fields in the ADC Control register may be written simultaneously:
–
–
–
–
Write to the ANAIN[3:0]field to select one of the 12 analog input sources.
Set CONTto 1 to select continuous conversion.
Write to the VREFbit to enable or disable the internal voltage reference generator.
Set CENto 1 to start the conversions.
3. When the first conversion in continuous operation is complete (after 5129 system
clock cycles, plus the 40 cycles for power-up, if necessary), the ADC control logic
performs the following operations:
–
CENresets to 0 to indicate the first conversion is complete. CENremains 0 for all
subsequent conversions in continuous operation.
–
An interrupt request is sent to the Interrupt Controller to indicate the conversion is
complete.
4. Thereafter, the ADC writes a new 10-bit data result to {ADCD_H[7:0],
ADCD_L[7:6]} every 256 system clock cycles. An interrupt request is sent to the
Interrupt Controller when each conversion is complete.
5. To disable continuous conversion, clear the CONTbit in the ADC Control register
to 0.
DMA Control of the ADC
The Direct Memory Access (DMA) Controller can control operation of the ADC includ-
ing analog input selection and conversion enable. For more information on the DMA and
configuring for ADC operations, see Direct Memory Access Controller on page 161.
PS019921-0308
Analog-to-Digital Converter
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
175
ADC Control Register Definitions
ADC Control Register
The ADC Control register selects the analog input channel and initiates the analog-to-dig-
ital conversion.
Table 86. ADC Control Register (ADCCTL)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
CEN
Reserved
VREF
CONT
ANAIN[3:0]
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
1
0
R/W
F70H
ADDR
CEN—Conversion Enable
0 = Conversion is complete. Writing a 0 produces no effect. The ADC automatically clears
this bit to 0 when a conversion has been completed.
1 = Begin conversion. Writing a 1 to this bit starts a conversion. If a conversion is already
in progress, the conversion restarts. This bit remains 1 until the conversion is complete.
Reserved—Must be 0.
VREF
0 = Internal voltage reference generator enabled. The VREF pin should be left uncon-
nected (or capacitively coupled to analog ground) if the internal voltage reference is
selected as the ADC reference voltage.
1 = Internal voltage reference generator disabled. An external voltage reference must be
provided through the VREF pin.
CONT
0 = Single-shot conversion. ADC data is output once at completion of the 5129 system
clock cycles.
1 = Continuous conversion. ADC data updated every 256 system clock cycles.
ANAIN—Analog Input Select
These bits select the analog input for conversion. For information on the Port pins avail-
able with each package style, see Signal and Pin Descriptions on page 7. Do not enable
unavailable analog inputs.
0000 = ANA0
0001 = ANA1
0010 = ANA2
0011 = ANA3
0100 = ANA4
PS019921-0308
Analog-to-Digital Converter
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
176
0101 = ANA5
0110 = ANA6
0111 = ANA7
1000 = ANA8
1001 = ANA9
1010 = ANA10
1011 = ANA11
11XX = Reserved.
ADC Data High Byte Register
The ADC Data High Byte register (Table 87) contains the upper eight bits of the 10-bit
ADC output. During a single-shot conversion, this value is invalid. Access to the ADC
Data High Byte register is read-only. The full 10-bit ADC result is given by
{ADCD_H[7:0], ADCD_L[7:6]}. Reading the ADC Data High Byte register latches data
in the ADC Low Bits register.
Table 87. ADC Data High Byte Register (ADCD_H)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
ADCD_H
FIELD
RESET
R/W
X
R
F72H
ADDR
ADCD_H—ADC Data High Byte
This byte contains the upper eight bits of the 10-bit ADC output. These bits are not valid
during a single-shot conversion. During a continuous conversion, the last conversion out-
put is held in this register. These bits are undefined after a Reset.
ADC Data Low Bits Register
The ADC Data Low Bits register (Table 88) contains the lower two bits of the conversion
value. The data in the ADC Data Low Bits register is latched each time the ADC Data
High Byte register is read. Reading this register always returns the lower two bits of the
conversion last read into the ADC High Byte register. Access to the ADC Data Low Bits
register is read-only. The full 10-bit ADC result is given by {ADCD_H[7:0],
ADCD_L[7:6]}.
PS019921-0308
Analog-to-Digital Converter
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
177
Table 88. ADC Data Low Bits Register (ADCD_L)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
ADCD_L
Reserved
FIELD
RESET
R/W
X
R
F73H
ADDR
ADCD_L—ADC Data Low Bits
These are the least significant two bits of the 10-bit ADC output. These bits are undefined
after a Reset.
Reserved
These bits are reserved and are always undefined.
PS019921-0308
Analog-to-Digital Converter
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
178
PS019921-0308
Analog-to-Digital Converter
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
179
Flash Memory
The products in the Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series feature up to 64 KB (65,536 bytes) of
non-volatile Flash memory with read/write/erase capability. The Flash memory can be
programmed and erased in-circuit by either user code or through the On-Chip Debugger.
The Flash memory array is arranged in 512 byte per page. The 512 byte page is the
minimum Flash block size that can be erased. The Flash memory is also divided into 8
sectors which can be protected from programming and erase operations on a per sector
basis.
Table 89 describes the Flash memory configuration for each device in the Z8 Encore! XP
F64XX Series. Table 90 on page 180 lists the sector address ranges. Figure 34 on
page 180 displays the Flash memory arrangement.
Table 89. Flash Memory Configurations
Pages
per
Number
Flash Memory
Addresses
Number of
Sectors
Part Number
Z8F162x
Z8F242x
Z8F322x
Z8F482x
Z8F642x
Flash Size of Pages
Sector Size
2K (2048)
4K (4096)
4K (4096)
8K (8192)
8K (8192)
Sector
16K (16,384)
24K (24,576)
32K (32,768)
48K (49,152)
64K (65,536)
32
48
0000H - 3FFFH
0000H - 5FFFH
0000H - 7FFFH
0000H - BFFFH
0000H - FFFFH
8
6
8
6
8
4
8
64
8
96
16
16
128
PS019921-0308
Flash Memory
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
180
Table 90. Flash Memory Sector Addresses
Flash Sector Address Ranges
Z8F242x Z8F322x Z8F482x
Sector Number
Z8F162x
Z8F642x
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0000H-07FFH 0000H-0FFFH 0000H-0FFFH 0000H-1FFFH 0000H-1FFFH
0800H-0FFFH 1000H-1FFFH 1000H-1FFFH 2000H-3FFFH 2000H-3FFFH
1000H-17FFH 2000H-2FFFH 2000H-2FFFH 4000H-5FFFH 4000H-5FFFH
1800H-1FFFH 3000H-3FFFH 3000H-3FFFH 6000H-7FFFH 6000H-7FFFH
2000H-27FFH 4000H-4FFFH 4000H-4FFFH 8000H-9FFFH 8000H-9FFFH
2800H-2FFFH 5000H-5FFFH 5000H-5FFFH A000H-BFFFH A000H-BFFFH
3000H-37FFH
3800H-3FFFH
N/A
N/A
6000H-6FFFH
7000H-7FFFH
N/A
N/A
C000H-DFFFH
E000H-FFFFH
64 KB Flash
Program Memory
Addresses
FFFFH
FE00H
FDFFH
FC00H
FBFFH
FA00H
128 Pages
512 Bytes per Page
05FFH
0400H
03FFH
0200H
01FFH
0000H
Figure 34. Flash Memory Arrangement
PS019921-0308
Flash Memory
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
181
Information Area
Table 91 describes the Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series Information Area. This 512 byte
Information Area is accessed by setting bit 7 of the Page Select Register to 1. When access
is enabled, the Information Area is mapped into Flash Memory and overlays the 512 bytes
at addresses FE00Hto FFFFH. When the Information Area access is enabled, LDC instruc-
tions return data from the Information Area. CPU instruction fetches always comes from
Flash Memory regardless of the Information Area access bit. Access to the Information
Area is read-only.
Table 91. Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series Information Area Map
Flash Memory Address (Hex)
FE00H-FE3FH
Function
Reserved
FE40H-FE53H
Part Number
20-character ASCII alphanumeric code
Left justified and filled with zeros
FE54H-FFFFH
Reserved
Operation
The Flash Controller provides the proper signals and timing for Byte Programming, Page
Erase, and Mass Erase of the Flash memory. The Flash Controller contains a protection
mechanism, via the Flash Control register (FCTL), to prevent accidental programming or
erasure. The following subsections provide details on the various operations (Lock,
Unlock, Sector Protect, Byte Programming, Page Erase, and Mass Erase).
PS019921-0308
Flash Memory
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
182
Timing Using the Flash Frequency Registers
Before performing a program or erase operation on the Flash memory, you must first
configure the Flash Frequency High and Low Byte registers. The Flash Frequency
registers allow programming and erasure of the Flash with system clock frequencies
ranging from 20 kHz through 20 MHz (the valid range is limited to the device operating
frequencies).
The Flash Frequency High and Low Byte registers combine to form a 16-bit value,
FFREQ, to control timing for Flash program and erase operations. The 16-bit Flash
Frequency value must contain the system clock frequency in kHz. This value is calculated
using the following equation:.
System Clock Frequency (Hz)
------------------------------------------------------------------------
1000
FFREQ[15:0] =
Flash programming and erasure are not supported for system clock frequencies
below 20 kHz, above 20 MHz, or outside of the device operating frequency
range. The Flash Frequency High and Low Byte registers must be loaded with
the correct value to insure proper Flash programming and erase operations.
Caution:
Flash Read Protection
The user code contained within the Flash memory can be protected from external access.
Programming the Flash Read Protect Option Bit prevents reading of user code by the On-
Chip Debugger or by using the Flash Controller Bypass mode. For more information, see
Option Bits on page 191 and On-Chip Debugger on page 195.
Flash Write/Erase Protection
The Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series provides several levels of protection against acciden-
tal program and erasure of the Flash memory contents. This protection is provided by the
Flash Controller unlock mechanism, the Flash Sector Protect register, and the Flash Write
Protect option bit.
Flash Controller Unlock Mechanism
At Reset, the Flash Controller locks to prevent accidental program or erasure of the Flash
memory. To program or erase the Flash memory, the Flash controller must be unlocked.
After unlocking the Flash Controller, the Flash can be programmed or erased. Any value
written by user code to the Flash Control register or Page Select Register out of sequence
will lock the Flash Controller.
Follow the steps below to unlock the Flash Controller from user code:
1. Write 00Hto the Flash Control register to reset the Flash Controller.
2. Write the page to be programmed or erased to the Page Select register.
PS019921-0308
Flash Memory
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
183
3. Write the first unlock command 73Hto the Flash Control register.
4. Write the second unlock command 8CHto the Flash Control register.
5. Re-write the page written in step 2 to the Page Select register.
Flash Sector Protection
The Flash Sector Protect register can be configured to prevent sectors from being
programmed or erased. Once a sector is protected, it cannot be unprotected by user code.
The Flash Sector Protect register is cleared after reset and any previously written
protection values is lost. User code must write this register in their initialization routine if
they want to enable sector protection.
The Flash Sector Protect register shares its Register File address with the Page Select
register. The Flash Sector Protect register is accessed by writing the Flash Control register
with 5EH. Once the Flash Sector Protect register is selected, it can be accessed at the Page
Select Register address. When user code writes the Flash Sector Protect register, bits can
only be set to 1. Thus, sectors can be protected, but not unprotected, via register write
operations. Writing a value other than 5EHto the Flash Control register de-selects the
Flash Sector Protect register and re-enables access to the Page Select register.
Follow the steps below to setup the Flash Sector Protect register from user code:
1. Write 00Hto the Flash Control register to reset the Flash Controller.
2. Write 5EHto the Flash Control register to select the Flash Sector Protect register.
3. Read and/or write the Flash Sector Protect register which is now at Register File
address FF9H.
4. Write 00Hto the Flash Control register to return the Flash Controller to its reset state.
Flash Write Protection Option Bit
The Flash Write Protect option bit can be enabled to block all program and erase opera-
tions from user code. For more information, see Option Bits on page 191.
Byte Programming
When the Flash Controller is unlocked, writes to Flash Memory from user code will pro-
gram a byte into the Flash if the address is located in the unlocked page. An erased Flash
byte contains all ones (FFH). The programming operation can only be used to change bits
from one to zero. To change a Flash bit (or multiple bits) from zero to one requires a Page
Erase or Mass Erase operation.
Byte Programming can be accomplished using the eZ8 CPU’s LDC or LDCI instructions.
For a description of the LDC and LDCI instructions, refer to eZ8™ CPU Core User Man-
ual (UM0128).
PS019921-0308
Flash Memory
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
184
While the Flash Controller programs the Flash memory, the eZ8 CPU idles but the system
clock and on-chip peripherals continue to operate. Interrupts that occur when a Program-
ming operation is in progress are serviced once the Programming operation is complete.
To exit Programming mode and lock the Flash Controller, write 00Hto the Flash Control
register.
User code cannot program Flash Memory on a page that lies in a protected sector. When
user code writes memory locations, only addresses located in the unlocked page are pro-
grammed. Memory writes outside of the unlocked page are ignored.
Each memory location must not be programmed more than twice before an
erase occurs.
Caution:
Follow the steps below to program the Flash from user code:
1. Write 00Hto the Flash Control register to reset the Flash Controller.
2. Write the page of memory to be programmed to the Page Select register.
3. Write the first unlock command 73Hto the Flash Control register.
4. Write the second unlock command 8CHto the Flash Control register.
5. Re-write the page written in step 2 to the Page Select register.
6. Write Flash Memory using LDC or LDCI instructions to program the Flash.
7. Repeat step 6 to program additional memory locations on the same page.
8. Write 00Hto the Flash Control register to lock the Flash Controller.
Page Erase
The Flash memory can be erased one page (512 bytes) at a time. Page Erasing the Flash
memory sets all bytes in that page to the value FFH. The Page Select register identifies the
page to be erased. While the Flash Controller executes the Page Erase operation, the eZ8
CPU idles but the system clock and on-chip peripherals continue to operate. The eZ8 CPU
resumes operation after the Page Erase operation completes. Interrupts that occur when
the Page Erase operation is in progress are serviced once the Page Erase operation is com-
plete. When the Page Erase operation is complete, the Flash Controller returns to its
locked state. Only pages located in unprotected sectors can be erased.
Follow the steps below to perform a Page Erase operation:
1. Write 00Hto the Flash Control register to reset the Flash Controller.
2. Write the page to be erased to the Page Select register.
3. Write the first unlock command 73Hto the Flash Control register.
4. Write the second unlock command 8CHto the Flash Control register.
PS019921-0308
Flash Memory
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
185
5. Re-write the page written in step 2 to the Page Select register.
6. Write the Page Erase command 95Hto the Flash Control register.
Mass Erase
The Flash memory cannot be Mass Erased by user code.
Flash Controller Bypass
The Flash Controller can be bypassed and the control signals for the Flash memory
brought out to the GPIO pins. Bypassing the Flash Controller allows faster Programming
algorithms by controlling the Flash programming signals directly.
Flash Controller Bypass is recommended for gang programming applications and large
volume customers who do not require in-circuit programming of the Flash memory.
For more information on bypassing the Flash Controller, refer to Third-Party Flash Pro-
gramming Support for Z8 Encore! available for download at www.zilog.com.
Flash Controller Behavior in Debug Mode
The following changes in behavior of the Flash Controller occur when the Flash Control-
ler is accessed using the On-Chip Debugger:
•
•
•
The Flash Write Protect option bit is ignored.
The Flash Sector Protect register is ignored for programming and erase operations.
Programming operations are not limited to the page selected in the Page Select
register.
•
•
Bits in the Flash Sector Protect register can be written to one or zero.
The second write of the Page Select register to unlock the Flash Controller is not
necessary.
•
•
The Page Select register can be written when the Flash Controller is unlocked.
The Mass Erase command is enabled through the Flash Control register.
For security reasons, Flash controller allows only a single page to be opened for
write/erase. When writing multiple Flash pages, the Flash controller must go
through the unlock sequence again to select another page.
Caution:
PS019921-0308
Flash Memory
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
186
Flash Control Register Definitions
Flash Control Register
The Flash Control register (Table 92) unlocks the Flash Controller for programming and
erase operations, or to select the Flash Sector Protect register.
The Write-only Flash Control Register shares its Register File address with the Read-only
Flash Status Register.
Table 92. Flash Control Register (FCTL)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
FCMD
0
FIELD
RESET
R/W
W
FF8H
ADDR
FCMD—Flash Command
73H = First unlock command.
8CH = Second unlock command.
95H = Page erase command.
63H = Mass erase command
5EH = Flash Sector Protect register select.
* All other commands, or any command out of sequence, lock the Flash Controller.
Flash Status Register
The Flash Status register (Table 93) indicates the current state of the Flash Controller. This
register can be read at any time. The Read-only Flash Status Register shares its Register
File address with the Write-only Flash Control Register.
Table 93. Flash Status Register (FSTAT)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reserved
FSTAT
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
R
FF8H
ADDR
PS019921-0308
Flash Memory
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
187
Reserved
These bits are reserved and must be 0.
FSTAT—Flash Controller Status
00_0000 = Flash Controller locked
00_0001 = First unlock command received
00_0010 = Second unlock command received
00_0011 = Flash Controller unlocked
00_0100 = Flash Sector Protect register selected
00_1xxx = Program operation in progress
01_0xxx = Page erase operation in progress
10_0xxx = Mass erase operation in progress
Page Select Register
The Page Select (FPS) register (Table 94) selects one of the 128 available Flash memory
pages to be erased or programmed. Each Flash Page contains 512 bytes of Flash memory.
During a Page Erase operation, all Flash memory locations with the 7 most significant bits
of the address given by the PAGE field are erased to FFH.
The Page Select register shares its Register File address with the Flash Sector Protect Reg-
ister. The Page Select register cannot be accessed when the Flash Sector Protect register is
enabled.
Table 94. Page Select Register (FPS)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
INFO_EN
PAGE
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
R/W
FF9H
ADDR
INFO_EN—Information Area Enable
0 = Information Area is not selected.
1 = Information Area is selected. The Information area is mapped into the Flash Memory
address space at addresses FE00Hthrough FFFFH.
PAGE—Page Select
This 7-bit field selects the Flash memory page for Programming and Page Erase opera-
tions. Flash Memory Address[15:9] = PAGE[6:0].
PS019921-0308
Flash Memory
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
188
Flash Sector Protect Register
The Flash Sector Protect register (Table 95) protects Flash memory sectors from being
programmed or erased from user code. The Flash Sector Protect register shares its Regis-
ter File address with the Page Select register. The Flash Sector protect register can be
accessed only after writing the Flash Control register with 5EH.
User code can only write bits in this register to 1 (bits cannot be cleared to 0 by user code).
Table 95. Flash Sector Protect Register (FPROT)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
SECT7
SECT6
SECT5
SECT4
SECT3
SECT2
SECT1
SECT0
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
R/W1
FF9H
ADDR
Note: R/W1 = Register is accessible for Read operations. Register can be written to 1 only (via user code).
SECTn—Sector Protect
0 = Sector n can be programmed or erased from user code.
1 = Sector n is protected and cannot be programmed or erased from user code.
* User code can only write bits from 0 to 1.
Flash Frequency High and Low Byte Registers
The Flash Frequency High and Low Byte registers (Table 96 and Table 97) combine to
form a 16-bit value, FFREQ, to control timing for Flash program and erase operations.
The 16-bit Flash Frequency registers must be written with the system clock frequency in
kHz for Program and Erase operations. Calculate the Flash Frequency value using the fol-
lowing equation:
System Clock Frequency
-----------------------------------------------------------
FFREQ[15:0] = {FFREQH[7:0],FFREQL[7:0]} =
1000
Flash programming and erasure is not supported for system clock frequencies be-
low 20 kHz, above 20 MHz, or outside of the valid operating frequency range for
the device. The Flash Frequency High and Low Byte registers must be loaded
with the correct value to insure proper program and erase times.
Caution:
PS019921-0308
Flash Memory
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
189
Table 96. Flash Frequency High Byte Register (FFREQH)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
2
1
1
0
0
FFREQH
0
FIELD
RESET
R/W
R/W
FFAH
ADDR
Table 97. Flash Frequency Low Byte Register (FFREQL)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
FFREQL
0
FIELD
RESET
R/W
R/W
FFBH
ADDR
FFREQH and FFREQL—Flash Frequency High and Low Bytes
These 2 bytes, {FFREQH[7:0], FFREQL[7:0]}, contain the 16-bit Flash Frequency value.
PS019921-0308
Flash Memory
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
190
PS019921-0308
Flash Memory
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
191
Option Bits
Option Bits allow user configuration of certain aspects of the Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX
Series operation. The feature configuration data is stored in the Flash Memory and read
during Reset. The features available for control via the Option Bits are:
•
•
•
•
Watchdog Timer time-out response selection–interrupt or Reset.
Watchdog Timer enabled at Reset.
The ability to prevent unwanted read access to user code in Flash Memory.
The ability to prevent accidental programming and erasure of the user code in Flash
Memory.
•
•
Voltage Brownout configuration-always enabled or disabled during STOP mode to
reduce STOP mode power consumption.
Oscillator mode selection-for high, medium, and low power crystal oscillators, or
external RC oscillator.
Operation
Option Bit Configuration By Reset
Each time the Option Bits are programmed or erased, the device must be Reset for the
change to take place. During any reset operation (System Reset, Reset, or Stop Mode
Recovery), the Option Bits are automatically read from the Flash Memory and written to
Option Configuration registers. The Option Configuration registers control operation of
the devices within the Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series. Option Bit control is established
before the device exits Reset and the eZ8 CPU begins code execution. The Option Config-
uration registers are not part of the Register File and are not accessible for read or write
access.
Option Bit Address Space
The first two bytes of Flash Memory at addresses 0000H(see Table 98 on page 192) and
0001H(see Table 99 on page 193) are reserved for the user Option Bits. The byte at Flash
Memory address 0000Hconfigures user options. The byte at Flash Memory address
0001His reserved for future use and must remain unprogrammed.
PS019921-0308
Option Bits
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
192
Flash Memory Address 0000H
Table 98. Flash Option Bits At Flash Memory Address 0000H
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
WDT_RE WDT_AO
S
OSC_SEL[1:0]
VBO_AO
RP
Reserved
FWP
FIELD
RESET
R/W
U
R/W
Program Memory 0000H
ADDR
Note: U = Unchanged by Reset. R/W = Read/Write.
WDT_RES—Watchdog Timer Reset
0 = Watchdog Timer time-out generates an interrupt request. Interrupts must be globally
enabled for the eZ8 CPU to acknowledge the interrupt request.
1 = Watchdog Timer time-out causes a Short Reset. This setting is the default for unpro-
grammed (erased) Flash.
WDT_AO—Watchdog Timer Always On
0 = Watchdog Timer is automatically enabled upon application of system power. Watch-
dog Timer can not be disabled except during STOP Mode (if configured to power down
during STOP mode).
1 = Watchdog Timer is enabled upon execution of the WDT instruction. Once enabled, the
Watchdog Timer can only be disabled by a Reset or Stop Mode Recovery. This setting is
the default for unprogrammed (erased) Flash.
OSC_SEL[1:0]—Oscillator Mode Selection
00 = On-chip oscillator configured for use with external RC networks (<4 MHz).
01 = Minimum power for use with very low frequency crystals (32 kHz to 1.0 MHz).
10 = Medium power for use with medium frequency crystals or ceramic resonators
(0.5 MHz to 10.0 MHz).
11 = Maximum power for use with high frequency crystals (8.0 MHz to 20.0 MHz). This
setting is the default for unprogrammed (erased) Flash.
VBO_AO—Voltage Brownout Protection Always On
0 = Voltage Brownout Protection is disabled in STOP mode to reduce total power
consumption.
1 = Voltage Brownout Protection is always enabled including during STOP mode.
This setting is the default for unprogrammed (erased) Flash.
RP—Read Protect
0 = User program code is inaccessible. Limited control features are available through
PS019921-0308
Option Bits
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
193
the On-Chip Debugger.
1 = User program code is accessible. All On-Chip Debugger commands are enabled. This
setting is the default for unprogrammed (erased) Flash.
Reserved
These Option Bits are reserved for future use and must always be 1.This setting is the
default for unprogrammed (erased) Flash.
FWP—Flash Write Protect (Flash version only)
FWP Description
0
Programming, Page Erase, and Mass Erase through User Code is disabled.
Mass Erase is available through the On-Chip Debugger.
1
Programming, and Page Erase are enabled for all of Flash Program Memory.
Flash Memory Address 0001H
Table 99. Options Bits at Flash Memory Address 0001H
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reserved
U
FIELD
RESET
R/W
R/W
Program Memory 0001H
ADDR
Note: U = Unchanged by Reset. R = Read-Only. R/W = Read/Write.
Reserved
These Option Bits are reserved for future use and must always be 1. This setting is the
default for unprogrammed (erased) Flash.
PS019921-0308
Option Bits
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
194
PS019921-0308
Option Bits
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
195
On-Chip Debugger
The Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series products contain an integrated On-Chip Debugger
(OCD) that provides advanced debugging features including:
•
•
•
•
Reading and writing of the Register File
Reading and writing of Program and Data Memory
Setting of Breakpoints
Execution of eZ8 CPU instructions
Architecture
The On-Chip Debugger consists of four primary functional blocks: transmitter, receiver,
auto-baud generator, and debug controller. Figure 35 displays the architecture of the
On-Chip Debugger.
eZ8TM CPU
Control
System
Clock
Auto-Baud
Detector/Generator
Transmitter
Receiver
Debug Controller
DBG
Pin
Figure 35. On-Chip Debugger Block Diagram
Operation
OCD Interface
The On-Chip Debugger uses the DBG pin for communication with an external host. This
one-pin interface is a bi-directional open-drain interface that transmits and receives data.
Data transmission is half-duplex, in that transmit and receive cannot occur simultaneously.
PS019921-0308
On-Chip Debugger
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
196
The serial data on the DBG pin is sent using the standard asynchronous data format
defined in RS-232. This pin can interface the Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series products to
the serial port of a host PC using minimal external hardware.Two different methods for
connecting the DBG pin to an RS-232 interface are depicted in Figure 36 and Figure 37 on
page 196.
Caution: For operation of the On-Chip Debugger, all power pins (VDD and AVDD) must
be supplied with power, and all ground pins (VSS and AVSS) must be properly
grounded. The DBG pin is open-drain and must always be connected to VDD
through an external pull-up resistor to ensure proper operation.
V
DD
RS-232
10 kΩ
Transceiver
Diode
RS-232 TX
RS-232 RX
DBG Pin
Figure 36. Interfacing the On-Chip Debugger’s DBG Pin with an RS-232 Interface (1)
V
DD
RS-232
10 kΩ
Transceiver
Open-Drain
Buffer
RS-232 TX
RS-232 RX
DBG Pin
Figure 37. Interfacing the On-Chip Debugger’s DBG Pin with an RS-232 Interface (2)
PS019921-0308
On-Chip Debugger
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
197
DEBUG Mode
The operating characteristics of the Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series devices in DEBUG
mode are:
•
The eZ8 CPU fetch unit stops, idling the eZ8 CPU, unless directed by the OCD to
execute specific instructions.
•
•
•
•
The system clock operates unless in STOP mode.
All enabled on-chip peripherals operate unless in STOP mode.
Automatically exits HALT mode.
Constantly refreshes the Watchdog Timer, if enabled.
Entering DEBUG Mode
The device enters DEBUG mode following any of the following operations:
•
•
•
Writing the DBGMODEbit in the OCD Control Register to 1 using the OCD interface.
eZ8 CPU execution of a BRK (Breakpoint) instruction (when enabled).
If the DBG pin is Low when the device exits Reset, the On-Chip Debugger
automatically puts the device into DEBUG mode.
Exiting DEBUG Mode
The device exits DEBUG mode following any of the following operations:
•
•
•
•
•
Clearing the DBGMODEbit in the OCD Control Register to 0.
Power-On Reset
Voltage Brownout reset
Asserting the RESET pin Low to initiate a Reset.
Driving the DBG pin Low while the device is in STOP mode initiates a system reset.
OCD Data Format
The OCD interface uses the asynchronous data format defined for RS-232. Each character
is transmitted as 1 Start bit, 8 data bits (least-significant bit first), and 1 Stop bit
(see Figure 38).
START
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
STOP
Figure 38. OCD Data Format
PS019921-0308
On-Chip Debugger
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
198
OCD Auto-Baud Detector/Generator
To run over a range of baud rates (bits per second) with various system clock frequencies,
the On-Chip Debugger has an Auto-Baud Detector/Generator. After a reset, the OCD is
idle until it receives data. The OCD requires that the first character sent from the host is
the character 80H. The character 80Hhas eight continuous bits Low (one Start bit plus 7
data bits). The Auto-Baud Detector measures this period and sets the OCD Baud Rate
Generator accordingly.
The Auto-Baud Detector/Generator is clocked by the system clock. The minimum baud
rate is the system clock frequency divided by 512. For optimal operation, the maximum
recommended baud rate is the system clock frequency divided by 8. The theoretical maxi-
mum baud rate is the system clock frequency divided by 4. This theoretical maximum is
possible for low noise designs with clean signals. Table 100 lists minimum and recom-
mended maximum baud rates for sample crystal frequencies.
Table 100. OCD Baud-Rate Limits
System Clock
Recommended Maximum Baud
Rate (kbits/s)
Minimum Baud Rate
(kbits/s)
Frequency (MHz)
20.0
2500
125.0
4.096
39.1
1.96
0.064
1.0
0.032768 (32 kHz)
If the OCD receives a Serial Break (nine or more continuous bits Low) the Auto-Baud
Detector/Generator resets. The Auto-Baud Detector/Generator can then be reconfigured
by sending 80H.
OCD Serial Errors
The On-Chip Debugger can detect any of the following error conditions on the DBG pin:
•
•
•
Serial Break (a minimum of nine continuous bits Low).
Framing Error (received Stop bit is Low).
Transmit Collision (OCD and host simultaneous transmission detected by the OCD).
When the OCD detects one of these errors, it aborts any command currently in progress,
transmits a Serial Break 4096 system clock cycles long back to the host, and resets the
Auto-Baud Detector/Generator. A Framing Error or Transmit Collision may be caused by
the host sending a Serial Break to the OCD. Because of the open-drain nature of the
interface, returning a Serial Break break back to the host only extends the length of the
Serial Break if the host releases the Serial Break early.
PS019921-0308
On-Chip Debugger
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
199
The host transmits a Serial Break on the DBG pin when first connecting to the Z8 Encore!
XP® F64XX Series devices or when recovering from an error. A Serial Break from the
host resets the Auto-Baud Generator/Detector but does not reset the OCD Control register.
A Serial Break leaves the device in DEBUG mode if that is the current mode. The OCD is
held in Reset until the end of the Serial Break when the DBG pin returns High. Because of
the open-drain nature of the DBG pin, the host can send a Serial Break to the OCD even if
the OCD is transmitting a character.
Breakpoints
Execution Breakpoints are generated using the BRK instruction (opcode 00H). When the
eZ8 CPU decodes a BRK instruction, it signals the On-Chip Debugger. If Breakpoints are
enabled, the OCD idles the eZ8 CPU and enters DEBUG mode. If Breakpoints are not
enabled, the OCD ignores the BRK signal and the BRK instruction operates as an NOP.
If breakpoints are enabled, the OCD can be configured to automatically enter DEBUG
mode, or to loop on the break instruction. If the OCD is configured to loop on the BRK
instruction, then the CPU is still enabled to service DMA and interrupt requests.
The loop on BRK instruction can be used to service interrupts in the background. For
interrupts to be serviced in the background, there cannot be any breakpoints in the inter-
rupt service routine. Otherwise, the CPU stops on the breakpoint in the interrupt routine.
For interrupts to be serviced in the background, interrupts must also be enabled. Debug-
ging software should not automatically enable interrupts when using this feature, since
interrupts are typically disabled during critical sections of code where interrupts should
not occur (such as adjusting the stack pointer or modifying shared data).
Software can poll the IDLE bit of the OCDSTAT register to determine if the OCD is loop-
ing on a BRK instruction. When software wants to stop the CPU on the BRK instruction it
is looping on, software should not set the DBGMODE bit of the OCDCTL register. The
CPU may have vectored to and be in the middle of an interrupt service routine when this
bit gets set. Instead, software must clear the BRKLP bit. This action allows the CPU to
finish the interrupt service routine it may be in and return the BRK instruction. When the
CPU returns to the BRK instruction it was previously looping on, it automatically sets the
DBGMODE bit and enter DEBUG mode.
Software detects that the majority of the OCD commands are still disabled when the
eZ8TM CPU is looping on a BRK instruction. The eZ8 CPU must be stopped and the part
must be in DEBUG mode before these commands can be issued.
Breakpoints in Flash Memory
The BRK instruction is opcode 00H, which corresponds to the fully programmed state of a
byte in Flash memory. To implement a Breakpoint, write 00Hto the desired address, over-
writing the current instruction. To remove a Breakpoint, the corresponding page of Flash
memory must be erased and reprogrammed with the original data.
PS019921-0308
On-Chip Debugger
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
200
On-Chip Debugger Commands
The host communicates to the On-Chip Debugger by sending OCD commands using the
DBG interface. During normal operation, only a subset of the OCD commands are avail-
able. In DEBUG mode, all OCD commands become available unless the user code and
control registers are protected by programming the Read Protect Option Bit (RP). The
Read Protect Option Bit prevents the code in memory from being read out of the Z8
Encore! XP® F64XX Series products. When this option is enabled, several of the OCD
commands are disabled. Table 101 contains a summary of the On-Chip Debugger com-
mands. Each OCD command is described in detail in the bulleted list following Table 101.
Table 101 indicates those commands that operate when the device is not in DEBUG mode
(normal operation) and those commands that are disabled by programming the Read Pro-
tect Option Bit.
Table 101. On-Chip Debugger Commands
Enabled when
NOT in DEBUG
mode?
Command
Byte
Disabled by
Debug Command
Read Protect Option Bit
Read OCD Revision
00H
02H
Yes
Yes
-
-
Read OCD Status
Register
Read Runtime Counter
03H
04H
-
-
Write OCD Control
Register
Yes
Cannot clear DBGMODEbit
Read OCD Control
Register
05H
Yes
-
Write Program Counter
Read Program Counter
Write Register
06H
07H
08H
-
-
-
Disabled
Disabled
Only writes of the Flash Memory Control
registers are allowed. Additionally, only
the Mass Erase command is allowed to
be written to the Flash Control register.
Read Register
09H
0AH
0BH
0CH
0DH
-
-
-
-
-
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Write Program Memory
Read Program Memory
Write Data Memory
Read Data Memory
PS019921-0308
On-Chip Debugger
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
201
Table 101. On-Chip Debugger Commands (Continued)
Enabled when
Command
Byte
NOT in DEBUG
mode?
Disabled by
Debug Command
Read Protect Option Bit
Read Program Memory
CRC
0EH
-
-
Reserved
0FH
10H
-
-
-
-
-
-
Step Instruction
Stuff Instruction
Execute Instruction
Reserved
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
-
11H
12H
13H - FFH
In the following list of OCD Commands, data and commands sent from the host to the On-
Chip Debugger are identified by ‘DBG ← Command/Data’. Data sent from the On-Chip
Debugger back to the host is identified by ‘DBG → Data’
•
Read OCD Revision (00H)—The Read OCD Revision command determines the
version of the On-Chip Debugger. If OCD commands are added, removed, or
changed, this revision number changes.
DBG ← 00H
DBG → OCDREV[15:8] (Major revision number)
DBG → OCDREV[7:0] (Minor revision number)
•
•
Read OCD Status Register (02H)—The Read OCD Status Register command reads
the OCDSTAT register.
DBG ← 02H
DBG → OCDSTAT[7:0]
Write OCD Control Register (04H)—The Write OCD Control Register command
writes the data that follows to the OCDCTL register. When the Read Protect Option
Bit is enabled, the DBGMODEbit (OCDCTL[7]) can only be set to 1, it cannot be
cleared to 0 and the only method of putting the device back into normal operating
mode is to reset the device.
DBG ← 04H
DBG ← OCDCTL[7:0]
•
•
Read OCD Control Register (05H)—The Read OCD Control Register command
reads the value of the OCDCTL register.
DBG ← 05H
DBG → OCDCTL[7:0]
Write Program Counter (06H)—The Write Program Counter command writes the
data that follows to the eZ8 CPU’s Program Counter (PC). If the device is not in
PS019921-0308
On-Chip Debugger
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
202
DEBUG mode or if the Read Protect Option Bit is enabled, the Program Counter (PC)
values are discarded.
DBG ← 06H
DBG ← ProgramCounter[15:8]
DBG ← ProgramCounter[7:0]
•
•
Read Program Counter (07H)—The Read Program Counter command reads the
value in the eZ8 CPU’s Program Counter (PC). If the device is not in DEBUG mode
or if the Read Protect Option Bit is enabled, this command returns FFFFH.
DBG ← 07H
DBG → ProgramCounter[15:8]
DBG → ProgramCounter[7:0]
Write Register (08H)—The Write Register command writes data to the Register File.
Data can be written 1-256 bytes at a time (256 bytes can be written by setting size to
zero). If the device is not in DEBUG mode, the address and data values are discarded.
If the Read Protect Option Bit is enabled, then only writes to the Flash Control
Registers are allowed and all other register write data values are discarded.
DBG ← 08H
DBG ← {4’h0,Register Address[11:8]}
DBG ← Register Address[7:0]
DBG ← Size[7:0]
DBG ← 1-256 data bytes
•
•
Read Register (09H)—The Read Register command reads data from the Register
File. Data can be read 1-256 bytes at a time (256 bytes can be read by setting size to
zero). If the device is not in DEBUG mode or if the Read Protect Option Bit is
enabled, this command returns FFHfor all the data values.
DBG ← 09H
DBG ← {4’h0,Register Address[11:8]
DBG ← Register Address[7:0]
DBG ← Size[7:0]
DBG → 1-256 data bytes
Write Program Memory (0AH)—The Write Program Memory command writes data
to Program Memory. This command is equivalent to the LDC and LDCI instructions.
Data can be written 1-65536 bytes at a time (65536 bytes can be written by setting size
to zero). The on-chip Flash Controller must be written to and unlocked for the
programming operation to occur. If the Flash Controller is not unlocked, the data is
discarded. If the device is not in DEBUG mode or if the Read Protect Option Bit is
enabled, the data is discarded.
DBG ← 0AH
DBG ← Program Memory Address[15:8]
DBG ← Program Memory Address[7:0]
DBG ← Size[15:8]
DBG ← Size[7:0]
DBG ← 1-65536 data bytes
PS019921-0308
On-Chip Debugger
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
203
•
•
Read Program Memory (0BH)—The Read Program Memory command reads data
from Program Memory. This command is equivalent to the LDC and LDCI
instructions. Data can be read 1-65536 bytes at a time (65536 bytes can be read by
setting size to zero). If the device is not in DEBUG mode or if the Read Protect Option
Bit is enabled, this command returns FFHfor the data.
DBG ← 0BH
DBG ← Program Memory Address[15:8]
DBG ← Program Memory Address[7:0]
DBG ← Size[15:8]
DBG ← Size[7:0]
DBG → 1-65536 data bytes
Write Data Memory (0CH)—The Write Data Memory command writes data to Data
Memory. This command is equivalent to the LDE and LDEI instructions. Data can be
written 1-65536 bytes at a time (65536 bytes can be written by setting size to zero). If
the device is not in DEBUG mode or if the Read Protect Option Bit is enabled, the
data is discarded.
DBG ← 0CH
DBG ← Data Memory Address[15:8]
DBG ← Data Memory Address[7:0]
DBG ← Size[15:8]
DBG ← Size[7:0]
DBG ← 1-65536 data bytes
•
•
Read Data Memory (0DH)—The Read Data Memory command reads from Data
Memory. This command is equivalent to the LDE and LDEI instructions. Data can be
read 1-65536 bytes at a time (65536 bytes can be read by setting size to zero). If the
device is not in DEBUG mode, this command returns FFHfor the data.
DBG ← 0DH
DBG ← Data Memory Address[15:8]
DBG ← Data Memory Address[7:0]
DBG ← Size[15:8]
DBG ← Size[7:0]
DBG → 1-65536 data bytes
Read Program Memory CRC (0EH)—The Read Program Memory CRC command
computes and returns the CRC (cyclic redundancy check) of Program Memory using
the 16-bit CRC-CCITT polynomial. If the device is not in DEBUG mode, this
command returns FFFFHfor the CRC value. Unlike most other OCD Read
commands, there is a delay from issuing of the command until the OCD returns the
data. The OCD reads the Program Memory, calculates the CRC value, and returns the
result. The delay is a function of the Program Memory size and is approximately equal
to the system clock period multiplied by the number of bytes in the Program Memory.
DBG ← 0EH
DBG → CRC[15:8]
DBG → CRC[7:0]
PS019921-0308
On-Chip Debugger
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
204
•
•
Step Instruction (10H)—The Step Instruction command steps one assembly
instruction at the current Program Counter (PC) location. If the device is not in
DEBUG mode or the Read Protect Option Bit is enabled, the OCD ignores this
command.
DBG ← 10H
Stuff Instruction (11H)—The Stuff Instruction command steps one assembly
instruction and allows specification of the first byte of the instruction. The remaining
0-4 bytes of the instruction are read from Program Memory. This command is useful
for stepping over instructions where the first byte of the instruction has been
overwritten by a Breakpoint. If the device is not in DEBUG mode or the Read Protect
Option Bit is enabled, the OCD ignores this command.
DBG ← 11H
DBG ← opcode[7:0]
•
Execute Instruction (12H)—The Execute Instruction command allows sending an
entire instruction to be executed to the eZ8 CPU. This command can also step over
Breakpoints. The number of bytes to send for the instruction depends on the opcode. If
the device is not in DEBUG mode or the Read Protect Option Bit is enabled, the OCD
ignores this command
DBG ← 12H
DBG ← 1-5 byte opcode
PS019921-0308
On-Chip Debugger
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
205
On-Chip Debugger Control Register Definitions
OCD Control Register
The OCD Control register (Table 102) controls the state of the On-Chip Debugger. This
register enters or exits DEBUG mode and enables the BRK instruction.
A ‘reset and stop’ function can be achieved by writing 81Hto this register. A ‘reset and
go’ function can be achieved by writing 41Hto this register. If the device is in DEBUG
mode, a ‘run’ function can be implemented by writing 40Hto this register.
Table 102. OCD Control Register (OCDCTL)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DBGMODE BRKEN DBGACK BRKLOOP
Reserved
RST
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
R/W
R
R/W
DBGMODE—DEBUG Mode
Setting this bit to 1 causes the device to enter DEBUG mode. When in DEBUG mode, the
eZ8 CPU stops fetching new instructions. Clearing this bit causes the eZ8 CPU to start
running again. This bit is automatically set when a BRK instruction is decoded and Break-
points are enabled. If the Read Protect Option Bit is enabled, this bit can only be cleared
by resetting the device, it cannot be written to 0.
0 = TheZ8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series device is operating in NORMAL mode.
1 = The Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series device is in DEBUG mode.
BRKEN—Breakpoint Enable
This bit controls the behavior of the BRK instruction (opcode 00H). By default, Break-
points are disabled and the BRK instruction behaves like a NOP. If this bit is set to 1 and a
BRK instruction is decoded, the OCD takes action dependent upon the BRKLOOP bit.
0 = BRK instruction is disabled.
1 = BRK instruction is enabled.
DBGACK—Debug Acknowledge
This bit enables the debug acknowledge feature. If this bit is set to 1, then the OCD sends
an Debug Acknowledge character (FFH) to the host when a Breakpoint occurs.
0 = Debug Acknowledge is disabled.
1 = Debug Acknowledge is enabled.
BRKLOOP—Breakpoint Loop
This bit determines what action the OCD takes when a BRK instruction is decoded if
breakpoints are enabled (BRKEN is 1). If this bit is 0, then the DBGMODE bit is automat-
ically set to 1 and the OCD entered DEBUG mode. If BRKLOOP is set to 1, then the
eZ8 CPU loops on the BRK instruction.
PS019921-0308
On-Chip Debugger
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
206
0 = BRK instruction sets DBGMODE to 1.
1 = eZ8 CPU loops on BRK instruction.
Reserved
These bits are reserved and must be 0.
RST—Reset
Setting this bit to 1 resets the Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series devices. The devices go
through a normal Power-On Reset sequence with the exception that the On-Chip Debug-
ger is not reset. This bit is automatically cleared to 0 when the reset finishes.
0 = No effect
1 = Reset the Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series device
OCD Status Register
The OCD Status register (Table 103) reports status information about the current state of
the debugger and the system.
Table 103. OCD Status Register (OCDSTAT)
BITS
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
IDLE
HALT
RPEN
Reserved
FIELD
RESET
R/W
0
R
IDLE—CPU idling
This bit is set if the part is in DEBUG mode (DBGMODE is 1), or if a BRK instruction
occurred since the last time OCDCTL was written. This can be used to determine if the
CPU is running or if it is idling.
0 = The eZ8 CPU is running.
1 = The eZ8 CPU is either stopped or looping on a BRK instruction.
HALT—HALT Mode
0 = The device is not in HALT mode.
1 = The device is in HALT mode.
RPEN—Read Protect Option Bit Enabled
0 = The Read Protect Option Bit is disabled (1).
1 = The Read Protect Option Bit is enabled (0), disabling many OCD commands.
Reserved
These bits are always 0.
PS019921-0308
On-Chip Debugger
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
207
On-Chip Oscillator
The products in the Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series feature an on-chip oscillator for use
with external crystals with frequencies from 32 kHz to 20 MHz. In addition, the oscillator
can support external RC networks with oscillation frequencies up to 4 MHz or ceramic
resonators with oscillation frequencies up to 20 MHz. This oscillator generates the pri-
mary system clock for the internal eZ8™ CPU and the majority of the on-chip peripherals.
Alternatively, the XIN input pin can also accept a CMOS-level clock input signal (32 kHz–
20 MHz). If an external clock generator is used, the XOUT pin must be left unconnected.
When configured for use with crystal oscillators or external clock drivers, the frequency of
the signal on the XIN input pin determines the frequency of the system clock (that is, no
internal clock divider). In RC operation, the system clock is driven by a clock divider
(divide by 2) to ensure 50% duty cycle.
Operating Modes
The Z8 Encore! XP F64XX Series products support four different oscillator modes:
•
•
•
On-chip oscillator configured for use with external RC networks (<4 MHz).
Minimum power for use with very low frequency crystals (32 kHz to 1.0 MHz).
Medium power for use with medium frequency crystals or ceramic resonators
(0.5 MHz to 10.0 MHz).
•
Maximum power for use with high frequency crystals or ceramic resonators
(8.0 MHz to 20.0 MHz).
The oscillator mode is selected through user-programmable Option Bits. For more infor-
mation, see Option Bits on page 191.
Crystal Oscillator Operation
Figure 39 on page 208 displays a recommended configuration for connection with an
external fundamental-mode, parallel-resonant crystal operating at 20 MHz. Recommended
20 MHz crystal specifications are provided in Table 104 on page 208. Resistor R1 is
optional and limits total power dissipation by the crystal. The printed circuit board layout
must add no more than 4 pF of stray capacitance to either the XIN or XOUT pins. If oscilla-
tion does not occur, reduce the values of capacitors C1 and C2 to decrease loading.
PS019921-0308
On-Chip Oscillator
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
208
On-Chip Oscillator
XIN
XOUT
R1 = 220
Ω
Crystal
C1 = 22 pF
C2 = 22 pF
Figure 39. Recommended 20 MHz Crystal Oscillator Configuration
Table 104. Recommended Crystal Oscillator Specifications (20 MHz Operation)
Parameter
Frequency
Resonance
Mode
Value
Units
Comments
20
MHz
Parallel
Fundamental
Series Resistance (R )
25
20
7
Ω
pF
Maximum
Maximum
Maximum
Maximum
S
Load Capacitance (C )
L
Shunt Capacitance (C )
pF
0
Drive Level
1
mW
PS019921-0308
On-Chip Oscillator
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
209
Oscillator Operation with an External RC Network
The External RC oscillator mode is applicable to timing insensitive applications.
Figure 40 displays a recommended configuration for connection with an external resistor-
capacitor (RC) network.
V
DD
R
C
X
IN
Figure 40. Connecting the On-Chip Oscillator to an External RC Network
An external resistance value of 45 kΩ is recommended for oscillator operation with an
external RC network. The minimum resistance value to ensure operation is 40 kΩ. The
typical oscillator frequency can be estimated from the values of the resistor (R in kΩ) and
capacitor (C in pF) elements using the following equation:
6
1×10
--------------------------------------------------------
Oscillator Frequency (kHz) =
(0.4 × R × C) + (4 × C)
Figure 41 displays the typical (3.3 V and 25 °C) oscillator frequency as a function of the
capacitor (C in pF) employed in the RC network assuming a 45 kΩ external resistor. For
very small values of C, the parasitic capacitance of the oscillator XIN pin and the printed
circuit board should be included in the estimation of the oscillator frequency.
It is possible to operate the RC oscillator using only the parasitic capacitance of the pack-
age and printed circuit board. To minimize sensitivity to external parasitics, external
capacitance values in excess of 20 pF are recommended.
PS019921-0308
On-Chip Oscillator
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
210
4000
3750
3500
3250
3000
2750
2500
2250
2000
1750
1500
1250
1000
750
500
250
0
0
20 40 60 80 100 120 140 160 180 200 220 240 260 280 300 320 340 360 380 400 420 440 460 480 500
C (pF)
Figure 41. Typical RC Oscillator Frequency as a Function of the External Capacitance with
a 45 kΩ Resistor
Caution: When using the external RC oscillator mode, the oscillator may stop oscillat-
ing if the power supply drops below 2.7 V, but before the power supply drops to
the voltage brown-out threshold. The oscillator will resume oscillation as soon
as the supply voltage exceeds 2.7 V.
PS019921-0308
On-Chip Oscillator
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
211
Electrical Characteristics
Absolute Maximum Ratings
Stresses greater than those listed in Table 105 may cause permanent damage to the device.
These ratings are stress ratings only. Operation of the device at any condition outside those
indicated in the operational sections of these specifications is not implied. Exposure to
absolute maximum rating conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability.
For improved reliability, unused inputs must be tied to one of the supply voltages (VDD or
VSS).
Table 105. Absolute Maximum Ratings
Parameter
Minimum Maximum Units
Notes
Ambient temperature under bias
Storage temperature
-40
-65
-0.3
-0.3
-5
+125
+150
+5.5
+3.6
+5
C
C
Voltage on any pin with respect to V
V
1
SS
Voltage on V pin with respect to V
V
DD
SS
Maximum current on input and/or inactive output pin
Maximum output current from active output pin
80-Pin QFP Maximum Ratings at –40 °C to 70 °C
Total power dissipation
µA
mA
-25
+25
550
150
mW
mA
Maximum current into V or out of V
DD
SS
80-Pin QFP Maximum Ratings at 70 °C to 125 °C
Total power dissipation
200
56
mW
mA
Maximum current into V or out of V
DD
SS
68-Pin PLCC Maximum Ratings at –40 °C to 70 °C
Total power dissipation
1000
275
mW
mA
Maximum current into V or out of V
DD
SS
68-Pin PLCC Maximum Ratings at
7
0 °C to 125 °C
Total power dissipation
500
140
mW
mA
Maximum current into V or out of V
DD
SS
64-Pin LQFP Maximum Ratings at –40 °C to 70 °C
Total power dissipation
1000
mW
PS019921-0308
Electrical Characteristics
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
212
Table 105. Absolute Maximum Ratings (Continued)
Parameter
Minimum Maximum Units
Notes
Maximum current into V or out of V
275
mA
DD
SS
64-Pin LQFP Maximum Ratings at 70 °C to 125 °C
Total power dissipation
540
150
mW
mA
Maximum current into V or out of V
DD
SS
44-Pin PLCC Maximum Ratings at –40 °C to 70 °C
Total power dissipation
750
200
mW
mA
Maximum current into V or out of V
DD
SS
44-Pin PLCC Maximum Ratings at 70 °C to 125 °C
Total power dissipation
295
83
mW
mA
Maximum current into V or out of V
DD
SS
44-Pin LQFP Maximum Ratings at –40 °C to 70 °C
Total power dissipation
750
200
mW
mA
Maximum current into V or out of V
DD
SS
44-Pin LQFP Maximum Ratings at 70 °C to 125 °C
Total power dissipation
360
100
mW
mA
Maximum current into V or out of V
DD
SS
Note: This voltage applies to all pins except the following: VDD, AVDD, pins supporting analog input (Ports B and H),
RESET, and where noted otherwise.
PS019921-0308
Electrical Characteristics
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
213
DC Characteristics
Table 106 lists the DC characteristics of the Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series products. All
voltages are referenced to VSS, the primary system ground.
Table 106. DC Characteristics
T = –40 °C to 125 °C
A
Symbol Parameter
Minimum Typical Maximum Units Conditions
V
V
Supply Voltage
3.0
–
–
3.6
V
V
DD
IL1
Low Level Input Voltage
-0.3
0.3*V
For all input pins except
RESET, DBG, XIN
DD
V
V
Low Level Input Voltage
-0.3
–
–
0.2*V
5.5
V
V
For RESET, DBG, and XIN.
IL2
DD
High Level Input Voltage 0.7*V
Port A, C, D, E, F, and G
pins.
IH1
DD
V
V
V
High Level Input Voltage 0.7*V
High Level Input Voltage 0.8*V
–
–
–
V
V
+0.3
+0.3
V
V
V
Port B and H pins.
IH2
IH3
OL1
DD
DD
DD
RESET, DBG, and XIN pins
DD
Low Level Output
–
2.4
–
0.4
I
= 2 mA; VDD = 3.0 V
OL
Voltage Standard Drive
High Output Drive disabled.
I = -2 mA; VDD = 3.0 V
OH
V
V
High Level Output
–
–
–
V
V
OH1
OL2
Voltage Standard Drive
High Output Drive disabled.
= 20 mA; VDD = 3.3 V
Low Level Output
Voltage High Drive
0.6
I
OL
High Output Drive enabled
T = -40 °C to +70 °C
A
V
V
V
V
High Level Output
Voltage
2.4
–
–
–
–
–
0.6
–
V
V
V
I
= -20 mA; VDD = 3.3 V
OH
OH2
OL3
OH3
RAM
High Output Drive enabled;
T = -40 °C to +70 °C
High Drive
A
Low Level Output
Voltage
I
= 15 mA; VDD = 3.3 V
OL
High Output Drive enabled;
T = +70 °C to +105 °C
High Drive
A
High Level Output
Voltage
2.4
I
= 15 mA; VDD = 3.3 V
OH
High Output Drive enabled;
T = +70 °C to +105 °C
High Drive
A
RAM Data Retention
Input Leakage Current
0.7
-5
–
–
–
V
I
+5
µA
V
V
= 3.6 V;
DD
IN
IL
1
= VDD or VSS
I
Tri-State Leakage
Current
-5
–
+5
µA
V
= 3.6 V
DD
TL
PS019921-0308
Electrical Characteristics
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
214
Table 106. DC Characteristics (Continued)
T = –40 °C to 125 °C
A
Symbol Parameter
Minimum Typical Maximum Units Conditions
2
C
GPIO Port Pad
Capacitance
–
8.0
–
pF
PAD
2
2
C
C
XIN Pad Capacitance
XOUT Pad Capacitance
Weak Pull-up Current
–
–
8.0
9.5
–
–
pF
pF
XIN
XOUT
I
I
30
–
100
11
350
mA V = 3.0 - 3.6 V
DD
PU
Active Mode Supply
Current
16
12
mA V = 3.6 V, Fsysclk = 20
DDA
DD
MHz
(See Figure 42 on
page 216 and Figure 43
on page 217) GPIO pins
configured as outputs
V
= 3.3 V
DD
–
–
9
4
3
11
9
mA V = 3.6 V, Fsysclk = 10
DD
MHz
DD
V
= 3.3 V
I
HALT Mode Supply
Current
7
5
mA V = 3.6 V, Fsysclk = 20
DDH
DD
MHz
(See Figure 44 on
page 218 and Figure 45
on page 219) GPIO pins
configured as outputs
V
= 3.3 V
DD
5
4
mA V = 3.6 V, Fsysclk = 10
DD
MHz
DD
V
= 3.3 V
PS019921-0308
Electrical Characteristics
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
215
Table 106. DC Characteristics (Continued)
T = –40 °C to 125 °C
A
Symbol Parameter
Minimum Typical Maximum Units Conditions
I
Stop Mode Supply
Current
–
520
700
µA
V
= 3.6 V, VBO and WDT
DD
DDS
Enabled
(See Figure 46 and
Figure 47) GPIO pins
configured as outputs
650
25
V
V
= 3.3 V
DD
–
10
µA
= 3.6 V, T = 0 to 70 ºC
DD
A
VBO
Disabled
20
WDT
Enabled
V
V
= 3.3 V
DD
DD
–
–
80
70
µA
µA
= 3.6 V, T = –40 to
A
+105 ºC
Disabled
Enabled
VBO
WDT
V
V
= 3.3 V
DD
250
150
= 3.6 V, T = –40 to
A
DD
+125 ºC
Disabled
Enabled
VBO
WDT
V
= 3.3 V
DD
1This condition excludes all pins that have on-chip pull-ups, when driven Low.
2These values are provided for design guidance only and are not tested in production.
PS019921-0308
Electrical Characteristics
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
216
Figure 42 displays the typical active mode current consumption while operating at 25 ºC
versus the system clock frequency. All GPIO pins are configured as outputs and driven
High.
stics
15
12
9
6
3
0
0
5
10
15
20
System Clock Frequency (MHz)
3.0V
3.3V
3.6V
Figure 42. Typical Active Mode Idd Versus System Clock Frequency
PS019921-0308
Electrical Characteristics
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
217
Figure 43 displays the maximum active mode current consumption across the full operat-
ing temperature range of the device and versus the system clock frequency. All GPIO pins
are configured as outputs and driven High.
stics
15
12
9
6
3
0
0
5
10
15
20
System Clock Frequency (MHz)
3.0V
3.3V
3.6V
Figure 43. Maximum Active Mode Idd Versus System Clock Frequency
PS019921-0308
Electrical Characteristics
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
218
Figure 44 displays the typical current consumption in HALT mode while operating at
25 ºC versus the system clock frequency. All GPIO pins are configured as outputs and
driven High.
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
5
10
15
20
System Clock Frequency (MHz)
3.0V
3.3V
3.6V
Figure 44. Typical HALT Mode Idd Versus System Clock Frequency
PS019921-0308
Electrical Characteristics
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
219
Figure 44 displays the maximum HALT mode current consumption across the full operat-
ing temperature range of the device and versus the system clock frequency. All GPIO pins
are configured as outputs and driven High.
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
5
10
15
20
System Clock Frequency (MHz)
3.0V 3.3V 3.6V
Figure 45. Maximum HALT Mode Icc Versus System Clock Frequency
PS019921-0308
Electrical Characteristics
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
220
Figure 46 displays the maximum current consumption in STOP mode with the VBO and
Watchdog Timer enabled versus the power supply voltage. All GPIO pins are configured
as outputs and driven High.
700
650
600
550
500
450
400
3.0
3.2
3.4
3.6
Vdd (V)
-40/105C
0/70C
25C Typical
Figure 46. Maximum STOP Mode Idd with VBO enabled versus Power Supply Voltage
PS019921-0308
Electrical Characteristics
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
221
Figure 47 displays the maximum current consumption in STOP mode with the VBO dis-
abled and Watchdog Timer enabled versus the power supply voltage. All GPIO pins are
configured as outputs and driven High. Disabling the Watchdog Timer and its internal RC
oscillator in STOP mode will provide some additional reduction in STOP mode current
consumption. This small current reduction would be indistinquishable on the scale of
Figure 47.
120.00
100.00
80.00
60.00
40.00
20.00
0.00
3.0
3.2
3.4
3.6
Vdd (V)
0/70C
25C Typical
-40/105C
-40/+125C
Figure 47. Maximum STOP Mode Idd with VBO Disabled versus Power Supply Voltage
PS019921-0308
Electrical Characteristics
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
222
On-Chip Peripheral AC and DC Electrical Characteristics
Table 107. Power-On Reset and Voltage Brownout Electrical Characteristics and Timing
T = –40 °C to 125 °C
A
1
Symbol Parameter
Minimum Typical Maximum Units Conditions
V
Power-On Reset
Voltage Threshold
2.40
2.30
50
2.70
2.60
100
2.90
2.85
–
V
V
= V
POR
DD
POR
V
Voltage Brownout Reset
Voltage Threshold
V
V
= V
VBO
DD
VBO
V
to V
mV
V
POR
VBO
hysteresis
Starting V voltage to
–
V
–
DD
SS
ensure valid Power-On
Reset.
T
Power-On Reset Analog
Delay
–
–
50
–
–
µs
V
> V
; T
Digital
ANA
ANA
DD
POR POR
Reset delay follows T
T
Power-On Reset Digital
Delay
6.6
ms
66 WDT Oscillator cycles
(10 kHz) + 16 System Clock
cycles (20 MHz)
POR
T
T
Voltage Brownout Pulse
Rejection Period
–
10
–
–
µs
V
< V
to generate a
VBO
VBO
DD
Reset.
Time for VDD to
0.10
100
ms
RAMP
transition from V to
SS
V
to ensure valid
POR
Reset
1
Data in the typical column is from characterization at 3.3 V and 0 °C. These values are provided for design guidance
only and are not tested in production.
PS019921-0308
Electrical Characteristics
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
223
Table 108. External RC Oscillator Electrical Characteristics and Timing
T = –40 °C to 125 °C
A
1
Symbol Parameter
Minimum Typical Maximum Units Conditions
1
V
Operating Voltage
Range
2.70
40
0
–
45
20
–
–
200
1000
4
V
DD
R
External Resistance from
XIN to VDD
kΩ
V
= V
DD VBO
EXT
EXT
OSC
C
External Capacitance
from XIN to VSS
pF
F
External RC Oscillation
Frequency
–
MHz
1
When using the external RC oscillator mode, the oscillator may stop oscillating if the power supply drops below
2.7 V, but before the power supply drops to the voltage brown-out threshold. The oscillator will resume oscillation as
soon as the supply voltage exceeds 2.7 V.
Table 109. Reset and Stop Mode Recovery Pin Timing
T = –40 °C to 125 °C
A
Symbol Parameter
Minimum Typical Maximum Units Conditions
T
RESET pin assertion to
initiate a system reset.
4
–
–
T
Not in STOP Mode.
CLK
period.
RESET
CLK
T
= System Clock
T
Stop Mode Recovery
pin Pulse Rejection
Period
10
20
40
ns
RESET, DBG, and GPIO
pins configured as SMR
sources.
SMR
PS019921-0308
Electrical Characteristics
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
224
Table 110 list the Flash Memory electrical characteristics and timing.
Table 110. Flash Memory Electrical Characteristics and Timing
V
A
= 3.0–3.6 V
DD
T = –40 °C to 125 °C
Parameter
Minimum Typical Maximum Units Notes
Flash Byte Read Time
Flash Byte Program Time
Flash Page Erase Time
Flash Mass Erase Time
50
20
10
200
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
40
–
ns
µs
ms
ms
–
Writes to Single Address
Before Next Erase
2
Flash Row Program Time
–
–
8
ms
Cumulative program time for
single row cannot exceed limit
before next erase. This
parameter is only an issue
when bypassing the Flash
Controller.
Data Retention
100
–
–
–
–
–
–
years 25 °C
Endurance, –40 °C to 105 °C
Endurance, 106 °C to 125 °C
10,000
1,000
cycles Program/erase cycles
cycles Program/erase cycles
Table 111 lists the Watchdog Timer electrical characteristics and timing.
Table 111. Watchdog Timer Electrical Characteristics and Timing
V
A
= 3.0–3.6 V
DD
T = –40 °C to 125 °C
Symbol Parameter
Minimum Typical Maximum Units Conditions
F
WDT Oscillator Frequency
5
–
10
20
5
kHz
WDT
WDT
I
WDT Oscillator Current
< 1
µA
including internal RC oscillator
Table 112 provides electrical characteristics and timing information for the Analog-to-
Digital Converter. Figure 48 displays the input frequency response of the ADC.
PS019921-0308
Electrical Characteristics
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
225
Table 112. Analog-to-Digital Converter Electrical Characteristics and Timing
V
A
= 3.0 V–3.6 V
DD
T = –40 °C to 125 °C
Symbol Parameter
Minimum Typical Maximum Units Conditions
Resolution
10
–
–
bits External V
= 3.0 V;
REF
Differential Nonlinearity
-1.0
+1.0
lsb
Guaranteed by design
(DNL)
Integral Nonlinearity (INL)
DC Offset Error
DC Offset Error
-3.0
-35
-50
+1.0
3.0
25
25
lsb
External V = 3.0 V
REF
–
–
mV
mV 44-pin LQFP, 44-pin
PLCC, and 68-pin
PLCC packages.
V
Internal Reference
Voltage
1.9
–
2.0
78
2.4
–
V
V
A
= 3.0 V - 3.6 V
DD
REF
T = -40 °C to 105 °C
VC
Voltage Coefficient of
Internal Reference
Voltage
mV/V V
variation as a
REF
REF
REF
function of AVDD.
TC
Temperature Coefficient
of Internal Reference
Voltage
–
1
–
mV/°C
Single-Shot Conversion
Period
–
–
–
5129
256
–
–
–
cycles System clock cycles
cycles System clock cycles
Continuous Conversion
Period
R
Analog Source
Impedance
150
Ω
Recommended
S
Zin
Input Impedance
150
kΩ
V
External Reference
Voltage
AVDD
40.0
V
AVDD <= VDD. When
using an external
reference voltage,
decoupling
REF
capacitance should be
placed from VREF to
AVSS.
I
Current draw into VREF
pin when driving with
external source.
25.0
µA
REF
PS019921-0308
Electrical Characteristics
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
226
ADC Magnitude Transfer Function (Linear Scale)
1
0.9
0.8
-3 dB
-6 dB
0.7
0.6
0.5
0.4
0.3
0.2
0.1
0
0
5
10
15
20
25
30
Frequency (kHz)
Figure 48. Analog-to-Digital Converter Frequency Response
PS019921-0308
Electrical Characteristics
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
227
AC Characteristics
The section provides information on the AC characteristics and timing. All AC timing
information assumes a standard load of 50 pF on all outputs. Table 113 lists the Z8
Encore! XP® F64XX Series AC characteristics and timing.
Table 113. AC Characteristics
V
A
= 3.0 V–3.6V
DD
T = –40 °C to 125 °C
Symbol Parameter
Minimum Maximum Units Conditions
F
F
System Clock Frequency
–
20.0
20.0
MHz Read-only from Flash memory.
sysclk
0.032768
MHz Program or erasure of the
Flash memory.
Crystal Oscillator Frequency 0.032768
20.0
MHz System clock frequencies
below the crystal oscillator
minimum require an external
clock driver.
XTAL
T
Crystal Oscillator Clock
Period
50
–
ns
T
= 1/F
sysclk
XIN
CLK
T
T
T
System Clock High Time
System Clock Low Time
System Clock Rise Time
20
20
–
ns
ns
ns
XINH
XINL
XINR
3
3
T
= 50 ns. Slower rise times
CLK
can be tolerated with longer
clock periods.
T
System Clock Fall Time
–
ns
T
= 50 ns. Slower fall times
CLK
XINF
can be tolerated with longer
clock periods.
PS019921-0308
Electrical Characteristics
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
228
General-Purpose I/O Port Input Data Sample Timing
Figure 49 displays timing of the GPIO Port input sampling. Table 114 lists the GPIO port
input timing.
TCLK
System
Clock
Port Value
Changes to 0
GPIO Pin
Input Value
GPIO Input
Data Latch
0 Latched
Into Port Input
Data Register
GPIO Data Register
Value 0 Read
GPIO Data
Read on Data Bus
by eZ8 CPU
Figure 49. Port Input Sample Timing
Table 114. GPIO Port Input Timing
Delay (ns)
Parameter Abbreviation
Min
Max
T
T
T
Port Input Transition to XIN Fall Setup Time
(Not pictured)
5
–
S_PORT
H_PORT
SMR
XIN Fall to Port Input Transition Hold Time
(Not pictured)
6
–
GPIO Port Pin Pulse Width to Insure Stop Mode
Recovery
1 µs
(for GPIO Port Pins enabled as SMR sources)
PS019921-0308
Electrical Characteristics
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
229
General-Purpose I/O Port Output Timing
Figure 50 and Table 115 provide timing information for GPIO Port pins.
TCLK
XIN
T1
T2
Port Output
Figure 50. GPIO Port Output Timing
Table 115. GPIO Port Output Timing
Delay (ns)
Parameter Abbreviation
GPIO Port pins
Minimum Maximum
T
T
XIN Rise to Port Output Valid Delay
XIN Rise to Port Output Hold Time
–
2
20
–
1
2
PS019921-0308
Electrical Characteristics
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
230
On-Chip Debugger Timing
Figure 51 and Table 116 provide timing information for the DBG pin. The DBG pin tim-
ing specifications assume a 4 µs maximum rise and fall time.
TCLK
XIN
T1
T2
T4
DBG
(Output)
Output Data
T3
DBG
(Input)
Input Data
Figure 51. On-Chip Debugger Timing
Table 116. On-Chip Debugger Timing
Delay (ns)
Parameter Abbreviation
DBG
Minimum
Maximum
T
T
T
T
XIN Rise to DBG Valid Delay
XIN Rise to DBG Output Hold Time
DBG to XIN Rise Input Setup Time
DBG to XIN Rise Input Hold Time
DBG frequency
–
2
30
1
2
3
4
–
10
5
–
–
System Clock/4
PS019921-0308
Electrical Characteristics
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
231
SPI Master Mode Timing
Figure 52 and Table 117 provide timing information for SPI Master mode pins. Timing is
shown with SCK rising edge used to source MOSI output data, SCK falling edge used to
sample MISO input data. Timing on the SS output pin(s) is controlled by software.
SCK
T1
MOSI
(Output)
Output Data
T2
T3
MISO
(Input)
Input Data
Figure 52. SPI Master Mode Timing
Table 117. SPI Master Mode Timing
Delay (ns)
Parameter Abbreviation
SPI Master
Min
Max
T
T
T
SCK Rise to MOSI output Valid Delay
-5
20
0
+5
1
2
3
MISO input to SCK (receive edge) Setup Time
MISO input to SCK (receive edge) Hold Time
PS019921-0308
Electrical Characteristics
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
232
SPI Slave Mode Timing
Figure 53 and Table 118 provide timing information for the SPI slave mode pins. Timing
is shown with SCK rising edge used to source MISO output data, SCK falling edge used to
sample MOSI input data.
SCK
T1
MISO
(Output)
Output Data
T2
T3
MOSI
(Input)
Input Data
T4
SS
(Input)
Figure 53. SPI Slave Mode Timing
Table 118. SPI Slave Mode Timing
Delay (ns)
Parameter Abbreviation
SPI Slave
Minimum Maximum
T
SCK (transmit edge) to MISO output Valid Delay
2 * Xin
period
3 * Xin
period +
20 nsec
1
T
T
MOSI input to SCK (receive edge) Setup Time
MOSI input to SCK (receive edge) Hold Time
0
2
3
3 * Xin
period
T
SS input assertion to SCK setup
1 * Xin
period
4
PS019921-0308
Electrical Characteristics
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
233
2
I C Timing
Figure 54 and Table 119 provide timing information for I2C pins.
SCL
(Output)
T1
SDA
(Output)
Output Data
T3
T2
Input Data
SDA
(Input)
Figure 54. I2C Timing
Table 119. I2C Timing
Delay (ns)
Parameter Abbreviation
Minimum Maximum
2
I C
T
T
T
SCL Fall to SDA output delay
SCL period/4
1
2
3
SDA Input to SCL rising edge Setup Time
SDA Input to SCL falling edge Hold Time
0
0
PS019921-0308
Electrical Characteristics
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
234
UART Timing
Figure 55 and Table 120 provide timing information for UART pins for the case where the
Clear To Send input pin (CTS) is used for flow control. In this example, it is assumed that
the Driver Enable polarity has been configured to be Active Low and is represented here
by DE. The CTS to DE assertion delay (T1) assumes the UART Transmit Data register has
been loaded with data prior to CTS assertion.
CTS
(Input)
T
1
DE
(Output)
T
T
3
2
TXD
(Output)
Stop
Start
Bit 0
Bit 1
Bit 7 Parity
End of
Stop Bit(s)
Figure 55. UART Timing with CTS
Table 120. UART Timing with CTS
Delay (ns)
Parameter Abbreviation
Minimum
Maximum
T
T
T
CTS Fall to DE Assertion Delay
2 * XIN period 2 * XIN period
+ 1 Bit period
1
2
3
DE Assertion to TXD Falling Edge (Start)
Delay
1 Bit period
1 Bit period +
1 * XIN period
End of Stop Bit(s) to DE Deassertion Delay 1 * XIN period 2 * XIN period
PS019921-0308
Electrical Characteristics
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
235
Figure 56 and Table 121 provide timing information for UART pins for the case where the
Clear To Send input signal (CTS) is not used for flow control. In this example, it is
assumed that the Driver Enable polarity has been configured to be Active Low and is
represented here by DE. DE asserts after the UART Transmit Data Register has been
written. DE remains asserted for multiple characters as long as the Transmit Data register
is written with the next character before the current character has completed.
DE
(Output)
T
T
2
1
TXD
(Output)
Stop
Start
Bit 0
Bit 1
Bit 7 Parity
End of
Stop Bit(s)
Figure 56. UART Timing without CTS
Table 121. UART Timing without CTS
Delay (ns)
Parameter Abbreviation
Minimum
Maximum
T
DE Assertion to TXD Falling Edge (Start)
Delay
1 Bit period
1 Bit period +
1 * XIN period
1
T
End of Stop Bit(s) to DE Deassertion Delay 1 * XIN period 2 * XIN period
2
PS019921-0308
Electrical Characteristics
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
236
PS019921-0308
Electrical Characteristics
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
237
eZ8™ CPU Instruction Set
Assembly Language Programming Introduction
The eZ8 CPU assembly language provides a means for writing an application program
without having to be concerned with actual memory addresses or machine instruction
formats. A program written in assembly language is called a source program. Assembly
language allows the use of symbolic addresses to identify memory locations. It also allows
mnemonic codes (opcodes and operands) to represent the instructions themselves. The
opcodes identify the instruction while the operands represent memory locations, registers,
or immediate data values.
Each assembly language program consists of a series of symbolic commands called
statements. Each statement can contain labels, operations, operands and comments.
Labels can be assigned to a particular instruction step in a source program. The label
identifies that step in the program as an entry point for use by other instructions.
The assembly language also includes assembler directives that supplement the machine
instruction. The assembler directives, or pseudo-ops, are not translated into a machine
instruction. Rather, the pseudo-ops are interpreted as directives that control or assist the
assembly process.
The source program is processed (assembled) by the assembler to obtain a machine
language program called the object code. The object code is executed by the eZ8 CPU. An
example segment of an assembly language program is detailed in the following example.
Assembly Language Source Program Example
JP START
; Everything after the semicolon is a comment.
START:
; A label called “START”. The first instruction (JP START) in this
; example causes program execution to jump to the point within the
; program where the STARTlabel occurs.
LD R4, R7
; A Load (LD) instruction with two operands. The first operand,
; Working Register R4, is the destination. The second operand,
; Working Register R7, is the source. The contents of R7 is
; written into R4.
LD 234H, #%01 ; Another Load (LD) instruction with two operands.
; The first operand, Extended Mode Register Address 234H,
; identifies the destination. The second operand, Immediate Data
; value 01H, is the source. The value 01His written into the
; Register at address 234H.
™
PS019921-0308
eZ8 CPU Instruction Set
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
238
Assembly Language Syntax
For proper instruction execution, eZ8 CPU assembly language syntax requires that the
operands be written as ‘destination, source’. After assembly, the object code usually has
the operands in the order ‘source, destination’, but ordering is opcode-dependent. The fol-
lowing instruction examples illustrate the format of some basic assembly instructions and
the resulting object code produced by the assembler. This binary format must be followed
if you prefer manual program coding or intend to implement your own assembler.
Example 1: If the contents of Registers 43H and 08H are added and the result is stored in
43H, the assembly syntax and resulting object code is:
Assembly Language Syntax Example 1
ADD
43H,
08H
(ADD dst, src)
(OPC src, dst)
Assembly Language
Code
04
08
43
Object Code
Example 2: In general, when an instruction format requires an 8-bit register address, that
address can specify any register location in the range 0–255 or, using Escaped Mode
Addressing, a Working Register R0 - R15. If the contents of Register 43H and Working
Register R8 are added and the result is stored in 43H, the assembly syntax and resulting
object code is:
Assembly Language Syntax Example 2
ADD
43H,
R8
(ADD dst, src)
(OPC src, dst)
Assembly Language
Code
04
E8
43
Object Code
Refer to the device-specific Product Specification to determine the exact register file range
available. The register file size varies, depending on the device type.
eZ8 CPU Instruction Notation
In the eZ8 CPU Instruction Summary and Description sections, the operands, condition
codes, status Flags, and address modes are represented by a notational shorthand that is
described in Table 122.
™
PS019921-0308
eZ8 CPU Instruction Set
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
239
.
Table 122. Notational Shorthand
Notation Description
Operand Range
b
Bit
b
b represents a value from 0 to 7 (000B to 111B).
cc
Condition Code
—
Refer to Condition Codes overview in the eZ8
CPU User Manual.
DA
ER
Direct Address
Addrs
Reg
Addrs. represents a number in the range of
0000H to FFFFH
Extended Addressing Register
Reg. represents a number in the range of 000H to
FFFH
IM
Ir
Immediate Data
#Data
@Rn
Data is a number between 00H to FFH
n = 0 –15
Indirect Working Register
Indirect Register
IR
@Reg
Reg. represents a number in the range of 00H to
FFH
Irr
Indirect Working Register Pair
Indirect Register Pair
@RRp
@Reg
p = 0, 2, 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, or 14
IRR
Reg. represents an even number in the range
00H to FEH
p
Polarity
p
Polarity is a single bit binary value of either 0B or
1B.
r
Working Register
Register
Rn
n = 0 – 15
R
Reg
Reg. represents a number in the range of 00H to
FFH
RA
Relative Address
X
X represents an index in the range of +127 to
-128 which is an offset relative to the address of
the next instruction
rr
Working Register Pair
Register Pair
RRp
Reg
p = 0, 2, 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, or 14
RR
Reg. represents an even number in the range of
00H to FEH
Vector
X
Vector Address
Indexed
Vector
#Index
Vector represents a number in the range of 00H
to FFH
The register or register pair to be indexed is offset
by the signed Index value (#Index) in a +127 to
-128 range.
Table 123 contains additional symbols that are used throughout the Instruction Summary
and Instruction Set Description sections.
™
PS019921-0308
eZ8 CPU Instruction Set
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
240
Table 123. Additional Symbols
Symbol
dst
src
@
Definition
Destination Operand
Source Operand
Indirect Address Prefix
Stack Pointer
SP
PC
FLAGS
RP
#
Program Counter
Flags Register
Register Pointer
Immediate Operand Prefix
Binary Number Suffix
Hexadecimal Number Prefix
Hexadecimal Number Suffix
B
%
H
Assignment of a value is indicated by an arrow. For example,
dst ← dst + src
indicates the source data is added to the destination data and the result is stored in the des-
tination location.
Condition Codes
The C, Z, S and V Flags control the operation of the conditional jump (JP cc and JR cc)
instructions. Sixteen frequently useful functions of the Flag settings are encoded in a 4-bit
field called the condition code (cc), which forms Bits 7:4 of the conditional jump instruc-
tions. The condition codes are summarized in Table 124. Some binary condition codes can
be created using more than one assembly code mnemonic. The result of the Flag test oper-
ation decides if the conditional jump is executed.
Table 124. Condition Codes
Assembly
Binary Hex Mnemonic
Definition
Always False
Less Than
Flag Test Operation
–
0000
0001
0010
0
1
2
F
LT
LE
(S XOR V) = 1
(Z OR (S XOR V)) = 1
Less Than or Equal
™
PS019921-0308
eZ8 CPU Instruction Set
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
241
Table 124. Condition Codes (Continued)
Assembly
Binary Hex Mnemonic
Definition
Unsigned Less Than or Equal
Flag Test Operation
0011
0100
0101
0110
0110
0111
0111
1000
1001
1010
1011
1100
1101
1110
1110
1111
1111
3
4
ULE
OV
(C OR Z) = 1
Overflow
Minus
V = 1
5
Ml
S = 1
6
Z
Zero
Z = 1
6
EQ
Equal
Z = 1
7
C
Carry
C = 1
7
ULT
T (or blank)
GE
Unsigned Less Than
Always True
Greater Than or Equal
Greater Than
Unsigned Greater Than
No Overflow
Plus
C = 1
8
–
9
(S XOR V) = 0
A
B
C
D
E
E
F
F
GT
(Z OR (S XOR V)) = 0
UGT
NOV
PL
(C = 0 AND Z = 0) = 1
V = 0
S = 0
Z = 0
Z = 0
C = 0
C = 0
NZ
Non-Zero
NE
Not Equal
NC
No Carry
UGE
Unsigned Greater Than or Equal
eZ8 CPU Instruction Classes
eZ8 CPU instructions can be divided functionally into the following groups:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Arithmetic
Bit Manipulation
Block Transfer
CPU Control
Load
Logical
Program Control
Rotate and Shift
™
PS019921-0308
eZ8 CPU Instruction Set
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
242
Table 125 through Table 132 contain the instructions belonging to each group and the
number of operands required for each instruction. Some instructions appear in more than
one table as these instruction can be considered as a subset of more than one category.
Within these tables, the source operand is identified as ’src’, the destination operand
is ’dst’ and a condition code is ’cc’.
Table 125. Arithmetic Instructions
Mnemonic
ADC
Operands
dst, src
dst, src
dst, src
dst, src
dst, src
dst, src
dst, src
dst, src
dst
Instruction
Add with Carry
ADCX
ADD
Add with Carry using Extended Addressing
Add
ADDX
CP
Add using Extended Addressing
Compare
CPC
Compare with Carry
CPCX
CPX
Compare with Carry using Extended Addressing
Compare using Extended Addressing
Decimal Adjust
DA
DEC
dst
Decrement
DECW
INC
dst
Decrement Word
dst
Increment
INCW
MULT
SBC
dst
Increment Word
dst
Multiply
dst, src
dst, src
dst, src
dst, src
Subtract with Carry
SBCX
SUB
Subtract with Carry using Extended Addressing
Subtract
SUBX
Subtract using Extended Addressing
Table 126. Bit Manipulation Instructions
Mnemonic
BCLR
Operands Instruction
bit, dst
Bit Clear
BIT
p, bit, dst
bit, dst
Bit Set or Clear
Bit Set
BSET
™
PS019921-0308
eZ8 CPU Instruction Set
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
243
Table 126. Bit Manipulation Instructions (Continued)
Mnemonic
BSWAP
CCF
Operands Instruction
dst
Bit Swap
—
Complement Carry Flag
Reset Carry Flag
Set Carry Flag
RCF
—
SCF
—
TCM
dst, src
dst, src
dst, src
dst, src
Test Complement Under Mask
TCMX
TM
Test Complement Under Mask using Extended Addressing
Test Under Mask
TMX
Test Under Mask using Extended Addressing
Table 127. Block Transfer Instructions
Mnemonic
Operands
Instruction
LDCI
dst, src
Load Constant to/from Program Memory and Auto-
Increment Addresses
LDEI
dst, src
Load External Data to/from Data Memory and Auto-
Increment Addresses
Table 128. CPU Control Instructions
Mnemonic Operands
Instruction
ATM
CCF
DI
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
src
Atomic Execution
Complement Carry Flag
Disable Interrupts
Enable Interrupts
HALT Mode
EI
HALT
NOP
RCF
SCF
SRP
No Operation
Reset Carry Flag
Set Carry Flag
Set Register Pointer
™
PS019921-0308
eZ8 CPU Instruction Set
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
244
Table 128. CPU Control Instructions
Mnemonic Operands
Instruction
STOP
WDT
—
—
STOP Mode
Watchdog Timer
Refresh
Table 129. Load Instructions
Mnemonic Operands Instruction
CLR
LD
dst
Clear
Load
dst, src
dst, src
dst, src
LDC
LDCI
Load Constant to/from Program Memory
Load Constant to/from Program Memory and Auto-Increment
Addresses
LDE
dst, src
dst, src
Load External Data to/from Data Memory
LDEI
Load External Data to/from Data Memory and Auto-Increment
Addresses
LDWX
LDX
dst, src
dst, src
Load Word using Extended Addressing
Load using Extended Addressing
LEA
dst, X(src) Load Effective Address
POP
dst
dst
src
src
Pop
POPX
PUSH
PUSHX
Pop using Extended Addressing
Push
Push using Extended Addressing
Table 130. Logical Instructions
Mnemonic Operands Instruction
AND
ANDX
COM
OR
dst, src
dst, src
dst
Logical AND
Logical AND using Extended Addressing
Complement
dst, src
dst, src
Logical OR
ORX
Logical OR using Extended Addressing
™
PS019921-0308
eZ8 CPU Instruction Set
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
245
Table 130. Logical Instructions (Continued)
Mnemonic Operands Instruction
XOR
dst, src
dst, src
Logical Exclusive OR
XORX
Logical Exclusive OR using Extended
Addressing
Table 131. Program Control Instructions
Mnemonic
BRK
Operands
Instruction
—
On-Chip Debugger Break
BTJ
p, bit, src, DA Bit Test and Jump
BTJNZ
BTJZ
CALL
DJNZ
IRET
JP
bit, src, DA
bit, src, DA
dst
Bit Test and Jump if Non-Zero
Bit Test and Jump if Zero
Call Procedure
dst, src, RA Decrement and Jump Non-Zero
—
Interrupt Return
Jump
dst
dst
DA
DA
—
JP cc
JR
Jump Conditional
Jump Relative
Jump Relative Conditional
Return
JR cc
RET
TRAP
vector
Software Trap
Table 132. Rotate and Shift Instructions
Mnemonic Operands
Instruction
BSWAP
RL
dst
dst
dst
dst
dst
dst
Bit Swap
Rotate Left
RLC
RR
Rotate Left through Carry
Rotate Right
RRC
SRA
Rotate Right through Carry
Shift Right Arithmetic
™
PS019921-0308
eZ8 CPU Instruction Set
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
246
Table 132. Rotate and Shift Instructions (Continued)
Mnemonic Operands
Instruction
SRL
dst
dst
Shift Right Logical
Swap Nibbles
SWAP
eZ8 CPU Instruction Summary
Table 133 summarizes the eZ8 CPU instructions. The table identifies the addressing
modes employed by the instruction, the effect upon the Flags register, the number of CPU
clock cycles required for the instruction fetch, and the number of CPU clock cycles
required for the instruction execution.
.
Table 133. eZ8 CPU Instruction Summary
Address
Mode
Flags
Assembly
Opcode(s)
(Hex)
Fetch Instr.
Mnemonic
Symbolic Operation dst
src
r
C
Z
S
V
D
H Cycles Cycles
ADC dst, src dst ← dst + src + C
r
r
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
*
*
*
*
0
*
2
2
3
3
3
3
4
4
2
2
3
3
3
3
4
4
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
3
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
3
Ir
R
R
R
IR
IM
IM
ER
IM
r
R
IR
ER
ER
r
ADCX dst, src dst ← dst + src + C
ADD dst, src dst ← dst + src
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
0
0
*
*
r
Ir
R
R
R
IR
IM
IM
ER
IM
R
IR
ER
ER
ADDX dst, src dst ← dst + src
*
*
*
*
0
*
™
PS019921-0308
eZ8 CPU Instruction Set
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
247
Table 133. eZ8 CPU Instruction Summary (Continued)
Address
Mode
Flags
Assembly
Mnemonic
Opcode(s)
(Hex)
Fetch Instr.
Symbolic Operation dst
src
r
C
Z
S
V
D
H Cycles Cycles
AND dst, src dst ← dst AND src
r
r
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
2F
-
*
*
0
-
-
2
2
3
3
3
3
4
4
1
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
3
2
Ir
R
R
R
IR
IM
IM
ER
IM
R
IR
ER
ER
ANDX dst, src dst ← dst AND src
-
-
*
-
*
-
0
-
-
-
-
-
ATM
Block all interrupt and
DMA requests during
execution of the next
3 instructions
BCLR bit, dst dst[bit] ← 0
BIT p, bit, dst dst[bit] ← p
r
r
E2
E2
00
E2
D5
F6
F7
F6
F7
F6
F7
D4
D6
-
-
-
-
-
-
*
-
-
-
-
-
*
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
2
2
1
2
2
3
3
3
3
3
3
2
3
2
2
1
2
2
3
4
3
4
3
4
6
3
BRK
Debugger Break
-
-
BSET bit, dst dst[bit] ← 1
r
-
-
BSWAP dst
dst[7:0] ← dst[0:7]
R
X
-
0
-
BTJ p, bit, src, if src[bit] = p
r
Ir
r
dst
PC ← PC + X
BTJNZ bit,
src, dst
if src[bit] = 1
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
PC ← PC + X
Ir
r
BTJZ bit, src, if src[bit] = 0
dst
PC ← PC + X
Ir
CALL dst
SP ← SP -2
@SP ← PC
PC ← dst
IRR
DA
CCF
C ← ~C
EF
B0
B1
*
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
1
2
2
2
2
3
CLR dst
dst ← 00H
R
IR
™
PS019921-0308
eZ8 CPU Instruction Set
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
248
Table 133. eZ8 CPU Instruction Summary (Continued)
Address
Mode
Flags
Assembly
Mnemonic
Opcode(s)
(Hex)
Fetch Instr.
Symbolic Operation dst
src
C
Z
S
V
D
H Cycles Cycles
COM dst
dst ← ~dst
R
IR
r
60
61
-
*
*
0
-
-
2
2
2
2
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
4
4
4
5
5
4
4
2
2
2
2
2
2
1
2
2
3
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
3
3
3
2
3
2
3
5
6
2
3
CP dst, src
dst - src
r
A2
*
*
*
*
-
-
r
Ir
A3
R
R
A4
R
IR
IM
IM
r
A5
R
A6
IR
r
A7
CPC dst, src dst - src - C
1F A2
1F A3
1F A4
1F A5
1F A6
1F A7
1F A8
1F A9
A8
*
*
*
*
-
-
r
Ir
R
R
R
IR
IM
IM
ER
IM
ER
IM
R
IR
ER
ER
ER
ER
R
CPCX dst, src dst - src - C
CPX dst, src dst - src
*
*
*
-
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
A9
DA dst
DEC dst
DECW dst
DI
dst ← DA(dst)
dst ← dst - 1
dst ← dst - 1
IRQCTL[7] ← 0
40
X
*
IR
R
41
30
IR
RR
IRR
31
80
-
*
81
8F
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
DJNZ dst, RA dst ← dst – 1
if dst ≠ 0
r
0A-FA
PC ← PC + X
™
PS019921-0308
eZ8 CPU Instruction Set
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
249
Table 133. eZ8 CPU Instruction Summary (Continued)
Address
Mode
Flags
Assembly
Mnemonic
Opcode(s)
(Hex)
Fetch Instr.
Symbolic Operation dst
IRQCTL[7] ← 1
src
C
-
Z
-
S
-
V
-
D
-
H Cycles Cycles
EI
9F
7F
-
-
-
1
1
2
2
1
2
2
1
2
2
2
3
2
5
6
5
HALT
INC dst
HALT Mode
-
-
-
-
-
dst ← dst + 1
R
IR
20
-
*
*
*
-
21
r
0E-FE
A0
INCW dst
IRET
dst ← dst + 1
RR
IRR
-
*
*
*
*
*
*
-
-
A1
FLAGS ← @SP
SP ← SP + 1
PC ← @SP
BF
*
*
*
SP ← SP + 2
IRQCTL[7] ← 1
JP dst
PC ← dst
DA
IRR
DA
8D
C4
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
3
2
3
2
3
2
JP cc, dst
if cc is true
0D-FD
PC ← dst
JR dst
PC ← PC + X
DA
DA
8B
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
2
2
2
2
JR cc, dst
if cc is true
0B-FB
PC ← PC + X
LD dst, rc
dst ← src
r
r
IM
X(r)
r
0C-FC
C7
D7
E3
-
-
-
-
-
-
2
3
3
2
3
3
3
3
2
3
2
3
4
3
2
4
2
3
3
3
X(r)
r
Ir
R
R
E4
R
IR
IM
IM
r
E5
R
E6
IR
Ir
E7
F3
IR
R
F5
™
PS019921-0308
eZ8 CPU Instruction Set
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
250
Table 133. eZ8 CPU Instruction Summary (Continued)
Address
Mode
Flags
Assembly
Mnemonic
Opcode(s)
(Hex)
Fetch Instr.
Symbolic Operation dst
src
Irr
Irr
r
C
Z
S
V
D
H Cycles Cycles
LDC dst, src dst ← src
r
C2
C5
D2
C3
D3
-
-
-
-
-
-
2
2
2
2
2
5
9
5
9
9
Ir
Irr
Ir
LDCI dst, src dst ← src
r ← r + 1
Irr
Ir
-
-
-
-
-
-
Irr
rr ← rr + 1
LDE dst, src dst ← src
r
Irr
r
82
92
83
93
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
2
2
2
2
5
5
9
9
Irr
Ir
LDEI dst, src dst ← src
r ← r + 1
Irr
Ir
Irr
rr ← rr + 1
LDWX dst, src dst ← src
LDX dst, src dst ← src
ER
r
ER
ER
ER
IRR
IRR
X(rr)
r
1F E8
84
-
-
-
-
-
-
5
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
4
3
3
2
4
2
3
4
5
4
4
2
3
4
5
2
2
3
5
8
-
-
-
-
-
-
Ir
85
R
86
IR
87
r
88
X(rr)
ER
ER
IRR
IRR
ER
ER
r
89
r
94
Ir
95
R
96
IR
97
ER
IM
E8
E9
98
LEA dst,
X(src)
dst ← src + X
X(r)
X(rr)
-
-
-
-
-
-
rr
99
MULT dst
NOP
dst[15:0] ←
RR
F4
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
dst[15:8] * dst[7:0]
No operation
0F
1
2
™
PS019921-0308
eZ8 CPU Instruction Set
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
251
Table 133. eZ8 CPU Instruction Summary (Continued)
Address
Mode
Flags
Assembly
Mnemonic
Opcode(s)
(Hex)
Fetch Instr.
Symbolic Operation dst
src
r
C
Z
S
V
D
H Cycles Cycles
OR dst, src
dst ← dst OR src
r
r
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
D8
-
*
*
0
-
-
2
2
3
3
3
3
4
4
2
2
3
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
3
2
3
2
Ir
R
R
R
IR
IM
IM
ER
IM
R
IR
ER
ER
R
ORX dst, src dst ← dst OR src
-
-
*
-
*
-
0
-
-
-
-
-
POP dst
dst ← @SP
SP ← SP + 1
IR
ER
POPX dst
PUSH src
dst ← @SP
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
SP ← SP + 1
SP ← SP – 1
@SP ← src
R
IR
70
71
2
2
3
3
2
3
2
2
IM
ER
1F 70
C8
PUSHX src
SP ← SP – 1
@SP ← src
-
-
-
-
-
-
RCF
RET
C ← 0
CF
AF
0
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
1
1
2
4
PC ← @SP
SP ← SP + 2
RL dst
R
90
91
*
*
*
*
-
-
2
2
2
3
C
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
IR
dst
RLC dst
RR dst
R
10
11
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
-
-
-
-
2
2
2
3
C
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
dst
IR
R
E0
E1
2
2
2
3
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
dst
C
IR
™
PS019921-0308
eZ8 CPU Instruction Set
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
252
Table 133. eZ8 CPU Instruction Summary (Continued)
Address
Mode
Flags
Assembly
Mnemonic
Opcode(s)
(Hex)
Fetch Instr.
Symbolic Operation dst
src
C
Z
S
V
D
H Cycles Cycles
RRC dst
R
C0
C1
*
*
*
*
-
-
2
2
2
3
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
dst
C
IR
SBC dst, src dst ← dst – src - C
r
r
r
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
DF
D0
D1
*
*
*
*
*
*
1
*
2
2
3
3
3
3
4
4
1
2
2
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
3
2
2
3
Ir
R
R
R
IR
IM
IM
ER
IM
R
IR
ER
ER
SBCX dst, src dst ← dst – src - C
*
*
1
*
SCF
C ← 1
1
*
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
SRA dst
R
*
*
0
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
dst
C
C
IR
SRL dst
R
1F C0
1F C1
*
*
0
*
-
-
3
3
2
3
0
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
dst
IR
SRP src
STOP
RP ← src
IM
01
6F
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
-
-
*
-
-
*
-
-
*
-
-
*
-
-
-
-
*
2
1
2
2
3
3
3
3
4
4
2
2
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
3
STOP Mode
SUB dst, src dst ← dst – src
r
r
r
1
Ir
R
R
R
IR
IM
IM
ER
IM
R
IR
ER
ER
SUBX dst, src dst ← dst – src
*
*
*
*
1
*
™
PS019921-0308
eZ8 CPU Instruction Set
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
253
Table 133. eZ8 CPU Instruction Summary (Continued)
Address
Mode
Flags
Assembly
Mnemonic
Opcode(s)
(Hex)
Fetch Instr.
Symbolic Operation dst
src
C
Z
S
V
D
H Cycles Cycles
SWAP dst
dst[7:4] ↔ dst[3:0]
R
IR
r
F0
F1
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
F2
X
*
*
X
-
-
2
2
2
2
3
3
3
3
4
4
2
2
3
3
3
3
4
4
2
2
3
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
3
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
3
6
TCM dst, src (NOT dst) AND src
r
Ir
-
*
*
0
-
-
r
R
R
R
IR
R
IM
IM
ER
IM
r
IR
ER
ER
r
TCMX dst, src (NOT dst) AND src
-
-
*
*
*
*
0
0
-
-
-
-
TM dst, src
dst AND src
r
Ir
R
R
R
IR
R
IM
IM
ER
IM
Vector
IR
ER
ER
TMX dst, src dst AND src
-
-
*
-
*
-
0
-
-
-
-
-
TRAP Vector SP ← SP – 2
@SP ← PC
SP ← SP – 1
@SP ← FLAGS
PC ← @Vector
WDT
5F
-
-
-
-
-
-
1
2
™
PS019921-0308
eZ8 CPU Instruction Set
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
254
Table 133. eZ8 CPU Instruction Summary (Continued)
Address
Mode
Flags
Assembly
Mnemonic
Opcode(s)
(Hex)
Fetch Instr.
Symbolic Operation dst
src
r
C
Z
S
V
D
H Cycles Cycles
XOR dst, src dst ← dst XOR src
r
r
B2
B3
B4
B5
B6
B7
B8
B9
-
*
*
0
-
-
2
2
3
3
3
3
4
4
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
3
Ir
R
R
R
IR
IM
IM
ER
IM
R
IR
ER
ER
XORX dst, src dst ← dst XOR src
-
*
*
0
-
-
0 = Reset to 0
1 = Set to 1
Flags Notation: * = Value is a function of the result of the operation.
- = Unaffected
X = Undefined
™
PS019921-0308
eZ8 CPU Instruction Set
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
255
Flags Register
The Flags Register contains the status information regarding the most recent arithmetic,
logical, bit manipulation or rotate and shift operation. The Flags Register contains six bits
of status information that are set or cleared by CPU operations. Four of the bits
(C, V, Z and S) can be tested for use with conditional jump instructions. Two Flags (H and
D) cannot be tested and are used for Binary-Coded Decimal (BCD) arithmetic.
The two remaining bits, User Flags (F1 and F2), are available as general-purpose status
bits. User Flags are unaffected by arithmetic operations and must be set or cleared by
instructions. The User Flags cannot be used with conditional Jumps. They are undefined at
initial power-up and are unaffected by Reset. Figure 57 displays the Flags and their bit
positions in the Flags Register.
Bit
7
Bit
0
C
Z
S
V
D
H F2 F1 Flags Register
User Flags
Half Carry Flag
Decimal Adjust Flag
Overflow Flag
Sign Flag
Zero Flag
Carry Flag
U = Undefined
Figure 57. Flags Register
Interrupts, the Software Trap (TRAP) instruction, and Illegal Instruction Traps all write
the value of the Flags Register to the stack. Executing an Interrupt Return (IRET) instruc-
tion restores the value saved on the stack into the Flags Register.
™
PS019921-0308
eZ8 CPU Instruction Set
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
256
™
PS019921-0308
eZ8 CPU Instruction Set
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
257
Opcode Maps
A description of the opcode map data and the abbreviations are provided in Figure 58 and
Table 134 on page 258. Figure 59 on page 259 and Figure 60 on page 260 provide
information on each of the eZ8TM CPU instructions.
Opcode
Lower Nibble
Fetch Cycles
Instruction Cycles
4
3.3
CP
Opcode
Upper Nibble
A
R2,R1
First Operand
Second Operand
After Assembly
After Assembly
Figure 58. Opcode Map Cell Description
PS019921-0308
Opcode Maps
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
258
Table 134. Opcode Map Abbreviations
Abbreviation
Description
Bit position
Abbreviation
Description
b
IRR
Indirect Register Pair
Polarity (0 or 1)
cc
X
Condition code
p
r
8-bit signed index or
displacement
4-bit Working Register
DA
ER
Destination address
R
8-bit register
Extended Addressing register r1, R1, Ir1, Irr1, IR1,
rr1, RR1, IRR1, ER1
Destination address
IM
Immediate data value
r2, R2, Ir2, Irr2, IR2,
rr2, RR2, IRR2, ER2
Source address
Ir
Indirect Working Register
Indirect register
RA
rr
Relative
IR
Irr
Working Register Pair
Register Pair
Indirect Working Register Pair RR
PS019921-0308
Opcode Maps
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
259
Lower Nibble (Hex)
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
A
B
C
D
E
F
1.2
2.2
2.3
2.4
3.3
3.4
3.3
3.4
4.3
4.3
2.3
2.2
JR
cc,X
2.2
LD
3.2
JP
1.2
INC
r1
1.2
BRK SRP ADD ADD ADD ADD ADD ADD ADDX ADDX DJNZ
NOP
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
A
B
C
D
E
F
IM
2.3
r1,r2
2.3
r1,Ir2
2.4
R2,R1
3.3
IR2,R1
3.4
R1,IM
3.3
IR1,IM ER2,ER1 IM,ER1
3.4 4.3 4.3
r1,X
r1,IM
cc,DA
2.2
RLC
R1
2.2
INC
R1
See 2nd
Opcode
Map
RLC ADC ADC ADC ADC ADC ADC ADCX ADCX
IR1
r1,r2
2.3
r1,Ir2
2.4
R2,R1
3.3
IR2,R1
3.4
R1,IM
3.3
IR1,IM ER2,ER1 IM,ER1
3.4 4.3 4.3
2.3
INC
IR1
1,2
ATM
SUB SUB SUB SUB SUB SUB SUBX SUBX
r1,r2
2.3
r1,Ir2
2.4
R2,R1
3.3
IR2,R1
3.4
R1,IM
3.3
IR1,IM ER2,ER1 IM,ER1
3.4 4.3 4.3
2.2
2.3
DEC DEC SBC SBC SBC SBC SBC SBC SBCX SBCX
R1
IR1
r1,r2
r1,Ir2
R2,R1
IR2,R1
R1,IM
IR1,IM ER2,ER1 IM,ER1
2.2
DA
R1
2.3
DA
IR1
2.3
OR
r1,r2
2.4
OR
r1,Ir2
3.3
OR
3.4
OR
3.3
OR
3.4
OR
4.3
4.3
ORX ORX
R2,R1
IR2,R1
R1,IM
IR1,IM ER2,ER1 IM,ER1
2.2
2.3
2.3
2.4
3.3
3.4
3.3
3.4
4.3
4.3
1.2
WDT
POP POP AND AND AND AND AND AND ANDX ANDX
R1
2.2
IR1
2.3
r1,r2
2.3
r1,Ir2
2.4
R2,R1
3.3
IR2,R1
3.4
R1,IM
3.3
IR1,IM ER2,ER1 IM,ER1
3.4 4.3 4.3
1.2
STOP
COM COM TCM TCM TCM TCM TCM TCM TCMX TCMX
R1
2.2
IR1
2.3
r1,r2
2.3
r1,Ir2
R2,R1
IR2,R1
R1,IM
IR1,IM ER2,ER1 IM,ER1
2.4
TM
3.3
TM
3.4
TM
3.3
TM
3.4
TM
4.3
4.3
1.2
HALT
PUSH PUSH TM
TMX TMX
R2
2.5
IR2
2.6
r1,r2
2.5
r1,Ir2
R2,R1
IR2,R1
R1,IM
IR1,IM ER2,ER1 IM,ER1
2.9
3.2
3.3
LDX
3.4
LDX
3.5
LDX
3.4
LDX
3.4
LDX
1.2
DI
DECW DECW LDE LDEI LDX
RR1
IRR1
r1,Irr2
2.5
Ir1,Irr2 r1,ER2 Ir1,ER2 IRR2,R1 IRR2,IR1 r1,rr2,X rr1,r2,X
2.9
2.2
RL
R1
2.3
RL
IR1
3.2
3.3
LDX
3.4
LDX
3.5
LDX
3.3
LEA
3.5
LEA
1.2
EI
LDE LDEI LDX
r2,Irr1
Ir2,Irr1 r2,ER1 Ir2,ER1 R2,IRR1 IR2,IRR1 r1,r2,X rr1,rr2,X
2.5
2.6
2.3
CP
r1,r2
2.4
CP
3.3
CP
3.4
CP
3.3
CP
3.4
CP
4.3
CPX
4.3
CPX
1.4
RET
INCW INCW
RR1
IRR1
2.3
r1,Ir2
R2,R1
IR2,R1
R1,IM
IR1,IM ER2,ER1 IM,ER1
2.2
CLR
R1
2.3
2.4
3.3
3.4
3.3
3.4
4.3
4.3
1.5
IRET
CLR XOR XOR XOR XOR XOR XOR XORX XORX
IR1
2.3
r1,r2
2.5
r1,Ir2
2.9
R2,R1
IR2,R1
R1,IM
IR1,IM ER2,ER1 IM,ER1
3.4 3.2
2.2
2.3
JP
2.9
1.2
RCF
RRC RRC LDC LDCI
LDC
LD PUSHX
R1
2.2
IR1
2.3
r1,Irr2
2.5
Ir1,Irr2
2.9
IRR1
Ir1,Irr2
r1,r2,X
ER2
2.6
2.2
3.3
3.4
LD
3.2
POPX
ER1
4.2
LDX
1.2
SCF
SRA SRA
LDC LDCI CALL BSWAP CALL
R1
IR1
r2,Irr1
Ir2,Irr1
IRR1
R1
DA
r2,r1,X
2.2
RR
R1
2.3
RR
IR1
2.2
2.3
LD
3.2
LD
3.3
LD
3.2
LD
3.3
LD
4.2
LDX
1.2
CCF
BIT
p,b,r1
r1,Ir2
R2,R1
IR2,R1
R1,IM
IR1,IM ER2,ER1 IM,ER1
2.2
2.3
2.6
2.3
LD
2.8
MULT
RR1
3.3
LD
3.3
BTJ
3.4
BTJ
SWAP SWAP TRAP
R1
IR1
Vector
Ir1,r2
R2,IR1 p,b,r1,X p,b,Ir1,X
Figure 59. First Opcode Map
PS019921-0308
Opcode Maps
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
260
Lower Nibble (Hex)
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
A
B
C
D
E
F
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
A
B
C
D
E
F
3,2
PUSH
IM
3.3
3.4
4.3
4.4
4.3
4.4
5.3
5.3
CPC CPC CPC CPC CPC CPC CPCX CPCX
r1,r2
r1,Ir2
R2,R1
IR2,R1
R1,IM
IR1,IM ER2,ER1 IM,ER1
3.2
SRL
R1
3.3
SRL
IR1
5,4
LDWX
ER2,ER1
Figure 60. Second Opcode Map after 1FH
PS019921-0308
Opcode Maps
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
261
Packaging
Figure 61 displays the 44-pin Low Profile Quad Flat Package (LQFP) available for the
Z8X1621, Z8X2421, Z8X3221, Z8X4821, and Z8X6421 devices.
A
HD
D
A2
A1
E
HE
DETAIL A
LE
c
b
e
L
0-7°
Figure 61. 44-Lead Low-Profile Quad Flat Package (LQFP)
PS019921-0308
Packaging
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
262
Figure 62 displays the 44-pin Plastic Lead Chip Carrier (PLCC) package available for the
Z8X1621, Z8X2421, Z8X3221, Z8X4821, and Z8X6421 devices.
A
D
A1
D1
0.71/0.51
.028/.020
45°
6
1
40
MILLIMETER
INCH
SYMBOL
7
39
29
MIN
MAX
MIN
MAX
0.180
0.115
0.695
0.656
0.630
e
A
A1
4.27
4.57
0.168
0.095
0.685
0.650
0.600
0.51/0.36
2.41
2.92
0.020/0.014
M
E1 E
D/E
D1/E1
D2
17.40
16.51
15.24
17.65
16.66
16.00
0.81/0.66
0.032/0.026
17
e
1.27 BSC
0.050 BSC
18
28
R 1.14/0.64
0.045/0.025
NOTES:
1. CONTROLLING DIMENSION : INCH
2. LEADS ARE COPLANAR WITHIN 0.004".
3. DIMENSION : MM
INCH
Figure 62. 44-Lead Plastic Lead Chip Carrier Package (PLCC)
Figure 62 displays the 64-pin Low-Profile Quad Flat Package (LQFP) available for the
Z8X1622, Z8X2422, Z8X3222, Z8X4822, and Z8X6422 devices.
A
HD
D
A2
A1
E
HE
DETAIL A
LE
c
e
b
L
0-7°
Figure 63. 64-Lead Low-Profile Quad Flat Package (LQFP)
PS019921-0308
Packaging
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
263
Figure 64 displays the 68-pin Plastic Lead Chip Carrier (PLCC) package available for the
Z8X1622, Z8X2422, Z8X3222, Z8X4822, and Z8X6422 devices.
Figure 64. 68-Lead Plastic Lead Chip Carrier Package (PLCC)
PS019921-0308
Packaging
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
264
Figure 65 displays the 80-pin Quad Flat Package (QFP) available for the Z8X4823 and
Z8X6423 devices.
HD
A2
D
MILLIMETER
INCH
A1
64
41
SYMBOL
MIN
MAX
0.38
MIN
.004
.102
.012
.005
.933
.783
.697
.547
MAX
.015
.110
.018
.008
.951
.791
.715
.555
A1
A2
b
0.10
65
40
2.60
2.80
0.30
0.45
c
0.13
0.20
E
HE
HD
D
23.70
19.90
17.70
13.90
24.15
20.10
18.15
14.10
HE
E
80
25
e
0.80 BSC
.0315 BSC
.028 .043
L
0.70
1.10
c
1
24
b
DETAIL A
e
NOTES:
CONTROLLING DIMENSIONS : MILLIMETER
LEAD COPLANARITY : MAX .10
2.
.004"
L
0-10°
DETAIL A
Figure 65. 80-Lead Quad-Flat Package (QFP)
PS019921-0308
Packaging
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
265
Ordering Information
Z8F642x with 64 KB Flash, 10-Bit Analog-to-Digital Converter
Standard Temperature: 0 °C to 70 °C
Z8F6421AN020SC
Z8F6421VN020SC
Z8F6422AR020SC
Z8F6422VS020SC
Z8F6423FT020SC
64 KB 4 KB 31 23
64 KB 4 KB 31 23
64 KB 4 KB 46 24
64 KB 4 KB 46 24
64 KB 4 KB 60 24
3
3
4
4
4
8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
LQFP 44-pin package
PLCC 44-pin package
LQFP 64-pin package
PLCC 68-pin package
QFP 80-pin package
8
12
12
12
Extended Temperature: –40 °C to +105 °C
Z8F6421AN020EC
Z8F6421VN020EC
Z8F6422AR020EC
Z8F6422VS020EC
Z8F6423FT020EC
64 KB 4 KB 31 23
3
3
4
4
4
8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
LQFP 44-pin package
PLCC 44-pin package
LQFP 64-pin package
PLCC 68-pin package
QFP 80-pin package
64 KB 4 KB 31 23
64 KB 4 KB 46 24
64 KB 4 KB 46 24
64 KB 4 KB 60 24
8
12
12
12
Automotive/Industrial Temperature: –40 °C to +125 °C
Z8F6421AN020AC
Z8F6421VN020AC
Z8F6422AR020AC
Z8F6422VS020AC
Z8F6423FT020AC
64 KB 4 KB 31 23
64 KB 4 KB 31 23
64 KB 4 KB 46 24
64 KB 4 KB 46 24
64 KB 4 KB 60 24
3
3
4
4
4
8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
LQFP 44-pin package
PLCC 44-pin package
LQFP 64-pin package
PLCC 68-pin package
QFP 80-pin package
8
12
12
12
PS019921-0308
Ordering Information
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
266
Z8F482x with 48 KB Flash, 10-Bit Analog-to-Digital Converter
Standard Temperature: 0 °C to 70 °C
Z8F4821AN020SC
Z8F4821VN020SC
Z8F4822AR020SC
Z8F4822VS020SC
Z8F4823FT020SC
48 KB 4 KB 31 23
48 KB 4 KB 31 23
48 KB 4 KB 46 24
48 KB 4 KB 46 24
48 KB 4 KB 60 24
3
3
4
4
4
8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
LQFP 44-pin package
PLCC 44-pin package
LQFP 64-pin package
PLCC 68-pin package
QFP 80-pin package
8
12
12
12
Extended Temperature: –40 °C to +105 °C
Z8F4821AN020EC
Z8F4821VN020EC
Z8F4822AR020EC
Z8F4822VS020EC
Z8F4823FT020EC
48 KB 4 KB 31 23
3
3
4
4
4
8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
LQFP 44-pin package
PLCC 44-pin package
LQFP 64-pin package
PLCC 68-pin package
QFP 80-pin package
48 KB 4 KB 31 23
48 KB 4 KB 46 24
48 KB 4 KB 46 24
48 KB 4 KB 60 24
8
12
12
12
Automotive/Industrial Temperature: –40 °C to +125 °C
Z8F4821AN020AC
Z8F4821VN020AC
Z8F4822AR020AC
Z8F4822VS020AC
Z8F4823FT020AC
48 KB 4 KB 31 23
48 KB 4 KB 31 23
48 KB 4 KB 46 24
48 KB 4 KB 46 24
48 KB 4 KB 60 24
3
3
4
4
4
8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
LQFP 44-pin package
PLCC 44-pin package
LQFP 64-pin package
PLCC 68-pin package
QFP 80-pin package
8
12
12
12
PS019921-0308
Ordering Information
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
267
Z8F322x with 32 KB Flash, 10-Bit Analog-to-Digital Converter
Standard Temperature: 0 °C to 70 °C
Z8F3221AN020SC
Z8F3221VN020SC
Z8F3222AR020SC
Z8F3222VS020SC
32 KB 2 KB 31 23
32 KB 2 KB 31 23
32 KB 2 KB 46 24
32 KB 2 KB 46 24
3
3
4
4
8
8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
LQFP 44-pin package
PLCC 44-pin package
LQFP 64-pin package
PLCC 68-pin package
12
12
Extended Temperature: –40 °C to 105 °C
Z8F3221AN020EC
Z8F3221VN020EC
Z8F3222AR020EC
Z8F3222VS020EC
32 KB 2 KB 31 23
3
3
4
4
8
8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
LQFP 44-pin package
PLCC 44-pin package
LQFP 64-pin package
PLCC 68-pin package
32 KB 2 KB 31 23
32 KB 2 KB 46 24
32 KB 2 KB 46 24
12
12
Automotive/Industrial Temperature: –40 °C to 125°C
Z8F3221AN020AC
Z8F3221VN020AC
Z8F3222AR020AC
Z8F3222VS020AC
32 KB 2 KB 31 23
32 KB 2 KB 31 23
32 KB 2 KB 46 24
32 KB 2 KB 46 24
3
3
4
4
8
8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
LQFP 44-pin package
PLCC 44-pin package
LQFP 64-pin package
PLCC 68-pin package
12
12
PS019921-0308
Ordering Information
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
268
Z8F242x with 24 KB Flash, 10-Bit Analog-to-Digital Converter
Standard Temperature: 0 °C to 70 °C
Z8F2421AN020SC
Z8F2421VN020SC
Z8F2422AR020SC
Z8F2422VS020SC
24 KB 2 KB 31 23
24 KB 2 KB 31 23
24 KB 2 KB 46 24
24 KB 2 KB 46 24
3
3
4
4
8
8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
LQFP 44-pin package
PLCC 44-pin package
LQFP 64-pin package
PLCC 68-pin package
12
12
Extended Temperature: –40 °C to 105 °C
Z8F2421AN020EC
Z8F2421VN020EC
Z8F2422AR020EC
Z8F2422VS020EC
24 KB 2 KB 31 23
3
3
4
4
8
8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
LQFP 44-pin package
PLCC 44-pin package
LQFP 64-pin package
PLCC 68-pin package
24 KB 2 KB 31 23
24 KB 2 KB 46 24
24 KB 2 KB 46 24
12
12
Automotive/Industrial Temperature: –40 °C to 125 °C
Z8F2421AN020AC
Z8F2421VN020AC
Z8F2422AR020AC
Z8F2422VS020AC
24 KB 2 KB 31 23
24 KB 2 KB 31 23
24 KB 2 KB 46 24
24 KB 2 KB 46 24
3
3
4
4
8
8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
LQFP 44-pin package
PLCC 44-pin package
LQFP 64-pin package
PLCC 68-pin package
12
12
PS019921-0308
Ordering Information
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
269
Z8F162x with 16 KB Flash, 10-Bit Analog-to-Digital Converter
Standard Temperature: 0 °C to 70 °C
Z8F1621AN020SC
Z8F1621VN020SC
Z8F1622AR020SC
Z8F1622VS020SC
16 KB 2 KB 31 23
16 KB 2 KB 31 23
16 KB 2 KB 46 24
16 KB 2 KB 46 24
3
3
4
4
8
8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
LQFP 44-pin package
PLCC 44-pin package
LQFP 64-pin package
PLCC 68-pin package
12
12
Extended Temperature: –40 °C to +105 °C
Z8F1621AN020EC
Z8F1621VN020EC
Z8F1622AR020EC
Z8F1622VS020EC
16 KB 2 KB 31 23
3
3
4
4
8
8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
LQFP 44-pin package
PLCC 44-pin package
LQFP 64-pin package
PLCC 68-pin package
16 KB 2 KB 31 23
16 KB 2 KB 46 24
16 KB 2 KB 46 24
12
12
Automotive/Industrial Temperature: –40 °C to +125 °C
Z8F1621AN020AC
Z8F1621VN020AC
Z8F1622AR020AC
Z8F1622VS020AC
Z8F64200100KITG
ZUSBSC00100ZACG
16 KB 2 KB 31 23
16 KB 2 KB 31 23
16 KB 2 KB 46 24
16 KB 2 KB 46 24
3
3
4
4
8
8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
LQFP 44-pin package
PLCC 44-pin package
LQFP 64-pin package
PLCC 68-pin package
Development Kit
12
12
USB Smart Cable
Accessory Kit
ZUSBOPTSC01ZACG
ZENETSC0100ZACG
Opto-Isolated USB Smart
Cable Accessory Kit
Ethernet Smart Cable
Accessory Kit
Note: Replace C with G for lead-free packaging.
For technical and customer support, hardware and software development tools, refer to
the Zilog® website at www.zilog.com. The latest released version of ZDS can be
downloaded from this website.
PS019921-0308
Ordering Information
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
270
Part Number Suffix Designations
Z8
F
64 21
A
N 020 S
C
Environmental Flow
C = Plastic Standard
G = Lead Free Package
Temperature Range (°C)
S = Standard, 0 to 70
E = Extended, –40 to +105
A = Automotive/Industrial, –40 to +125
Speed
020 = 20 MHz
Pin Count
N = 44 pins
R = 64 pins
S = 68 pins
T = 80 pins
Package
A = LQFP
F = QFP
P = PDIP
V = PLCC
Device Type
21 = Devices with 29 or 31 I/O Lines, 23
Interrupts, 3 Timers and 8 ADC channels
22 = Devices with 46 I/O Lines, 24 Interrupts,
4 Timers and 12 ADC channels
23 = Devices with 60 I/O Lines, 24 Interrupts,
4 Timers and 12 ADC channels
Memory Size
64 KB Flash, 4 KB RAM
48 KB Flash, 4 KB RAM
32 KB Flash, 2 KB RAM
24 KB Flash, 2 KB RAM
16 KB Flash, 2 KB RAM
Memory Type
F = Flash
Device Family
PS019921-0308
Ordering Information
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
271
Example: Part number Z8F6421AN020SC is an 8-bit microcontroller product in an LQFP
package, using 44 pins, operating with a maximum 20 MHz external clock frequency over
a 0 ºC to +70 ºC temperature range and built using the Plastic-Standard environmental
flow.
PS019921-0308
Ordering Information
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
272
PS019921-0308
Ordering Information
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
273
Index
address space 17
ADDX 242
Symbols
# 240
analog signals 14
% 240
@ 240
analog-to-digital converter (ADC) 171
AND 244
ANDX 244
arithmetic instructions 242
assembly language programming 237
assembly language syntax 238
Numerics
10-bit ADC 4
44-lead low-profile quad flat package 261
44-lead plastic lead chip carrier package 262
64-lead low-profile quad flat package 262
68-lead plastic lead chip carrier package 263
80-lead quad flat package 264
B
B 240
b 239
baud rate generator, UART 109
BCLR 242
A
absolute maximum ratings 211
AC characteristics 227
ADC 242
binary number suffix 240
BIT 242
architecture 171
bit 239
automatic power-down 172
block diagram 172
clear 242
manipulation instructions 242
set 242
set or clear 242
swap 243
continuous conversion 173
control register 175
control register definitions 175
data high byte register 176
data low bits register 176
DMA control 174
test and jump 245
test and jump if non-zero 245
test and jump if zero 245
bit jump and test if non-zero 245
bit swap 245
electrical characteristics and timing 225
operation 172
single-shot conversion 173
ADCCTL register 175
ADCDH register 176
ADCDL register 176
ADCX 242
block diagram 3
block transfer instructions 243
BRK 245
BSET 242
ADD 242
BSWAP 243, 245
add - extended addressing 242
add with carry 242
BTJ 245
BTJNZ 245
add with carry - extended addressing 242
additional symbols 240
BTJZ 245
PS019921-0308
Index
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
274
DECW 242
C
destination operand 240
device, port availability 53
DI 243
CALL procedure 245
capture mode 91
capture/compare mode 91
cc 239
direct address 239
direct memory access controller 161
disable interrupts 243
CCF 243
characteristics, electrical 211
clear 244
DJNZ 245
DMA
clock phase (SPI) 128
CLR 244
address high nibble register 165
configuring DMA0-1 data transfer 161
configuring for DMA_ADC data transfer 162
control of ADC 174
control register 163
control register definitions 163
controller 5
COM 244
compare 91
compare - extended addressing 242
compare mode 91
compare with carry 242
compare with carry - extended addressing 242
complement 244
DMA_ADC address register 167
DMA_ADC control register 168
DMA_ADC operation 162
end address low byte register 166
I/O address register 164
operation 161
complement carry flag 243
condition code 239
continuous conversion (ADC) 173
continuous mode 90
control register definition, UART 110
control register, I2C 154
counter modes 90
start/current address low byte register 166
status register 169
DMAA_STAT register 169
DMAACTL register 168
DMAxCTL register 163
DMAxEND register 166
DMAxH register 165
CP 242
CPC 242
CPCX 242
CPU and peripheral overview 3
CPU control instructions 243
CPX 242
DMAxI/O address (DMAxIO) 165
DMAxIO register 165
DMAxSTART register 166
dst 240
Customer Feedback Form 287
customer feedback form 271
D
E
DA 239, 242
EI 243
data register, I2C 152
DC characteristics 213
debugger, on-chip 195
DEC 242
electrical characteristics 211
ADC 225
flash memory and timing 224
GPIO input data sample timing 228
watch-dog timer 224
enable interrupt 243
ER 239
decimal adjust 242
decrement 242
decrement and jump non-zero 245
decrement word 242
PS019921-0308
Index
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
275
extended addressing register 239
external pin reset 49
GPIO 4, 53
alternate functions 54
external RC oscillator 223
eZ8 CPU features 3
architecture 53
control register definitions 56
input data sample timing 228
interrupts 56
eZ8 CPU instruction classes 241
eZ8 CPU instruction notation 238
eZ8 CPU instruction set 237
eZ8 CPU instruction summary 246
port A-H address registers 57
port A-H alternate function sub-registers 59
port A-H control registers 58
port A-H data direction sub-registers 59
port A-H high drive enable sub-registers 60
port A-H input data registers 62
port A-H output control sub-registers 60
port A-H output data registers 62
port A-H Stop Mode Recovery sub-registers 61
port availability by device 53
port input timing 228
F
FCTL register 186
features, Z8 Encore! 1
first opcode map 259
FLAGS 240
flags register 240
flash
port output timing 229
controller 4
option bit address space 191
option bit configuration - reset 191
program memory address 0001H 193
flash memory
H
H 240
arrangement 180
HALT 243
byte programming 183
code protection 182
configurations 179
halt mode 51, 243
hexadecimal number prefix/suffix 240
control register definitions 186
controller bypass 185
electrical characteristics and timing 224
flash control register 186
flash status register 186
frequency high and low byte registers 188
mass erase 185
I
I2C 4
10-bit address read transaction 150
10-bit address transaction 147
10-bit addressed slave data transfer format 147
10-bit receive data format 150
7-bit address transaction 145
7-bit address, reading a transaction 149
7-bit addressed slave data transfer format 144,
145, 146
operation 181
operation timing 182
page erase 184
page select register 187
FPS register 187
7-bit receive data transfer format 149
baud high and low byte registers 156, 157, 159
C status register 153
FSTAT register 186
control register definitions 152
controller 139
G
gated mode 91
controller signals 13
general-purpose I/O 53
interrupts 141
PS019921-0308
Index
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
276
operation 140
SDA and SCL signals 141
stop and start conditions 143
I2CBRH register 156, 157, 159
I2CBRL register 157
I2CCTL register 154
I2CDATA register 153
I2CSTAT register 153
IM 239
COM 244
CP 242
CPC 242
CPCX 242
CPU control 243
CPX 242
DA 242
DEC 242
DECW 242
DI 243
immediate data 239
immediate operand prefix 240
INC 242
DJNZ 245
EI 243
increment 242
HALT 243
INC 242
increment word 242
INCW 242
INCW 242
IRET 245
JP 245
indexed 239
indirect address prefix 240
indirect register 239
indirect register pair 239
indirect working register 239
indirect working register pair 239
infrared encoder/decoder (IrDA) 121
instruction set, ez8 CPU 237
instructions
LD 244
LDC 244
LDCI 243, 244
LDE 244
LDEI 243
LDX 244
LEA 244
ADC 242
load 244
ADCX 242
logical 244
MULT 242
NOP 243
OR 244
ADD 242
ADDX 242
AND 244
ANDX 244
ORX 244
POP 244
arithmetic 242
BCLR 242
POPX 244
program control 245
PUSH 244
PUSHX 244
RCF 243
BIT 242
bit manipulation 242
block transfer 243
BRK 245
BSET 242
RET 245
BSWAP 243, 245
BTJ 245
RL 245
RLC 245
BTJNZ 245
rotate and shift 245
RR 245
BTJZ 245
CALL 245
RRC 245
SBC 242
SCF 243
CCF 243
CLR 244
PS019921-0308
Index
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
277
SRA 245
operation 121
SRL 246
receiving data 122
transmitting data 122
IRET 245
SRP 243
STOP 244
IRQ0 enable high and low bit registers 70
IRQ1 enable high and low bit registers 71
IRQ2 enable high and low bit registers 72
IRR 239
SUB 242
SUBX 242
SWAP 246
TCM 243
Irr 239
TCMX 243
TM 243
TMX 243
J
TRAP 245
watch-dog timer refresh 244
XOR 245
JP 245
jump, conditional, relative, and relative conditional
245
XORX 245
instructions, eZ8 classes of 241
interrupt control register 75
interrupt controller 5, 63
architecture 63
L
LD 244
interrupt assertion types 66
interrupt vectors and priority 66
operation 65
LDC 244
LDCI 243, 244
LDE 244
register definitions 67
software interrupt assertion 66
interrupt edge select register 74
interrupt port select register 74
interrupt request 0 register 67
interrupt request 1 register 68
interrupt request 2 register 69
interrupt return 245
interrupt vector listing 63
interrupts
LDEI 243, 244
LDX 244
LEA 244
load 244
load constant 243
load constant to/from program memory 244
load constant with auto-increment addresses 244
load effective address 244
load external data 244
load external data to/from data memory and auto-
increment addresses 243
load external to/from data memory and auto-incre-
ment addresses 244
not acknowledge 141
receive 141
SPI 131
transmit 141
load instructions 244
load using extended addressing 244
logical AND 244
UART 107
introduction 1
IR 239
logical AND/extended addressing 244
logical exclusive OR 245
logical exclusive OR/extended addressing 245
logical instructions 244
logical OR 244
Ir 239
IrDA
architecture 121
block diagram 121
control register definitions 124
logical OR/extended addressing 244
PS019921-0308
Index
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
278
low power modes 51
LQFP
rr 239
vector 239
X 239
44 lead 261
64 lead 262
notational shorthand 239
M
O
master interrupt enable 65
master-in, slave-out and-in 127
memory
OCD
architecture 195
auto-baud detector/generator 198
baud rate limits 198
program 17
MISO 127
block diagram 195
mode
breakpoints 199
capture 91
commands 200
capture/compare 91
continuous 90
counter 90
control register 205
data format 197
DBG pin to RS-232 Interface 196
debug mode 197
gated 91
one-shot 90
debugger break 245
PWM 90
interface 195
modes 91
serial errors 198
MULT 242
status register 206
multiply 242
timing 230
multiprocessor mode, UART 105
OCD commands
execute instruction (12H) 204
read data memory (0DH) 203
read OCD control register (05H) 201
read OCD revision (00H) 201
read OCD status register (02H) 201
read program counter (07H) 202
read program memory (0BH) 203
read program memory CRC (0EH) 203
read register (09H) 202
step instruction (10H) 204
stuff instruction (11H) 204
write data memory (0CH) 203
write OCD control register (04H) 201
write program counter (06H) 201
write program memory (0AH) 202
write register (08H) 202
on-chip debugger 5
N
NOP (no operation) 243
not acknowledge interrupt 141
notation
b 239
cc 239
DA 239
ER 239
IM 239
IR 239
Ir 239
IRR 239
Irr 239
p 239
R 239
r 239
on-chip debugger (OCD) 195
on-chip debugger signals 15
on-chip oscillator 207
RA 239
RR 239
PS019921-0308
Index
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
279
one-shot mode 90
opcode map
program control instructions 245
program counter 240
program memory 17
PUSH 244
abbreviations 258
cell description 257
first 259
push using extended addressing 244
PUSHX 244
second after 1FH 260
Operational Description 99
OR 244
PWM mode 90
PxADDR register 57
PxCTL register 58
ordering information 265
ORX 244
oscillator signals 14
Q
QFP 264
P
p 239
packaging
R
LQFP
R 239
44 lead 261
r 239
64 lead 262
RA
PLCC
register address 239
44 lead 262
RCF 243
receive
68 lead 263
10-bit data format (I2C) 150
7-bit data transfer format (I2C) 149
IrDA data 122
QFP 264
part number description 270
part selection guide 2
PC 240
receive interrupt 141
receiving UART data-interrupt-driven method 104
receiving UART data-polled method 103
register 136, 165, 239
peripheral AC and DC electrical characteristics 222
PHASE=0 timing (SPI) 129
PHASE=1 timing (SPI) 130
pin characteristics 15
PLCC
ADC control (ADCCTL) 175
ADC data high byte (ADCDH) 176
ADC data low bits (ADCDL) 176
baud low and high byte (I2C) 156, 157, 159
baud rate high and low byte (SPI) 138
control (SPI) 133
44 lead 262
68-lead 263
polarity 239
POP 244
control, I2C 154
pop using extended addressing 244
POPX 244
data, SPI 133
DMA status (DMAA_STAT) 169
DMA_ADC address 167
DMA_ADC control DMAACTL) 168
DMAx address high nibble (DMAxH) 165
DMAx control (DMAxCTL) 163
DMAx end/address low byte (DMAxEND) 166
DMAx start/current address low byte register
port availability, device 53
port input timing (GPIO) 228
port output timing, GPIO 229
power supply signals 15
power-down, automatic (ADC) 172
power-on and voltage brown-out 222
power-on reset (POR) 47
PS019921-0308
Index
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
280
(DMAxSTART) 166
and STOP mode characteristics 45
flash control (FCTL) 186
carry flag 243
controller 5
sources 46
flash high and low byte (FFREQH and FRE-
EQL) 188
flash page select (FPS) 187
RET 245
flash status (FSTAT) 186
return 245
GPIO port A-H address (PxADDR) 57
GPIO port A-H alternate function sub-registers
59
RL 245
RLC 245
rotate and shift instructions 245
rotate left 245
rotate left through carry 245
rotate right 245
rotate right through carry 245
RP 240
GPIO port A-H control address (PxCTL) 58
GPIO port A-H data direction sub-registers 59
I2C baud rate high (I2CBRH) 156, 157, 159
I2C control (I2CCTL) 154
I2C data (I2CDATA) 153
RR 239, 245
I2C status 153
rr 239
I2C status (I2CSTAT) 153
RRC 245
I2Cbaud rate low (I2CBRL) 157
mode, SPI 136
OCD control 205
OCD status 206
S
SPI baud rate high byte (SPIBRH) 138
SPI baud rate low byte (SPIBRL) 138
SPI control (SPICTL) 134
SBC 242
SCF 243
SDA and SCL (IrDA) signals 141
second opcode map after 1FH 260
serial clock 127
SPI data (SPIDATA) 133
SPI status (SPISTAT) 135
status, I2C 153
serial peripheral interface (SPI) 125
set carry flag 243
status, SPI 135
UARTx baud rate high byte (UxBRH) 117
UARTx baud rate low byte (UxBRL) 117
UARTx Control 0 (UxCTL0) 113, 116
UARTx control 1 (UxCTL1) 114
UARTx receive data (UxRXD) 111
UARTx status 0 (UxSTAT0) 111
UARTx status 1 (UxSTAT1) 113
UARTx transmit data (UxTXD) 110
watchdog timer control (WDTCTL) 96
watchdog timer reload high byte (WDTH) 98
watchdog timer reload low byte (WDTL) 98
watchdog timer reload upper byte (WDTU) 98
set register pointer 243
shift right arithmetic 245
shift right logical 246
signal descriptions 13
single-shot conversion (ADC) 173
SIO 5
slave data transfer formats (I2C) 147
slave select 128
software trap 245
source operand 240
SP 240
SPI
register file 17
architecture 125
register file address map 21
register pair 239
register pointer 240
reset
baud rate generator 132
baud rate high and low byte register 138
clock phase 128
configured as slave 126
PS019921-0308
Index
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
281
control register 133
control register definitions 133
data register 133
symbols, additional 240
system and core resets 46
error detection 131
interrupts 131
T
mode fault error 131
mode register 136
TCM 243
TCMX 243
multi-master operation 130
operation 126
Technical Support 287
test complement under mask 243
test complement under mask - extended addressing
243
overrun error 131
signals 127
single master, multiple slave system 126
single master, single slave system 125
status register 135
test under mask 243
test under mask - extended addressing 243
timer signals 14
timing, PHASE = 0 129
timing, PHASE=1 130
SPI controller signals 13
SPI mode (SPIMODE) 136
SPIBRH register 138
SPIBRL register 138
SPICTL register 134
SPIDATA register 133
SPIMODE register 136
SPISTAT register 135
SRA 245
timers 5, 77
architecture 77
block diagram 78
capture mode 82, 91
capture/compare mode 85, 91
compare mode 83, 91
continuous mode 79, 90
counter mode 80
counter modes 90
gated mode 84, 91
one-shot mode 78, 90
operating mode 78
src 240
SRL 246
PWM mode 81, 90
SRP 243
reading the timer count values 86
reload high and low byte registers 87
timer control register definitions 86
timer output signal operation 86
timers 0-3
stack pointer 240
status register, I2C 153
STOP 244
STOP mode 51, 244
Stop Mode Recovery
sources 49
control 0 registers 89
control 1 registers 90
high and low byte registers 86, 88
TM 243
using a GPIO port pin transition 50
using watchdog timer time-out 50
SUB 242
TMX 243
subtract 242
transmit
subtract - extended addressing 242
subtract with carry 242
subtract with carry - extended addressing 242
SUBX 242
IrDA data 122
transmit interrupt 141
transmitting UART data-interrupt-driven method
102
SWAP 246
swap nibbles 246
transmitting UART data-polled method 101
TRAP 245
PS019921-0308
Index
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
282
electrical characteristics and timing 224
interrupt in normal operation 94
interrupt in STOP mode 94
refresh 244
U
UART 4
architecture 99
asynchronous data format without/with parity
101
reload unlock sequence 95
reload upper, high and low registers 97
reset 48
baud rate generator 109
baud rates table 118
reset in normal operation 95
reset in STOP mode 95
time-out response 94
control register definitions 110
controller signals 14
data format 100
interrupts 107
WDTCTL register 96
WDTH register 98
multiprocessor mode 105
receiving data using interrupt-driven method
104
WDTL register 98
working register 239
working register pair 239
WTDU register 98
receiving data using the polled method 103
transmitting data using the interrupt-driven
method 102
transmitting data using the polled method 101
x baud rate high and low registers 116
x control 0 and control 1 registers 113
x status 0 and status 1 registers 111, 112
UxBRH register 117
X
X 239
XOR 245
XORX 245
UxBRL register 117
UxCTL0 register 113, 116
UxCTL1 register 114
Z
Z8 Encore!
UxRXD register 111
block diagram 3
features 1
UxSTAT0 register 111
UxSTAT1 register 113
introduction 1
part selection guide 2
UxTXD register 110
V
vector 239
voltage brownout reset (VBR) 47
W
watchdog timer
approximate time-out delay 94
CNTL 48
control register 96
refresh 94
PS019921-0308
Index
Z8 Encore! XP® F64XX Series
Product Specification
283
Customer Support
For answers to technical questions about the product, documentation, or any other issues
with Zilog’s offerings, please visit Zilog’s Knowledge Base at
http://www.zilog.com/kb.
For any comments, detail technical questions, or reporting problems, please visit
Zilog’s Technical Support at http://support.zilog.com.
PS019921-0308
Customer Support
相关型号:
©2020 ICPDF网 联系我们和版权申明